1/* tc-ia64.c -- Assembler for the HP/Intel IA-64 architecture.
2   Copyright (C) 1998-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3   Contributed by David Mosberger-Tang <davidm@hpl.hp.com>
4
5   This file is part of GAS, the GNU Assembler.
6
7   GAS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9   the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
10   any later version.
11
12   GAS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
15   GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18   along with GAS; see the file COPYING.  If not, write to
19   the Free Software Foundation, 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20   Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
21
22/*
23  TODO:
24
25  - optional operands
26  - directives:
27	.eb
28	.estate
29	.lb
30	.popsection
31	.previous
32	.psr
33	.pushsection
34  - labels are wrong if automatic alignment is introduced
35    (e.g., checkout the second real10 definition in test-data.s)
36  - DV-related stuff:
37	<reg>.safe_across_calls and any other DV-related directives I don't
38	  have documentation for.
39	verify mod-sched-brs reads/writes are checked/marked (and other
40	notes)
41
42 */
43
44#include "as.h"
45#include "safe-ctype.h"
46#include "dwarf2dbg.h"
47#include "subsegs.h"
48
49#include "opcode/ia64.h"
50
51#include "elf/ia64.h"
52#include "bfdver.h"
53#include <time.h>
54
55#ifdef HAVE_LIMITS_H
56#include <limits.h>
57#endif
58
59#define NELEMS(a)	((int) (sizeof (a)/sizeof ((a)[0])))
60
61/* Some systems define MIN in, e.g., param.h.  */
62#undef MIN
63#define MIN(a,b)	((a) < (b) ? (a) : (b))
64
65#define NUM_SLOTS	4
66#define PREV_SLOT	md.slot[(md.curr_slot + NUM_SLOTS - 1) % NUM_SLOTS]
67#define CURR_SLOT	md.slot[md.curr_slot]
68
69#define O_pseudo_fixup (O_max + 1)
70
71enum special_section
72  {
73    /* IA-64 ABI section pseudo-ops.  */
74    SPECIAL_SECTION_BSS = 0,
75    SPECIAL_SECTION_SBSS,
76    SPECIAL_SECTION_SDATA,
77    SPECIAL_SECTION_RODATA,
78    SPECIAL_SECTION_COMMENT,
79    SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND,
80    SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND_INFO,
81    /* HPUX specific section pseudo-ops.  */
82    SPECIAL_SECTION_INIT_ARRAY,
83    SPECIAL_SECTION_FINI_ARRAY,
84  };
85
86enum reloc_func
87  {
88    FUNC_DTP_MODULE,
89    FUNC_DTP_RELATIVE,
90    FUNC_FPTR_RELATIVE,
91    FUNC_GP_RELATIVE,
92    FUNC_LT_RELATIVE,
93    FUNC_LT_RELATIVE_X,
94    FUNC_PC_RELATIVE,
95    FUNC_PLT_RELATIVE,
96    FUNC_SEC_RELATIVE,
97    FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE,
98    FUNC_TP_RELATIVE,
99    FUNC_LTV_RELATIVE,
100    FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE,
101    FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE,
102    FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE,
103    FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE,
104    FUNC_IPLT_RELOC,
105#ifdef TE_VMS
106    FUNC_SLOTCOUNT_RELOC,
107#endif
108  };
109
110enum reg_symbol
111  {
112    REG_GR	= 0,
113    REG_FR	= (REG_GR + 128),
114    REG_AR	= (REG_FR + 128),
115    REG_CR	= (REG_AR + 128),
116    REG_DAHR	= (REG_CR + 128),
117    REG_P	= (REG_DAHR + 8),
118    REG_BR	= (REG_P  + 64),
119    REG_IP	= (REG_BR + 8),
120    REG_CFM,
121    REG_PR,
122    REG_PR_ROT,
123    REG_PSR,
124    REG_PSR_L,
125    REG_PSR_UM,
126    /* The following are pseudo-registers for use by gas only.  */
127    IND_CPUID,
128    IND_DBR,
129    IND_DTR,
130    IND_ITR,
131    IND_IBR,
132    IND_MSR,
133    IND_PKR,
134    IND_PMC,
135    IND_PMD,
136    IND_DAHR,
137    IND_RR,
138    /* The following pseudo-registers are used for unwind directives only:  */
139    REG_PSP,
140    REG_PRIUNAT,
141    REG_NUM
142  };
143
144enum dynreg_type
145  {
146    DYNREG_GR = 0,	/* dynamic general purpose register */
147    DYNREG_FR,		/* dynamic floating point register */
148    DYNREG_PR,		/* dynamic predicate register */
149    DYNREG_NUM_TYPES
150  };
151
152enum operand_match_result
153  {
154    OPERAND_MATCH,
155    OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE,
156    OPERAND_MISMATCH
157  };
158
159/* On the ia64, we can't know the address of a text label until the
160   instructions are packed into a bundle.  To handle this, we keep
161   track of the list of labels that appear in front of each
162   instruction.  */
163struct label_fix
164{
165  struct label_fix *next;
166  struct symbol *sym;
167  bfd_boolean dw2_mark_labels;
168};
169
170#ifdef TE_VMS
171/* An internally used relocation.  */
172#define DUMMY_RELOC_IA64_SLOTCOUNT	(BFD_RELOC_UNUSED + 1)
173#endif
174
175/* This is the endianness of the current section.  */
176extern int target_big_endian;
177
178/* This is the default endianness.  */
179static int default_big_endian = TARGET_BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN;
180
181void (*ia64_number_to_chars) (char *, valueT, int);
182
183static void ia64_float_to_chars_bigendian (char *, LITTLENUM_TYPE *, int);
184static void ia64_float_to_chars_littleendian (char *, LITTLENUM_TYPE *, int);
185
186static void (*ia64_float_to_chars) (char *, LITTLENUM_TYPE *, int);
187
188static struct hash_control *alias_hash;
189static struct hash_control *alias_name_hash;
190static struct hash_control *secalias_hash;
191static struct hash_control *secalias_name_hash;
192
193/* List of chars besides those in app.c:symbol_chars that can start an
194   operand.  Used to prevent the scrubber eating vital white-space.  */
195const char ia64_symbol_chars[] = "@?";
196
197/* Characters which always start a comment.  */
198const char comment_chars[] = "";
199
200/* Characters which start a comment at the beginning of a line.  */
201const char line_comment_chars[] = "#";
202
203/* Characters which may be used to separate multiple commands on a
204   single line.  */
205const char line_separator_chars[] = ";{}";
206
207/* Characters which are used to indicate an exponent in a floating
208   point number.  */
209const char EXP_CHARS[] = "eE";
210
211/* Characters which mean that a number is a floating point constant,
212   as in 0d1.0.  */
213const char FLT_CHARS[] = "rRsSfFdDxXpP";
214
215/* ia64-specific option processing:  */
216
217const char *md_shortopts = "m:N:x::";
218
219struct option md_longopts[] =
220  {
221#define OPTION_MCONSTANT_GP (OPTION_MD_BASE + 1)
222    {"mconstant-gp", no_argument, NULL, OPTION_MCONSTANT_GP},
223#define OPTION_MAUTO_PIC (OPTION_MD_BASE + 2)
224    {"mauto-pic", no_argument, NULL, OPTION_MAUTO_PIC}
225  };
226
227size_t md_longopts_size = sizeof (md_longopts);
228
229static struct
230  {
231    struct hash_control *pseudo_hash;	/* pseudo opcode hash table */
232    struct hash_control *reg_hash;	/* register name hash table */
233    struct hash_control *dynreg_hash;	/* dynamic register hash table */
234    struct hash_control *const_hash;	/* constant hash table */
235    struct hash_control *entry_hash;    /* code entry hint hash table */
236
237    /* If X_op is != O_absent, the register name for the instruction's
238       qualifying predicate.  If NULL, p0 is assumed for instructions
239       that are predictable.  */
240    expressionS qp;
241
242    /* Optimize for which CPU.  */
243    enum
244      {
245	itanium1,
246	itanium2
247      } tune;
248
249    /* What to do when hint.b is used.  */
250    enum
251      {
252	hint_b_error,
253	hint_b_warning,
254	hint_b_ok
255      } hint_b;
256
257    unsigned int
258      manual_bundling : 1,
259      debug_dv: 1,
260      detect_dv: 1,
261      explicit_mode : 1,            /* which mode we're in */
262      default_explicit_mode : 1,    /* which mode is the default */
263      mode_explicitly_set : 1,      /* was the current mode explicitly set? */
264      auto_align : 1,
265      keep_pending_output : 1;
266
267    /* What to do when something is wrong with unwind directives.  */
268    enum
269      {
270	unwind_check_warning,
271	unwind_check_error
272      } unwind_check;
273
274    /* Each bundle consists of up to three instructions.  We keep
275       track of four most recent instructions so we can correctly set
276       the end_of_insn_group for the last instruction in a bundle.  */
277    int curr_slot;
278    int num_slots_in_use;
279    struct slot
280      {
281	unsigned int
282	  end_of_insn_group : 1,
283	  manual_bundling_on : 1,
284	  manual_bundling_off : 1,
285	  loc_directive_seen : 1;
286	signed char user_template;	/* user-selected template, if any */
287	unsigned char qp_regno;		/* qualifying predicate */
288	/* This duplicates a good fraction of "struct fix" but we
289	   can't use a "struct fix" instead since we can't call
290	   fix_new_exp() until we know the address of the instruction.  */
291	int num_fixups;
292	struct insn_fix
293	  {
294	    bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
295	    enum ia64_opnd opnd;	/* type of operand in need of fix */
296	    unsigned int is_pcrel : 1;	/* is operand pc-relative? */
297	    expressionS expr;		/* the value to be inserted */
298	  }
299	fixup[2];			/* at most two fixups per insn */
300	struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
301	struct label_fix *label_fixups;
302	struct label_fix *tag_fixups;
303	struct unw_rec_list *unwind_record;	/* Unwind directive.  */
304	expressionS opnd[6];
305	const char *src_file;
306	unsigned int src_line;
307	struct dwarf2_line_info debug_line;
308      }
309    slot[NUM_SLOTS];
310
311    segT last_text_seg;
312
313    struct dynreg
314      {
315	struct dynreg *next;		/* next dynamic register */
316	const char *name;
317	unsigned short base;		/* the base register number */
318	unsigned short num_regs;	/* # of registers in this set */
319      }
320    *dynreg[DYNREG_NUM_TYPES], in, loc, out, rot;
321
322    flagword flags;			/* ELF-header flags */
323
324    struct mem_offset {
325      unsigned hint:1;              /* is this hint currently valid? */
326      bfd_vma offset;               /* mem.offset offset */
327      bfd_vma base;                 /* mem.offset base */
328    } mem_offset;
329
330    int path;                       /* number of alt. entry points seen */
331    const char **entry_labels;      /* labels of all alternate paths in
332				       the current DV-checking block.  */
333    int maxpaths;                   /* size currently allocated for
334				       entry_labels */
335
336    int pointer_size;       /* size in bytes of a pointer */
337    int pointer_size_shift; /* shift size of a pointer for alignment */
338
339    symbolS *indregsym[IND_RR - IND_CPUID + 1];
340  }
341md;
342
343/* These are not const, because they are modified to MMI for non-itanium1
344   targets below.  */
345/* MFI bundle of nops.  */
346static unsigned char le_nop[16] =
347{
348  0x0c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x01, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00,
349  0x00, 0x02, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x04, 0x00
350};
351/* MFI bundle of nops with stop-bit.  */
352static unsigned char le_nop_stop[16] =
353{
354  0x0d, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x01, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00,
355  0x00, 0x02, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x04, 0x00
356};
357
358/* application registers:  */
359
360#define AR_K0		0
361#define AR_K7		7
362#define AR_RSC		16
363#define AR_BSP		17
364#define AR_BSPSTORE	18
365#define AR_RNAT		19
366#define AR_FCR		21
367#define AR_EFLAG	24
368#define AR_CSD		25
369#define AR_SSD		26
370#define AR_CFLG		27
371#define AR_FSR		28
372#define AR_FIR		29
373#define AR_FDR		30
374#define AR_CCV		32
375#define AR_UNAT		36
376#define AR_FPSR		40
377#define AR_ITC		44
378#define AR_RUC		45
379#define AR_PFS		64
380#define AR_LC		65
381#define AR_EC		66
382
383static const struct
384  {
385    const char *name;
386    unsigned int regnum;
387  }
388ar[] =
389  {
390    {"ar.k0",		AR_K0},		{"ar.k1",	AR_K0 + 1},
391    {"ar.k2",		AR_K0 + 2},	{"ar.k3",	AR_K0 + 3},
392    {"ar.k4",		AR_K0 + 4},	{"ar.k5",	AR_K0 + 5},
393    {"ar.k6",		AR_K0 + 6},	{"ar.k7",	AR_K7},
394    {"ar.rsc",		AR_RSC},	{"ar.bsp",	AR_BSP},
395    {"ar.bspstore",	AR_BSPSTORE},	{"ar.rnat",	AR_RNAT},
396    {"ar.fcr",		AR_FCR},	{"ar.eflag",	AR_EFLAG},
397    {"ar.csd",		AR_CSD},	{"ar.ssd",	AR_SSD},
398    {"ar.cflg",		AR_CFLG},	{"ar.fsr",	AR_FSR},
399    {"ar.fir",		AR_FIR},	{"ar.fdr",	AR_FDR},
400    {"ar.ccv",		AR_CCV},	{"ar.unat",	AR_UNAT},
401    {"ar.fpsr",		AR_FPSR},	{"ar.itc",	AR_ITC},
402    {"ar.ruc",		AR_RUC},	{"ar.pfs",	AR_PFS},
403    {"ar.lc",		AR_LC},		{"ar.ec",	AR_EC},
404  };
405
406/* control registers:  */
407
408#define CR_DCR           0
409#define CR_ITM           1
410#define CR_IVA           2
411#define CR_PTA           8
412#define CR_GPTA          9
413#define CR_IPSR         16
414#define CR_ISR          17
415#define CR_IIP          19
416#define CR_IFA          20
417#define CR_ITIR         21
418#define CR_IIPA         22
419#define CR_IFS          23
420#define CR_IIM          24
421#define CR_IHA          25
422#define CR_IIB0         26
423#define CR_IIB1         27
424#define CR_LID          64
425#define CR_IVR          65
426#define CR_TPR          66
427#define CR_EOI          67
428#define CR_IRR0         68
429#define CR_IRR3         71
430#define CR_ITV          72
431#define CR_PMV          73
432#define CR_CMCV         74
433#define CR_LRR0         80
434#define CR_LRR1         81
435
436static const struct
437  {
438    const char *name;
439    unsigned int regnum;
440  }
441cr[] =
442  {
443    {"cr.dcr",	CR_DCR},
444    {"cr.itm",	CR_ITM},
445    {"cr.iva",	CR_IVA},
446    {"cr.pta",	CR_PTA},
447    {"cr.gpta",	CR_GPTA},
448    {"cr.ipsr",	CR_IPSR},
449    {"cr.isr",	CR_ISR},
450    {"cr.iip",	CR_IIP},
451    {"cr.ifa",	CR_IFA},
452    {"cr.itir",	CR_ITIR},
453    {"cr.iipa",	CR_IIPA},
454    {"cr.ifs",	CR_IFS},
455    {"cr.iim",	CR_IIM},
456    {"cr.iha",	CR_IHA},
457    {"cr.iib0",	CR_IIB0},
458    {"cr.iib1",	CR_IIB1},
459    {"cr.lid",	CR_LID},
460    {"cr.ivr",	CR_IVR},
461    {"cr.tpr",	CR_TPR},
462    {"cr.eoi",	CR_EOI},
463    {"cr.irr0",	CR_IRR0},
464    {"cr.irr1",	CR_IRR0 + 1},
465    {"cr.irr2",	CR_IRR0 + 2},
466    {"cr.irr3",	CR_IRR3},
467    {"cr.itv",	CR_ITV},
468    {"cr.pmv",	CR_PMV},
469    {"cr.cmcv",	CR_CMCV},
470    {"cr.lrr0",	CR_LRR0},
471    {"cr.lrr1",	CR_LRR1}
472  };
473
474#define PSR_MFL         4
475#define PSR_IC          13
476#define PSR_DFL         18
477#define PSR_CPL         32
478
479static const struct const_desc
480  {
481    const char *name;
482    valueT value;
483  }
484const_bits[] =
485  {
486    /* PSR constant masks:  */
487
488    /* 0: reserved */
489    {"psr.be",	((valueT) 1) << 1},
490    {"psr.up",	((valueT) 1) << 2},
491    {"psr.ac",	((valueT) 1) << 3},
492    {"psr.mfl",	((valueT) 1) << 4},
493    {"psr.mfh",	((valueT) 1) << 5},
494    /* 6-12: reserved */
495    {"psr.ic",	((valueT) 1) << 13},
496    {"psr.i",	((valueT) 1) << 14},
497    {"psr.pk",	((valueT) 1) << 15},
498    /* 16: reserved */
499    {"psr.dt",	((valueT) 1) << 17},
500    {"psr.dfl",	((valueT) 1) << 18},
501    {"psr.dfh",	((valueT) 1) << 19},
502    {"psr.sp",	((valueT) 1) << 20},
503    {"psr.pp",	((valueT) 1) << 21},
504    {"psr.di",	((valueT) 1) << 22},
505    {"psr.si",	((valueT) 1) << 23},
506    {"psr.db",	((valueT) 1) << 24},
507    {"psr.lp",	((valueT) 1) << 25},
508    {"psr.tb",	((valueT) 1) << 26},
509    {"psr.rt",	((valueT) 1) << 27},
510    /* 28-31: reserved */
511    /* 32-33: cpl (current privilege level) */
512    {"psr.is",	((valueT) 1) << 34},
513    {"psr.mc",	((valueT) 1) << 35},
514    {"psr.it",	((valueT) 1) << 36},
515    {"psr.id",	((valueT) 1) << 37},
516    {"psr.da",	((valueT) 1) << 38},
517    {"psr.dd",	((valueT) 1) << 39},
518    {"psr.ss",	((valueT) 1) << 40},
519    /* 41-42: ri (restart instruction) */
520    {"psr.ed",	((valueT) 1) << 43},
521    {"psr.bn",	((valueT) 1) << 44},
522  };
523
524/* indirect register-sets/memory:  */
525
526static const struct
527  {
528    const char *name;
529    unsigned int regnum;
530  }
531indirect_reg[] =
532  {
533    { "CPUID",	IND_CPUID },
534    { "cpuid",	IND_CPUID },
535    { "dbr",	IND_DBR },
536    { "dtr",	IND_DTR },
537    { "itr",	IND_ITR },
538    { "ibr",	IND_IBR },
539    { "msr",	IND_MSR },
540    { "pkr",	IND_PKR },
541    { "pmc",	IND_PMC },
542    { "pmd",	IND_PMD },
543    { "dahr",	IND_DAHR },
544    { "rr",	IND_RR },
545  };
546
547/* Pseudo functions used to indicate relocation types (these functions
548   start with an at sign (@).  */
549static struct
550  {
551    const char *name;
552    enum pseudo_type
553      {
554	PSEUDO_FUNC_NONE,
555	PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC,
556	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,
557	PSEUDO_FUNC_REG,
558	PSEUDO_FUNC_FLOAT
559      }
560    type;
561    union
562      {
563	unsigned long ival;
564	symbolS *sym;
565      }
566    u;
567  }
568pseudo_func[] =
569  {
570    /* reloc pseudo functions (these must come first!):  */
571    { "dtpmod",	PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
572    { "dtprel",	PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
573    { "fptr",	PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
574    { "gprel",	PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
575    { "ltoff",	PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
576    { "ltoffx",	PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
577    { "pcrel",	PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
578    { "pltoff",	PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
579    { "secrel",	PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
580    { "segrel",	PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
581    { "tprel",	PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
582    { "ltv",	PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
583    { NULL, 0, { 0 } },	/* placeholder for FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE */
584    { NULL, 0, { 0 } },	/* placeholder for FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE */
585    { NULL, 0, { 0 } },	/* placeholder for FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE */
586    { NULL, 0, { 0 } },	/* placeholder for FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE */
587    { "iplt",	PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
588#ifdef TE_VMS
589    { "slotcount", PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
590#endif
591
592    /* mbtype4 constants:  */
593    { "alt",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0xa } },
594    { "brcst",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x0 } },
595    { "mix",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x8 } },
596    { "rev",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0xb } },
597    { "shuf",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x9 } },
598
599    /* fclass constants:  */
600    { "nat",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x100 } },
601    { "qnan",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x080 } },
602    { "snan",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x040 } },
603    { "pos",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x001 } },
604    { "neg",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x002 } },
605    { "zero",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x004 } },
606    { "unorm",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x008 } },
607    { "norm",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x010 } },
608    { "inf",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x020 } },
609
610    { "natval",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x100 } }, /* old usage */
611
612    /* hint constants: */
613    { "pause",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x0 } },
614    { "priority", PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x1 } },
615
616    /* tf constants: */
617    { "clz",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, {  32 } },
618    { "mpy",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, {  33 } },
619    { "datahints",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, {  34 } },
620
621    /* unwind-related constants:  */
622    { "svr4",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,	{ ELFOSABI_NONE } },
623    { "hpux",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,	{ ELFOSABI_HPUX } },
624    { "nt",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,	{ 2 } },		/* conflicts w/ELFOSABI_NETBSD */
625    { "linux",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,	{ ELFOSABI_GNU } },
626    { "freebsd", PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,	{ ELFOSABI_FREEBSD } },
627    { "openvms", PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,	{ ELFOSABI_OPENVMS } },
628    { "nsk",	PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,	{ ELFOSABI_NSK } },
629
630    /* unwind-related registers:  */
631    { "priunat",PSEUDO_FUNC_REG, { REG_PRIUNAT } }
632  };
633
634/* 41-bit nop opcodes (one per unit):  */
635static const bfd_vma nop[IA64_NUM_UNITS] =
636  {
637    0x0000000000LL,	/* NIL => break 0 */
638    0x0008000000LL,	/* I-unit nop */
639    0x0008000000LL,	/* M-unit nop */
640    0x4000000000LL,	/* B-unit nop */
641    0x0008000000LL,	/* F-unit nop */
642    0x0000000000LL,	/* L-"unit" nop immediate */
643    0x0008000000LL,	/* X-unit nop */
644  };
645
646/* Can't be `const' as it's passed to input routines (which have the
647   habit of setting temporary sentinels.  */
648static char special_section_name[][20] =
649  {
650    {".bss"}, {".sbss"}, {".sdata"}, {".rodata"}, {".comment"},
651    {".IA_64.unwind"}, {".IA_64.unwind_info"},
652    {".init_array"}, {".fini_array"}
653  };
654
655/* The best template for a particular sequence of up to three
656   instructions:  */
657#define N	IA64_NUM_TYPES
658static unsigned char best_template[N][N][N];
659#undef N
660
661/* Resource dependencies currently in effect */
662static struct rsrc {
663  int depind;                       /* dependency index */
664  const struct ia64_dependency *dependency; /* actual dependency */
665  unsigned specific:1,              /* is this a specific bit/regno? */
666    link_to_qp_branch:1;           /* will a branch on the same QP clear it?*/
667  int index;                        /* specific regno/bit within dependency */
668  int note;                         /* optional qualifying note (0 if none) */
669#define STATE_NONE 0
670#define STATE_STOP 1
671#define STATE_SRLZ 2
672  int insn_srlz;                    /* current insn serialization state */
673  int data_srlz;                    /* current data serialization state */
674  int qp_regno;                     /* qualifying predicate for this usage */
675  const char *file;                       /* what file marked this dependency */
676  unsigned int line;                /* what line marked this dependency */
677  struct mem_offset mem_offset;     /* optional memory offset hint */
678  enum { CMP_NONE, CMP_OR, CMP_AND } cmp_type; /* OR or AND compare? */
679  int path;                         /* corresponding code entry index */
680} *regdeps = NULL;
681static int regdepslen = 0;
682static int regdepstotlen = 0;
683static const char *dv_mode[] = { "RAW", "WAW", "WAR" };
684static const char *dv_sem[] = { "none", "implied", "impliedf",
685				"data", "instr", "specific", "stop", "other" };
686static const char *dv_cmp_type[] = { "none", "OR", "AND" };
687
688/* Current state of PR mutexation */
689static struct qpmutex {
690  valueT prmask;
691  int path;
692} *qp_mutexes = NULL;          /* QP mutex bitmasks */
693static int qp_mutexeslen = 0;
694static int qp_mutexestotlen = 0;
695static valueT qp_safe_across_calls = 0;
696
697/* Current state of PR implications */
698static struct qp_imply {
699  unsigned p1:6;
700  unsigned p2:6;
701  unsigned p2_branched:1;
702  int path;
703} *qp_implies = NULL;
704static int qp_implieslen = 0;
705static int qp_impliestotlen = 0;
706
707/* Keep track of static GR values so that indirect register usage can
708   sometimes be tracked.  */
709static struct gr {
710  unsigned known:1;
711  int path;
712  valueT value;
713} gr_values[128] = {
714  {
715    1,
716#ifdef INT_MAX
717    INT_MAX,
718#else
719    (((1 << (8 * sizeof(gr_values->path) - 2)) - 1) << 1) + 1,
720#endif
721    0
722  }
723};
724
725/* Remember the alignment frag.  */
726static fragS *align_frag;
727
728/* These are the routines required to output the various types of
729   unwind records.  */
730
731/* A slot_number is a frag address plus the slot index (0-2).  We use the
732   frag address here so that if there is a section switch in the middle of
733   a function, then instructions emitted to a different section are not
734   counted.  Since there may be more than one frag for a function, this
735   means we also need to keep track of which frag this address belongs to
736   so we can compute inter-frag distances.  This also nicely solves the
737   problem with nops emitted for align directives, which can't easily be
738   counted, but can easily be derived from frag sizes.  */
739
740typedef struct unw_rec_list {
741  unwind_record r;
742  unsigned long slot_number;
743  fragS *slot_frag;
744  struct unw_rec_list *next;
745} unw_rec_list;
746
747#define SLOT_NUM_NOT_SET        (unsigned)-1
748
749/* Linked list of saved prologue counts.  A very poor
750   implementation of a map from label numbers to prologue counts.  */
751typedef struct label_prologue_count
752{
753  struct label_prologue_count *next;
754  unsigned long label_number;
755  unsigned int prologue_count;
756} label_prologue_count;
757
758typedef struct proc_pending
759{
760  symbolS *sym;
761  struct proc_pending *next;
762} proc_pending;
763
764static struct
765{
766  /* Maintain a list of unwind entries for the current function.  */
767  unw_rec_list *list;
768  unw_rec_list *tail;
769
770  /* Any unwind entries that should be attached to the current slot
771     that an insn is being constructed for.  */
772  unw_rec_list *current_entry;
773
774  /* These are used to create the unwind table entry for this function.  */
775  proc_pending proc_pending;
776  symbolS *info;		/* pointer to unwind info */
777  symbolS *personality_routine;
778  segT saved_text_seg;
779  subsegT saved_text_subseg;
780  unsigned int force_unwind_entry : 1;	/* force generation of unwind entry? */
781
782  /* TRUE if processing unwind directives in a prologue region.  */
783  unsigned int prologue : 1;
784  unsigned int prologue_mask : 4;
785  unsigned int prologue_gr : 7;
786  unsigned int body : 1;
787  unsigned int insn : 1;
788  unsigned int prologue_count;	/* number of .prologues seen so far */
789  /* Prologue counts at previous .label_state directives.  */
790  struct label_prologue_count * saved_prologue_counts;
791
792  /* List of split up .save-s.  */
793  unw_p_record *pending_saves;
794} unwind;
795
796/* The input value is a negated offset from psp, and specifies an address
797   psp - offset.  The encoded value is psp + 16 - (4 * offset).  Thus we
798   must add 16 and divide by 4 to get the encoded value.  */
799
800#define ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET(OFFSET) (((OFFSET) + 16) / 4)
801
802typedef void (*vbyte_func) (int, char *, char *);
803
804/* Forward declarations:  */
805static void dot_alias (int);
806static int parse_operand_and_eval (expressionS *, int);
807static void emit_one_bundle (void);
808static bfd_reloc_code_real_type ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (struct symbol *,
809							  bfd_reloc_code_real_type);
810static void insn_group_break (int, int, int);
811static void add_qp_mutex (valueT);
812static void add_qp_imply (int, int);
813static void clear_qp_mutex (valueT);
814static void clear_qp_implies (valueT, valueT);
815static void print_dependency (const char *, int);
816static void instruction_serialization (void);
817static void data_serialization (void);
818static void output_R3_format (vbyte_func, unw_record_type, unsigned long);
819static void output_B3_format (vbyte_func, unsigned long, unsigned long);
820static void output_B4_format (vbyte_func, unw_record_type, unsigned long);
821static void free_saved_prologue_counts (void);
822
823/* Determine if application register REGNUM resides only in the integer
824   unit (as opposed to the memory unit).  */
825static int
826ar_is_only_in_integer_unit (int reg)
827{
828  reg -= REG_AR;
829  return reg >= 64 && reg <= 111;
830}
831
832/* Determine if application register REGNUM resides only in the memory
833   unit (as opposed to the integer unit).  */
834static int
835ar_is_only_in_memory_unit (int reg)
836{
837  reg -= REG_AR;
838  return reg >= 0 && reg <= 47;
839}
840
841/* Switch to section NAME and create section if necessary.  It's
842   rather ugly that we have to manipulate input_line_pointer but I
843   don't see any other way to accomplish the same thing without
844   changing obj-elf.c (which may be the Right Thing, in the end).  */
845static void
846set_section (char *name)
847{
848  char *saved_input_line_pointer;
849
850  saved_input_line_pointer = input_line_pointer;
851  input_line_pointer = name;
852  obj_elf_section (0);
853  input_line_pointer = saved_input_line_pointer;
854}
855
856/* Map 's' to SHF_IA_64_SHORT.  */
857
858bfd_vma
859ia64_elf_section_letter (int letter, const char **ptr_msg)
860{
861  if (letter == 's')
862    return SHF_IA_64_SHORT;
863  else if (letter == 'o')
864    return SHF_LINK_ORDER;
865#ifdef TE_VMS
866  else if (letter == 'O')
867    return SHF_IA_64_VMS_OVERLAID;
868  else if (letter == 'g')
869    return SHF_IA_64_VMS_GLOBAL;
870#endif
871
872  *ptr_msg = _("bad .section directive: want a,o,s,w,x,M,S,G,T in string");
873  return -1;
874}
875
876/* Map SHF_IA_64_SHORT to SEC_SMALL_DATA.  */
877
878flagword
879ia64_elf_section_flags (flagword flags,
880			bfd_vma attr,
881			int type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
882{
883  if (attr & SHF_IA_64_SHORT)
884    flags |= SEC_SMALL_DATA;
885  return flags;
886}
887
888int
889ia64_elf_section_type (const char *str, size_t len)
890{
891#define STREQ(s) ((len == sizeof (s) - 1) && (strncmp (str, s, sizeof (s) - 1) == 0))
892
893  if (STREQ (ELF_STRING_ia64_unwind_info))
894    return SHT_PROGBITS;
895
896  if (STREQ (ELF_STRING_ia64_unwind_info_once))
897    return SHT_PROGBITS;
898
899  if (STREQ (ELF_STRING_ia64_unwind))
900    return SHT_IA_64_UNWIND;
901
902  if (STREQ (ELF_STRING_ia64_unwind_once))
903    return SHT_IA_64_UNWIND;
904
905  if (STREQ ("unwind"))
906    return SHT_IA_64_UNWIND;
907
908  return -1;
909#undef STREQ
910}
911
912static unsigned int
913set_regstack (unsigned int ins,
914	      unsigned int locs,
915	      unsigned int outs,
916	      unsigned int rots)
917{
918  /* Size of frame.  */
919  unsigned int sof;
920
921  sof = ins + locs + outs;
922  if (sof > 96)
923    {
924      as_bad (_("Size of frame exceeds maximum of 96 registers"));
925      return 0;
926    }
927  if (rots > sof)
928    {
929      as_warn (_("Size of rotating registers exceeds frame size"));
930      return 0;
931    }
932  md.in.base = REG_GR + 32;
933  md.loc.base = md.in.base + ins;
934  md.out.base = md.loc.base + locs;
935
936  md.in.num_regs  = ins;
937  md.loc.num_regs = locs;
938  md.out.num_regs = outs;
939  md.rot.num_regs = rots;
940  return sof;
941}
942
943void
944ia64_flush_insns (void)
945{
946  struct label_fix *lfix;
947  segT saved_seg;
948  subsegT saved_subseg;
949  unw_rec_list *ptr;
950  bfd_boolean mark;
951
952  if (!md.last_text_seg)
953    return;
954
955  saved_seg = now_seg;
956  saved_subseg = now_subseg;
957
958  subseg_set (md.last_text_seg, 0);
959
960  while (md.num_slots_in_use > 0)
961    emit_one_bundle ();		/* force out queued instructions */
962
963  /* In case there are labels following the last instruction, resolve
964     those now.  */
965  mark = FALSE;
966  for (lfix = CURR_SLOT.label_fixups; lfix; lfix = lfix->next)
967    {
968      symbol_set_value_now (lfix->sym);
969      mark |= lfix->dw2_mark_labels;
970    }
971  if (mark)
972    {
973      dwarf2_where (&CURR_SLOT.debug_line);
974      CURR_SLOT.debug_line.flags |= DWARF2_FLAG_BASIC_BLOCK;
975      dwarf2_gen_line_info (frag_now_fix (), &CURR_SLOT.debug_line);
976      dwarf2_consume_line_info ();
977    }
978  CURR_SLOT.label_fixups = 0;
979
980  for (lfix = CURR_SLOT.tag_fixups; lfix; lfix = lfix->next)
981    symbol_set_value_now (lfix->sym);
982  CURR_SLOT.tag_fixups = 0;
983
984  /* In case there are unwind directives following the last instruction,
985     resolve those now.  We only handle prologue, body, and endp directives
986     here.  Give an error for others.  */
987  for (ptr = unwind.current_entry; ptr; ptr = ptr->next)
988    {
989      switch (ptr->r.type)
990	{
991	case prologue:
992	case prologue_gr:
993	case body:
994	case endp:
995	  ptr->slot_number = (unsigned long) frag_more (0);
996	  ptr->slot_frag = frag_now;
997	  break;
998
999	  /* Allow any record which doesn't have a "t" field (i.e.,
1000	     doesn't relate to a particular instruction).  */
1001	case unwabi:
1002	case br_gr:
1003	case copy_state:
1004	case fr_mem:
1005	case frgr_mem:
1006	case gr_gr:
1007	case gr_mem:
1008	case label_state:
1009	case rp_br:
1010	case spill_base:
1011	case spill_mask:
1012	  /* nothing */
1013	  break;
1014
1015	default:
1016	  as_bad (_("Unwind directive not followed by an instruction."));
1017	  break;
1018	}
1019    }
1020  unwind.current_entry = NULL;
1021
1022  subseg_set (saved_seg, saved_subseg);
1023
1024  if (md.qp.X_op == O_register)
1025    as_bad (_("qualifying predicate not followed by instruction"));
1026}
1027
1028void
1029ia64_cons_align (int nbytes)
1030{
1031  if (md.auto_align)
1032    {
1033      int log;
1034      for (log = 0; (nbytes & 1) != 1; nbytes >>= 1)
1035	log++;
1036
1037      do_align (log, NULL, 0, 0);
1038    }
1039}
1040
1041#ifdef TE_VMS
1042
1043/* .vms_common section, symbol, size, alignment  */
1044
1045static void
1046obj_elf_vms_common (int ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1047{
1048  const char *sec_name;
1049  char *sym_name;
1050  char c;
1051  offsetT size;
1052  offsetT cur_size;
1053  offsetT temp;
1054  symbolS *symbolP;
1055  segT current_seg = now_seg;
1056  subsegT current_subseg = now_subseg;
1057  offsetT log_align;
1058
1059  /* Section name.  */
1060  sec_name = obj_elf_section_name ();
1061  if (sec_name == NULL)
1062    return;
1063
1064  /* Symbol name.  */
1065  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
1066  if (*input_line_pointer == ',')
1067    {
1068      input_line_pointer++;
1069      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
1070    }
1071  else
1072    {
1073      as_bad (_("expected ',' after section name"));
1074      ignore_rest_of_line ();
1075      return;
1076    }
1077
1078  c = get_symbol_name (&sym_name);
1079
1080  if (input_line_pointer == sym_name)
1081    {
1082      (void) restore_line_pointer (c);
1083      as_bad (_("expected symbol name"));
1084      ignore_rest_of_line ();
1085      return;
1086    }
1087
1088  symbolP = symbol_find_or_make (sym_name);
1089  (void) restore_line_pointer (c);
1090
1091  if ((S_IS_DEFINED (symbolP) || symbol_equated_p (symbolP))
1092      && !S_IS_COMMON (symbolP))
1093    {
1094      as_bad (_("Ignoring attempt to re-define symbol"));
1095      ignore_rest_of_line ();
1096      return;
1097    }
1098
1099  /* Symbol size.  */
1100  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
1101  if (*input_line_pointer == ',')
1102    {
1103      input_line_pointer++;
1104      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
1105    }
1106  else
1107    {
1108      as_bad (_("expected ',' after symbol name"));
1109      ignore_rest_of_line ();
1110      return;
1111    }
1112
1113  temp = get_absolute_expression ();
1114  size = temp;
1115  size &= ((offsetT) 2 << (stdoutput->arch_info->bits_per_address - 1)) - 1;
1116  if (temp != size)
1117    {
1118      as_warn (_("size (%ld) out of range, ignored"), (long) temp);
1119      ignore_rest_of_line ();
1120      return;
1121    }
1122
1123  /* Alignment.  */
1124  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
1125  if (*input_line_pointer == ',')
1126    {
1127      input_line_pointer++;
1128      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
1129    }
1130  else
1131    {
1132      as_bad (_("expected ',' after symbol size"));
1133      ignore_rest_of_line ();
1134      return;
1135    }
1136
1137  log_align = get_absolute_expression ();
1138
1139  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
1140
1141  obj_elf_change_section
1142    (sec_name, SHT_NOBITS, 0,
1143     SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_IA_64_VMS_OVERLAID | SHF_IA_64_VMS_GLOBAL,
1144     0, NULL, 1, 0);
1145
1146  S_SET_VALUE (symbolP, 0);
1147  S_SET_SIZE (symbolP, size);
1148  S_SET_EXTERNAL (symbolP);
1149  S_SET_SEGMENT (symbolP, now_seg);
1150
1151  symbol_get_bfdsym (symbolP)->flags |= BSF_OBJECT;
1152
1153  record_alignment (now_seg, log_align);
1154
1155  cur_size = bfd_section_size (now_seg);
1156  if ((int) size > cur_size)
1157    {
1158      char *pfrag
1159        = frag_var (rs_fill, 1, 1, (relax_substateT)0, NULL,
1160                    (valueT)size - (valueT)cur_size, NULL);
1161      *pfrag = 0;
1162      bfd_set_section_size (now_seg, size);
1163    }
1164
1165  /* Switch back to current segment.  */
1166  subseg_set (current_seg, current_subseg);
1167
1168#ifdef md_elf_section_change_hook
1169  md_elf_section_change_hook ();
1170#endif
1171}
1172
1173#endif /* TE_VMS */
1174
1175/* Output COUNT bytes to a memory location.  */
1176static char *vbyte_mem_ptr = NULL;
1177
1178static void
1179output_vbyte_mem (int count, char *ptr, char *comment ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1180{
1181  int x;
1182  if (vbyte_mem_ptr == NULL)
1183    abort ();
1184
1185  if (count == 0)
1186    return;
1187  for (x = 0; x < count; x++)
1188    *(vbyte_mem_ptr++) = ptr[x];
1189}
1190
1191/* Count the number of bytes required for records.  */
1192static int vbyte_count = 0;
1193static void
1194count_output (int count,
1195	      char *ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1196	      char *comment ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1197{
1198  vbyte_count += count;
1199}
1200
1201static void
1202output_R1_format (vbyte_func f, unw_record_type rtype, int rlen)
1203{
1204  int r = 0;
1205  char byte;
1206  if (rlen > 0x1f)
1207    {
1208      output_R3_format (f, rtype, rlen);
1209      return;
1210    }
1211
1212  if (rtype == body)
1213    r = 1;
1214  else if (rtype != prologue)
1215    as_bad (_("record type is not valid"));
1216
1217  byte = UNW_R1 | (r << 5) | (rlen & 0x1f);
1218  (*f) (1, &byte, NULL);
1219}
1220
1221static void
1222output_R2_format (vbyte_func f, int mask, int grsave, unsigned long rlen)
1223{
1224  char bytes[20];
1225  int count = 2;
1226  mask = (mask & 0x0f);
1227  grsave = (grsave & 0x7f);
1228
1229  bytes[0] = (UNW_R2 | (mask >> 1));
1230  bytes[1] = (((mask & 0x01) << 7) | grsave);
1231  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 2, rlen, 0);
1232  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1233}
1234
1235static void
1236output_R3_format (vbyte_func f, unw_record_type rtype, unsigned long rlen)
1237{
1238  int r = 0, count;
1239  char bytes[20];
1240  if (rlen <= 0x1f)
1241    {
1242      output_R1_format (f, rtype, rlen);
1243      return;
1244    }
1245
1246  if (rtype == body)
1247    r = 1;
1248  else if (rtype != prologue)
1249    as_bad (_("record type is not valid"));
1250  bytes[0] = (UNW_R3 | r);
1251  count = output_leb128 (bytes + 1, rlen, 0);
1252  (*f) (count + 1, bytes, NULL);
1253}
1254
1255static void
1256output_P1_format (vbyte_func f, int brmask)
1257{
1258  char byte;
1259  byte = UNW_P1 | (brmask & 0x1f);
1260  (*f) (1, &byte, NULL);
1261}
1262
1263static void
1264output_P2_format (vbyte_func f, int brmask, int gr)
1265{
1266  char bytes[2];
1267  brmask = (brmask & 0x1f);
1268  bytes[0] = UNW_P2 | (brmask >> 1);
1269  bytes[1] = (((brmask & 1) << 7) | gr);
1270  (*f) (2, bytes, NULL);
1271}
1272
1273static void
1274output_P3_format (vbyte_func f, unw_record_type rtype, int reg)
1275{
1276  char bytes[2];
1277  int r = 0;
1278  reg = (reg & 0x7f);
1279  switch (rtype)
1280    {
1281    case psp_gr:
1282      r = 0;
1283      break;
1284    case rp_gr:
1285      r = 1;
1286      break;
1287    case pfs_gr:
1288      r = 2;
1289      break;
1290    case preds_gr:
1291      r = 3;
1292      break;
1293    case unat_gr:
1294      r = 4;
1295      break;
1296    case lc_gr:
1297      r = 5;
1298      break;
1299    case rp_br:
1300      r = 6;
1301      break;
1302    case rnat_gr:
1303      r = 7;
1304      break;
1305    case bsp_gr:
1306      r = 8;
1307      break;
1308    case bspstore_gr:
1309      r = 9;
1310      break;
1311    case fpsr_gr:
1312      r = 10;
1313      break;
1314    case priunat_gr:
1315      r = 11;
1316      break;
1317    default:
1318      as_bad (_("Invalid record type for P3 format."));
1319    }
1320  bytes[0] = (UNW_P3 | (r >> 1));
1321  bytes[1] = (((r & 1) << 7) | reg);
1322  (*f) (2, bytes, NULL);
1323}
1324
1325static void
1326output_P4_format (vbyte_func f, unsigned char *imask, unsigned long imask_size)
1327{
1328  imask[0] = UNW_P4;
1329  (*f) (imask_size, (char *) imask, NULL);
1330}
1331
1332static void
1333output_P5_format (vbyte_func f, int grmask, unsigned long frmask)
1334{
1335  char bytes[4];
1336  grmask = (grmask & 0x0f);
1337
1338  bytes[0] = UNW_P5;
1339  bytes[1] = ((grmask << 4) | ((frmask & 0x000f0000) >> 16));
1340  bytes[2] = ((frmask & 0x0000ff00) >> 8);
1341  bytes[3] = (frmask & 0x000000ff);
1342  (*f) (4, bytes, NULL);
1343}
1344
1345static void
1346output_P6_format (vbyte_func f, unw_record_type rtype, int rmask)
1347{
1348  char byte;
1349  int r = 0;
1350
1351  if (rtype == gr_mem)
1352    r = 1;
1353  else if (rtype != fr_mem)
1354    as_bad (_("Invalid record type for format P6"));
1355  byte = (UNW_P6 | (r << 4) | (rmask & 0x0f));
1356  (*f) (1, &byte, NULL);
1357}
1358
1359static void
1360output_P7_format (vbyte_func f,
1361		  unw_record_type rtype,
1362		  unsigned long w1,
1363		  unsigned long w2)
1364{
1365  char bytes[20];
1366  int count = 1;
1367  int r = 0;
1368  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 1, w1, 0);
1369  switch (rtype)
1370    {
1371    case mem_stack_f:
1372      r = 0;
1373      count += output_leb128 (bytes + count, w2 >> 4, 0);
1374      break;
1375    case mem_stack_v:
1376      r = 1;
1377      break;
1378    case spill_base:
1379      r = 2;
1380      break;
1381    case psp_sprel:
1382      r = 3;
1383      break;
1384    case rp_when:
1385      r = 4;
1386      break;
1387    case rp_psprel:
1388      r = 5;
1389      break;
1390    case pfs_when:
1391      r = 6;
1392      break;
1393    case pfs_psprel:
1394      r = 7;
1395      break;
1396    case preds_when:
1397      r = 8;
1398      break;
1399    case preds_psprel:
1400      r = 9;
1401      break;
1402    case lc_when:
1403      r = 10;
1404      break;
1405    case lc_psprel:
1406      r = 11;
1407      break;
1408    case unat_when:
1409      r = 12;
1410      break;
1411    case unat_psprel:
1412      r = 13;
1413      break;
1414    case fpsr_when:
1415      r = 14;
1416      break;
1417    case fpsr_psprel:
1418      r = 15;
1419      break;
1420    default:
1421      break;
1422    }
1423  bytes[0] = (UNW_P7 | r);
1424  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1425}
1426
1427static void
1428output_P8_format (vbyte_func f, unw_record_type rtype, unsigned long t)
1429{
1430  char bytes[20];
1431  int r = 0;
1432  int count = 2;
1433  bytes[0] = UNW_P8;
1434  switch (rtype)
1435    {
1436    case rp_sprel:
1437      r = 1;
1438      break;
1439    case pfs_sprel:
1440      r = 2;
1441      break;
1442    case preds_sprel:
1443      r = 3;
1444      break;
1445    case lc_sprel:
1446      r = 4;
1447      break;
1448    case unat_sprel:
1449      r = 5;
1450      break;
1451    case fpsr_sprel:
1452      r = 6;
1453      break;
1454    case bsp_when:
1455      r = 7;
1456      break;
1457    case bsp_psprel:
1458      r = 8;
1459      break;
1460    case bsp_sprel:
1461      r = 9;
1462      break;
1463    case bspstore_when:
1464      r = 10;
1465      break;
1466    case bspstore_psprel:
1467      r = 11;
1468      break;
1469    case bspstore_sprel:
1470      r = 12;
1471      break;
1472    case rnat_when:
1473      r = 13;
1474      break;
1475    case rnat_psprel:
1476      r = 14;
1477      break;
1478    case rnat_sprel:
1479      r = 15;
1480      break;
1481    case priunat_when_gr:
1482      r = 16;
1483      break;
1484    case priunat_psprel:
1485      r = 17;
1486      break;
1487    case priunat_sprel:
1488      r = 18;
1489      break;
1490    case priunat_when_mem:
1491      r = 19;
1492      break;
1493    default:
1494      break;
1495    }
1496  bytes[1] = r;
1497  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 2, t, 0);
1498  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1499}
1500
1501static void
1502output_P9_format (vbyte_func f, int grmask, int gr)
1503{
1504  char bytes[3];
1505  bytes[0] = UNW_P9;
1506  bytes[1] = (grmask & 0x0f);
1507  bytes[2] = (gr & 0x7f);
1508  (*f) (3, bytes, NULL);
1509}
1510
1511static void
1512output_P10_format (vbyte_func f, int abi, int context)
1513{
1514  char bytes[3];
1515  bytes[0] = UNW_P10;
1516  bytes[1] = (abi & 0xff);
1517  bytes[2] = (context & 0xff);
1518  (*f) (3, bytes, NULL);
1519}
1520
1521static void
1522output_B1_format (vbyte_func f, unw_record_type rtype, unsigned long label)
1523{
1524  char byte;
1525  int r = 0;
1526  if (label > 0x1f)
1527    {
1528      output_B4_format (f, rtype, label);
1529      return;
1530    }
1531  if (rtype == copy_state)
1532    r = 1;
1533  else if (rtype != label_state)
1534    as_bad (_("Invalid record type for format B1"));
1535
1536  byte = (UNW_B1 | (r << 5) | (label & 0x1f));
1537  (*f) (1, &byte, NULL);
1538}
1539
1540static void
1541output_B2_format (vbyte_func f, unsigned long ecount, unsigned long t)
1542{
1543  char bytes[20];
1544  int count = 1;
1545  if (ecount > 0x1f)
1546    {
1547      output_B3_format (f, ecount, t);
1548      return;
1549    }
1550  bytes[0] = (UNW_B2 | (ecount & 0x1f));
1551  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 1, t, 0);
1552  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1553}
1554
1555static void
1556output_B3_format (vbyte_func f, unsigned long ecount, unsigned long t)
1557{
1558  char bytes[20];
1559  int count = 1;
1560  if (ecount <= 0x1f)
1561    {
1562      output_B2_format (f, ecount, t);
1563      return;
1564    }
1565  bytes[0] = UNW_B3;
1566  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 1, t, 0);
1567  count += output_leb128 (bytes + count, ecount, 0);
1568  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1569}
1570
1571static void
1572output_B4_format (vbyte_func f, unw_record_type rtype, unsigned long label)
1573{
1574  char bytes[20];
1575  int r = 0;
1576  int count = 1;
1577  if (label <= 0x1f)
1578    {
1579      output_B1_format (f, rtype, label);
1580      return;
1581    }
1582
1583  if (rtype == copy_state)
1584    r = 1;
1585  else if (rtype != label_state)
1586    as_bad (_("Invalid record type for format B1"));
1587
1588  bytes[0] = (UNW_B4 | (r << 3));
1589  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 1, label, 0);
1590  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1591}
1592
1593static char
1594format_ab_reg (int ab, int reg)
1595{
1596  int ret;
1597  ab = (ab & 3);
1598  reg = (reg & 0x1f);
1599  ret = (ab << 5) | reg;
1600  return ret;
1601}
1602
1603static void
1604output_X1_format (vbyte_func f,
1605		  unw_record_type rtype,
1606		  int ab,
1607		  int reg,
1608		  unsigned long t,
1609		  unsigned long w1)
1610{
1611  char bytes[20];
1612  int r = 0;
1613  int count = 2;
1614  bytes[0] = UNW_X1;
1615
1616  if (rtype == spill_sprel)
1617    r = 1;
1618  else if (rtype != spill_psprel)
1619    as_bad (_("Invalid record type for format X1"));
1620  bytes[1] = ((r << 7) | format_ab_reg (ab, reg));
1621  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 2, t, 0);
1622  count += output_leb128 (bytes + count, w1, 0);
1623  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1624}
1625
1626static void
1627output_X2_format (vbyte_func f,
1628		  int ab,
1629		  int reg,
1630		  int x,
1631		  int y,
1632		  int treg,
1633		  unsigned long t)
1634{
1635  char bytes[20];
1636  int count = 3;
1637  bytes[0] = UNW_X2;
1638  bytes[1] = (((x & 1) << 7) | format_ab_reg (ab, reg));
1639  bytes[2] = (((y & 1) << 7) | (treg & 0x7f));
1640  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 3, t, 0);
1641  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1642}
1643
1644static void
1645output_X3_format (vbyte_func f,
1646		  unw_record_type rtype,
1647		  int qp,
1648		  int ab,
1649		  int reg,
1650		  unsigned long t,
1651		  unsigned long w1)
1652{
1653  char bytes[20];
1654  int r = 0;
1655  int count = 3;
1656  bytes[0] = UNW_X3;
1657
1658  if (rtype == spill_sprel_p)
1659    r = 1;
1660  else if (rtype != spill_psprel_p)
1661    as_bad (_("Invalid record type for format X3"));
1662  bytes[1] = ((r << 7) | (qp & 0x3f));
1663  bytes[2] = format_ab_reg (ab, reg);
1664  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 3, t, 0);
1665  count += output_leb128 (bytes + count, w1, 0);
1666  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1667}
1668
1669static void
1670output_X4_format (vbyte_func f,
1671		  int qp,
1672		  int ab,
1673		  int reg,
1674		  int x,
1675		  int y,
1676		  int treg,
1677		  unsigned long t)
1678{
1679  char bytes[20];
1680  int count = 4;
1681  bytes[0] = UNW_X4;
1682  bytes[1] = (qp & 0x3f);
1683  bytes[2] = (((x & 1) << 7) | format_ab_reg (ab, reg));
1684  bytes[3] = (((y & 1) << 7) | (treg & 0x7f));
1685  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 4, t, 0);
1686  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1687}
1688
1689/* This function checks whether there are any outstanding .save-s and
1690   discards them if so.  */
1691
1692static void
1693check_pending_save (void)
1694{
1695  if (unwind.pending_saves)
1696    {
1697      unw_rec_list *cur, *prev;
1698
1699      as_warn (_("Previous .save incomplete"));
1700      for (cur = unwind.list, prev = NULL; cur; )
1701	if (&cur->r.record.p == unwind.pending_saves)
1702	  {
1703	    if (prev)
1704	      prev->next = cur->next;
1705	    else
1706	      unwind.list = cur->next;
1707	    if (cur == unwind.tail)
1708	      unwind.tail = prev;
1709	    if (cur == unwind.current_entry)
1710	      unwind.current_entry = cur->next;
1711	    /* Don't free the first discarded record, it's being used as
1712	       terminator for (currently) br_gr and gr_gr processing, and
1713	       also prevents leaving a dangling pointer to it in its
1714	       predecessor.  */
1715	    cur->r.record.p.grmask = 0;
1716	    cur->r.record.p.brmask = 0;
1717	    cur->r.record.p.frmask = 0;
1718	    prev = cur->r.record.p.next;
1719	    cur->r.record.p.next = NULL;
1720	    cur = prev;
1721	    break;
1722	  }
1723	else
1724	  {
1725	    prev = cur;
1726	    cur = cur->next;
1727	  }
1728      while (cur)
1729	{
1730	  prev = cur;
1731	  cur = cur->r.record.p.next;
1732	  free (prev);
1733	}
1734      unwind.pending_saves = NULL;
1735    }
1736}
1737
1738/* This function allocates a record list structure, and initializes fields.  */
1739
1740static unw_rec_list *
1741alloc_record (unw_record_type t)
1742{
1743  unw_rec_list *ptr;
1744  ptr = XNEW (unw_rec_list);
1745  memset (ptr, 0, sizeof (*ptr));
1746  ptr->slot_number = SLOT_NUM_NOT_SET;
1747  ptr->r.type = t;
1748  return ptr;
1749}
1750
1751/* Dummy unwind record used for calculating the length of the last prologue or
1752   body region.  */
1753
1754static unw_rec_list *
1755output_endp (void)
1756{
1757  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (endp);
1758  return ptr;
1759}
1760
1761static unw_rec_list *
1762output_prologue (void)
1763{
1764  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (prologue);
1765  memset (&ptr->r.record.r.mask, 0, sizeof (ptr->r.record.r.mask));
1766  return ptr;
1767}
1768
1769static unw_rec_list *
1770output_prologue_gr (unsigned int saved_mask, unsigned int reg)
1771{
1772  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (prologue_gr);
1773  memset (&ptr->r.record.r.mask, 0, sizeof (ptr->r.record.r.mask));
1774  ptr->r.record.r.grmask = saved_mask;
1775  ptr->r.record.r.grsave = reg;
1776  return ptr;
1777}
1778
1779static unw_rec_list *
1780output_body (void)
1781{
1782  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (body);
1783  return ptr;
1784}
1785
1786static unw_rec_list *
1787output_mem_stack_f (unsigned int size)
1788{
1789  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (mem_stack_f);
1790  ptr->r.record.p.size = size;
1791  return ptr;
1792}
1793
1794static unw_rec_list *
1795output_mem_stack_v (void)
1796{
1797  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (mem_stack_v);
1798  return ptr;
1799}
1800
1801static unw_rec_list *
1802output_psp_gr (unsigned int gr)
1803{
1804  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (psp_gr);
1805  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
1806  return ptr;
1807}
1808
1809static unw_rec_list *
1810output_psp_sprel (unsigned int offset)
1811{
1812  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (psp_sprel);
1813  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
1814  return ptr;
1815}
1816
1817static unw_rec_list *
1818output_rp_when (void)
1819{
1820  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rp_when);
1821  return ptr;
1822}
1823
1824static unw_rec_list *
1825output_rp_gr (unsigned int gr)
1826{
1827  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rp_gr);
1828  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
1829  return ptr;
1830}
1831
1832static unw_rec_list *
1833output_rp_br (unsigned int br)
1834{
1835  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rp_br);
1836  ptr->r.record.p.r.br = br;
1837  return ptr;
1838}
1839
1840static unw_rec_list *
1841output_rp_psprel (unsigned int offset)
1842{
1843  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rp_psprel);
1844  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
1845  return ptr;
1846}
1847
1848static unw_rec_list *
1849output_rp_sprel (unsigned int offset)
1850{
1851  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rp_sprel);
1852  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
1853  return ptr;
1854}
1855
1856static unw_rec_list *
1857output_pfs_when (void)
1858{
1859  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (pfs_when);
1860  return ptr;
1861}
1862
1863static unw_rec_list *
1864output_pfs_gr (unsigned int gr)
1865{
1866  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (pfs_gr);
1867  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
1868  return ptr;
1869}
1870
1871static unw_rec_list *
1872output_pfs_psprel (unsigned int offset)
1873{
1874  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (pfs_psprel);
1875  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
1876  return ptr;
1877}
1878
1879static unw_rec_list *
1880output_pfs_sprel (unsigned int offset)
1881{
1882  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (pfs_sprel);
1883  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
1884  return ptr;
1885}
1886
1887static unw_rec_list *
1888output_preds_when (void)
1889{
1890  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (preds_when);
1891  return ptr;
1892}
1893
1894static unw_rec_list *
1895output_preds_gr (unsigned int gr)
1896{
1897  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (preds_gr);
1898  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
1899  return ptr;
1900}
1901
1902static unw_rec_list *
1903output_preds_psprel (unsigned int offset)
1904{
1905  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (preds_psprel);
1906  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
1907  return ptr;
1908}
1909
1910static unw_rec_list *
1911output_preds_sprel (unsigned int offset)
1912{
1913  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (preds_sprel);
1914  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
1915  return ptr;
1916}
1917
1918static unw_rec_list *
1919output_fr_mem (unsigned int mask)
1920{
1921  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (fr_mem);
1922  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
1923
1924  ptr->r.record.p.frmask = mask;
1925  unwind.pending_saves = &ptr->r.record.p;
1926  for (;;)
1927    {
1928      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
1929
1930      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
1931      mask &= ~(mask & (~mask + 1));
1932      if (!mask)
1933	return ptr;
1934      cur = alloc_record (fr_mem);
1935      cur->r.record.p.frmask = mask;
1936      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
1937      prev->r.record.p.frmask ^= mask;
1938      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
1939    }
1940}
1941
1942static unw_rec_list *
1943output_frgr_mem (unsigned int gr_mask, unsigned int fr_mask)
1944{
1945  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (frgr_mem);
1946  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
1947
1948  unwind.pending_saves = &cur->r.record.p;
1949  cur->r.record.p.frmask = fr_mask;
1950  while (fr_mask)
1951    {
1952      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
1953
1954      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
1955      fr_mask &= ~(fr_mask & (~fr_mask + 1));
1956      if (!gr_mask && !fr_mask)
1957	return ptr;
1958      cur = alloc_record (frgr_mem);
1959      cur->r.record.p.frmask = fr_mask;
1960      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
1961      prev->r.record.p.frmask ^= fr_mask;
1962      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
1963    }
1964  cur->r.record.p.grmask = gr_mask;
1965  for (;;)
1966    {
1967      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
1968
1969      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
1970      gr_mask &= ~(gr_mask & (~gr_mask + 1));
1971      if (!gr_mask)
1972	return ptr;
1973      cur = alloc_record (frgr_mem);
1974      cur->r.record.p.grmask = gr_mask;
1975      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
1976      prev->r.record.p.grmask ^= gr_mask;
1977      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
1978    }
1979}
1980
1981static unw_rec_list *
1982output_gr_gr (unsigned int mask, unsigned int reg)
1983{
1984  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (gr_gr);
1985  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
1986
1987  ptr->r.record.p.grmask = mask;
1988  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = reg;
1989  unwind.pending_saves = &ptr->r.record.p;
1990  for (;;)
1991    {
1992      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
1993
1994      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
1995      mask &= ~(mask & (~mask + 1));
1996      if (!mask)
1997	return ptr;
1998      cur = alloc_record (gr_gr);
1999      cur->r.record.p.grmask = mask;
2000      /* Indicate this record shouldn't be output.  */
2001      cur->r.record.p.r.gr = REG_NUM;
2002      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
2003      prev->r.record.p.grmask ^= mask;
2004      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
2005    }
2006}
2007
2008static unw_rec_list *
2009output_gr_mem (unsigned int mask)
2010{
2011  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (gr_mem);
2012  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
2013
2014  ptr->r.record.p.grmask = mask;
2015  unwind.pending_saves = &ptr->r.record.p;
2016  for (;;)
2017    {
2018      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
2019
2020      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
2021      mask &= ~(mask & (~mask + 1));
2022      if (!mask)
2023	return ptr;
2024      cur = alloc_record (gr_mem);
2025      cur->r.record.p.grmask = mask;
2026      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
2027      prev->r.record.p.grmask ^= mask;
2028      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
2029    }
2030}
2031
2032static unw_rec_list *
2033output_br_mem (unsigned int mask)
2034{
2035  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (br_mem);
2036  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
2037
2038  ptr->r.record.p.brmask = mask;
2039  unwind.pending_saves = &ptr->r.record.p;
2040  for (;;)
2041    {
2042      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
2043
2044      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
2045      mask &= ~(mask & (~mask + 1));
2046      if (!mask)
2047	return ptr;
2048      cur = alloc_record (br_mem);
2049      cur->r.record.p.brmask = mask;
2050      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
2051      prev->r.record.p.brmask ^= mask;
2052      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
2053    }
2054}
2055
2056static unw_rec_list *
2057output_br_gr (unsigned int mask, unsigned int reg)
2058{
2059  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (br_gr);
2060  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
2061
2062  ptr->r.record.p.brmask = mask;
2063  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = reg;
2064  unwind.pending_saves = &ptr->r.record.p;
2065  for (;;)
2066    {
2067      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
2068
2069      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
2070      mask &= ~(mask & (~mask + 1));
2071      if (!mask)
2072	return ptr;
2073      cur = alloc_record (br_gr);
2074      cur->r.record.p.brmask = mask;
2075      /* Indicate this record shouldn't be output.  */
2076      cur->r.record.p.r.gr = REG_NUM;
2077      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
2078      prev->r.record.p.brmask ^= mask;
2079      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
2080    }
2081}
2082
2083static unw_rec_list *
2084output_spill_base (unsigned int offset)
2085{
2086  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (spill_base);
2087  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2088  return ptr;
2089}
2090
2091static unw_rec_list *
2092output_unat_when (void)
2093{
2094  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (unat_when);
2095  return ptr;
2096}
2097
2098static unw_rec_list *
2099output_unat_gr (unsigned int gr)
2100{
2101  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (unat_gr);
2102  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2103  return ptr;
2104}
2105
2106static unw_rec_list *
2107output_unat_psprel (unsigned int offset)
2108{
2109  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (unat_psprel);
2110  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2111  return ptr;
2112}
2113
2114static unw_rec_list *
2115output_unat_sprel (unsigned int offset)
2116{
2117  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (unat_sprel);
2118  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2119  return ptr;
2120}
2121
2122static unw_rec_list *
2123output_lc_when (void)
2124{
2125  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (lc_when);
2126  return ptr;
2127}
2128
2129static unw_rec_list *
2130output_lc_gr (unsigned int gr)
2131{
2132  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (lc_gr);
2133  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2134  return ptr;
2135}
2136
2137static unw_rec_list *
2138output_lc_psprel (unsigned int offset)
2139{
2140  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (lc_psprel);
2141  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2142  return ptr;
2143}
2144
2145static unw_rec_list *
2146output_lc_sprel (unsigned int offset)
2147{
2148  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (lc_sprel);
2149  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2150  return ptr;
2151}
2152
2153static unw_rec_list *
2154output_fpsr_when (void)
2155{
2156  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (fpsr_when);
2157  return ptr;
2158}
2159
2160static unw_rec_list *
2161output_fpsr_gr (unsigned int gr)
2162{
2163  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (fpsr_gr);
2164  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2165  return ptr;
2166}
2167
2168static unw_rec_list *
2169output_fpsr_psprel (unsigned int offset)
2170{
2171  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (fpsr_psprel);
2172  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2173  return ptr;
2174}
2175
2176static unw_rec_list *
2177output_fpsr_sprel (unsigned int offset)
2178{
2179  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (fpsr_sprel);
2180  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2181  return ptr;
2182}
2183
2184static unw_rec_list *
2185output_priunat_when_gr (void)
2186{
2187  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (priunat_when_gr);
2188  return ptr;
2189}
2190
2191static unw_rec_list *
2192output_priunat_when_mem (void)
2193{
2194  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (priunat_when_mem);
2195  return ptr;
2196}
2197
2198static unw_rec_list *
2199output_priunat_gr (unsigned int gr)
2200{
2201  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (priunat_gr);
2202  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2203  return ptr;
2204}
2205
2206static unw_rec_list *
2207output_priunat_psprel (unsigned int offset)
2208{
2209  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (priunat_psprel);
2210  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2211  return ptr;
2212}
2213
2214static unw_rec_list *
2215output_priunat_sprel (unsigned int offset)
2216{
2217  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (priunat_sprel);
2218  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2219  return ptr;
2220}
2221
2222static unw_rec_list *
2223output_bsp_when (void)
2224{
2225  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bsp_when);
2226  return ptr;
2227}
2228
2229static unw_rec_list *
2230output_bsp_gr (unsigned int gr)
2231{
2232  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bsp_gr);
2233  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2234  return ptr;
2235}
2236
2237static unw_rec_list *
2238output_bsp_psprel (unsigned int offset)
2239{
2240  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bsp_psprel);
2241  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2242  return ptr;
2243}
2244
2245static unw_rec_list *
2246output_bsp_sprel (unsigned int offset)
2247{
2248  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bsp_sprel);
2249  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2250  return ptr;
2251}
2252
2253static unw_rec_list *
2254output_bspstore_when (void)
2255{
2256  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bspstore_when);
2257  return ptr;
2258}
2259
2260static unw_rec_list *
2261output_bspstore_gr (unsigned int gr)
2262{
2263  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bspstore_gr);
2264  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2265  return ptr;
2266}
2267
2268static unw_rec_list *
2269output_bspstore_psprel (unsigned int offset)
2270{
2271  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bspstore_psprel);
2272  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2273  return ptr;
2274}
2275
2276static unw_rec_list *
2277output_bspstore_sprel (unsigned int offset)
2278{
2279  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bspstore_sprel);
2280  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2281  return ptr;
2282}
2283
2284static unw_rec_list *
2285output_rnat_when (void)
2286{
2287  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rnat_when);
2288  return ptr;
2289}
2290
2291static unw_rec_list *
2292output_rnat_gr (unsigned int gr)
2293{
2294  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rnat_gr);
2295  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2296  return ptr;
2297}
2298
2299static unw_rec_list *
2300output_rnat_psprel (unsigned int offset)
2301{
2302  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rnat_psprel);
2303  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2304  return ptr;
2305}
2306
2307static unw_rec_list *
2308output_rnat_sprel (unsigned int offset)
2309{
2310  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rnat_sprel);
2311  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2312  return ptr;
2313}
2314
2315static unw_rec_list *
2316output_unwabi (unsigned long abi, unsigned long context)
2317{
2318  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (unwabi);
2319  ptr->r.record.p.abi = abi;
2320  ptr->r.record.p.context = context;
2321  return ptr;
2322}
2323
2324static unw_rec_list *
2325output_epilogue (unsigned long ecount)
2326{
2327  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (epilogue);
2328  ptr->r.record.b.ecount = ecount;
2329  return ptr;
2330}
2331
2332static unw_rec_list *
2333output_label_state (unsigned long label)
2334{
2335  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (label_state);
2336  ptr->r.record.b.label = label;
2337  return ptr;
2338}
2339
2340static unw_rec_list *
2341output_copy_state (unsigned long label)
2342{
2343  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (copy_state);
2344  ptr->r.record.b.label = label;
2345  return ptr;
2346}
2347
2348static unw_rec_list *
2349output_spill_psprel (unsigned int ab,
2350		     unsigned int reg,
2351		     unsigned int offset,
2352		     unsigned int predicate)
2353{
2354  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (predicate ? spill_psprel_p : spill_psprel);
2355  ptr->r.record.x.ab = ab;
2356  ptr->r.record.x.reg = reg;
2357  ptr->r.record.x.where.pspoff = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2358  ptr->r.record.x.qp = predicate;
2359  return ptr;
2360}
2361
2362static unw_rec_list *
2363output_spill_sprel (unsigned int ab,
2364		    unsigned int reg,
2365		    unsigned int offset,
2366		    unsigned int predicate)
2367{
2368  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (predicate ? spill_sprel_p : spill_sprel);
2369  ptr->r.record.x.ab = ab;
2370  ptr->r.record.x.reg = reg;
2371  ptr->r.record.x.where.spoff = offset / 4;
2372  ptr->r.record.x.qp = predicate;
2373  return ptr;
2374}
2375
2376static unw_rec_list *
2377output_spill_reg (unsigned int ab,
2378		  unsigned int reg,
2379		  unsigned int targ_reg,
2380		  unsigned int xy,
2381		  unsigned int predicate)
2382{
2383  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (predicate ? spill_reg_p : spill_reg);
2384  ptr->r.record.x.ab = ab;
2385  ptr->r.record.x.reg = reg;
2386  ptr->r.record.x.where.reg = targ_reg;
2387  ptr->r.record.x.xy = xy;
2388  ptr->r.record.x.qp = predicate;
2389  return ptr;
2390}
2391
2392/* Given a unw_rec_list process the correct format with the
2393   specified function.  */
2394
2395static void
2396process_one_record (unw_rec_list *ptr, vbyte_func f)
2397{
2398  unsigned int fr_mask, gr_mask;
2399
2400  switch (ptr->r.type)
2401    {
2402      /* This is a dummy record that takes up no space in the output.  */
2403    case endp:
2404      break;
2405
2406    case gr_mem:
2407    case fr_mem:
2408    case br_mem:
2409    case frgr_mem:
2410      /* These are taken care of by prologue/prologue_gr.  */
2411      break;
2412
2413    case prologue_gr:
2414    case prologue:
2415      if (ptr->r.type == prologue_gr)
2416	output_R2_format (f, ptr->r.record.r.grmask,
2417			  ptr->r.record.r.grsave, ptr->r.record.r.rlen);
2418      else
2419	output_R1_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.r.rlen);
2420
2421      /* Output descriptor(s) for union of register spills (if any).  */
2422      gr_mask = ptr->r.record.r.mask.gr_mem;
2423      fr_mask = ptr->r.record.r.mask.fr_mem;
2424      if (fr_mask)
2425	{
2426	  if ((fr_mask & ~0xfUL) == 0)
2427	    output_P6_format (f, fr_mem, fr_mask);
2428	  else
2429	    {
2430	      output_P5_format (f, gr_mask, fr_mask);
2431	      gr_mask = 0;
2432	    }
2433	}
2434      if (gr_mask)
2435	output_P6_format (f, gr_mem, gr_mask);
2436      if (ptr->r.record.r.mask.br_mem)
2437	output_P1_format (f, ptr->r.record.r.mask.br_mem);
2438
2439      /* output imask descriptor if necessary:  */
2440      if (ptr->r.record.r.mask.i)
2441	output_P4_format (f, ptr->r.record.r.mask.i,
2442			  ptr->r.record.r.imask_size);
2443      break;
2444
2445    case body:
2446      output_R1_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.r.rlen);
2447      break;
2448    case mem_stack_f:
2449    case mem_stack_v:
2450      output_P7_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.t,
2451			ptr->r.record.p.size);
2452      break;
2453    case psp_gr:
2454    case rp_gr:
2455    case pfs_gr:
2456    case preds_gr:
2457    case unat_gr:
2458    case lc_gr:
2459    case fpsr_gr:
2460    case priunat_gr:
2461    case bsp_gr:
2462    case bspstore_gr:
2463    case rnat_gr:
2464      output_P3_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.r.gr);
2465      break;
2466    case rp_br:
2467      output_P3_format (f, rp_br, ptr->r.record.p.r.br);
2468      break;
2469    case psp_sprel:
2470      output_P7_format (f, psp_sprel, ptr->r.record.p.off.sp, 0);
2471      break;
2472    case rp_when:
2473    case pfs_when:
2474    case preds_when:
2475    case unat_when:
2476    case lc_when:
2477    case fpsr_when:
2478      output_P7_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.t, 0);
2479      break;
2480    case rp_psprel:
2481    case pfs_psprel:
2482    case preds_psprel:
2483    case unat_psprel:
2484    case lc_psprel:
2485    case fpsr_psprel:
2486    case spill_base:
2487      output_P7_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.off.psp, 0);
2488      break;
2489    case rp_sprel:
2490    case pfs_sprel:
2491    case preds_sprel:
2492    case unat_sprel:
2493    case lc_sprel:
2494    case fpsr_sprel:
2495    case priunat_sprel:
2496    case bsp_sprel:
2497    case bspstore_sprel:
2498    case rnat_sprel:
2499      output_P8_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.off.sp);
2500      break;
2501    case gr_gr:
2502      if (ptr->r.record.p.r.gr < REG_NUM)
2503	{
2504	  const unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
2505
2506	  gr_mask = cur->r.record.p.grmask;
2507	  while ((cur = cur->r.record.p.next) != NULL)
2508	    gr_mask |= cur->r.record.p.grmask;
2509	  output_P9_format (f, gr_mask, ptr->r.record.p.r.gr);
2510	}
2511      break;
2512    case br_gr:
2513      if (ptr->r.record.p.r.gr < REG_NUM)
2514	{
2515	  const unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
2516
2517	  gr_mask = cur->r.record.p.brmask;
2518	  while ((cur = cur->r.record.p.next) != NULL)
2519	    gr_mask |= cur->r.record.p.brmask;
2520	  output_P2_format (f, gr_mask, ptr->r.record.p.r.gr);
2521	}
2522      break;
2523    case spill_mask:
2524      as_bad (_("spill_mask record unimplemented."));
2525      break;
2526    case priunat_when_gr:
2527    case priunat_when_mem:
2528    case bsp_when:
2529    case bspstore_when:
2530    case rnat_when:
2531      output_P8_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.t);
2532      break;
2533    case priunat_psprel:
2534    case bsp_psprel:
2535    case bspstore_psprel:
2536    case rnat_psprel:
2537      output_P8_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.off.psp);
2538      break;
2539    case unwabi:
2540      output_P10_format (f, ptr->r.record.p.abi, ptr->r.record.p.context);
2541      break;
2542    case epilogue:
2543      output_B3_format (f, ptr->r.record.b.ecount, ptr->r.record.b.t);
2544      break;
2545    case label_state:
2546    case copy_state:
2547      output_B4_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.b.label);
2548      break;
2549    case spill_psprel:
2550      output_X1_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.x.ab,
2551			ptr->r.record.x.reg, ptr->r.record.x.t,
2552			ptr->r.record.x.where.pspoff);
2553      break;
2554    case spill_sprel:
2555      output_X1_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.x.ab,
2556			ptr->r.record.x.reg, ptr->r.record.x.t,
2557			ptr->r.record.x.where.spoff);
2558      break;
2559    case spill_reg:
2560      output_X2_format (f, ptr->r.record.x.ab, ptr->r.record.x.reg,
2561			ptr->r.record.x.xy >> 1, ptr->r.record.x.xy,
2562			ptr->r.record.x.where.reg, ptr->r.record.x.t);
2563      break;
2564    case spill_psprel_p:
2565      output_X3_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.x.qp,
2566			ptr->r.record.x.ab, ptr->r.record.x.reg,
2567			ptr->r.record.x.t, ptr->r.record.x.where.pspoff);
2568      break;
2569    case spill_sprel_p:
2570      output_X3_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.x.qp,
2571			ptr->r.record.x.ab, ptr->r.record.x.reg,
2572			ptr->r.record.x.t, ptr->r.record.x.where.spoff);
2573      break;
2574    case spill_reg_p:
2575      output_X4_format (f, ptr->r.record.x.qp, ptr->r.record.x.ab,
2576			ptr->r.record.x.reg, ptr->r.record.x.xy >> 1,
2577			ptr->r.record.x.xy, ptr->r.record.x.where.reg,
2578			ptr->r.record.x.t);
2579      break;
2580    default:
2581      as_bad (_("record_type_not_valid"));
2582      break;
2583    }
2584}
2585
2586/* Given a unw_rec_list list, process all the records with
2587   the specified function.  */
2588static void
2589process_unw_records (unw_rec_list *list, vbyte_func f)
2590{
2591  unw_rec_list *ptr;
2592  for (ptr = list; ptr; ptr = ptr->next)
2593    process_one_record (ptr, f);
2594}
2595
2596/* Determine the size of a record list in bytes.  */
2597static int
2598calc_record_size (unw_rec_list *list)
2599{
2600  vbyte_count = 0;
2601  process_unw_records (list, count_output);
2602  return vbyte_count;
2603}
2604
2605/* Return the number of bits set in the input value.
2606   Perhaps this has a better place...  */
2607#if __GNUC__ > 3 || (__GNUC__ == 3 && __GNUC_MINOR__ >= 4)
2608# define popcount __builtin_popcount
2609#else
2610static int
2611popcount (unsigned x)
2612{
2613  static const unsigned char popcnt[16] =
2614    {
2615      0, 1, 1, 2,
2616      1, 2, 2, 3,
2617      1, 2, 2, 3,
2618      2, 3, 3, 4
2619    };
2620
2621  if (x < NELEMS (popcnt))
2622    return popcnt[x];
2623  return popcnt[x % NELEMS (popcnt)] + popcount (x / NELEMS (popcnt));
2624}
2625#endif
2626
2627/* Update IMASK bitmask to reflect the fact that one or more registers
2628   of type TYPE are saved starting at instruction with index T.  If N
2629   bits are set in REGMASK, it is assumed that instructions T through
2630   T+N-1 save these registers.
2631
2632   TYPE values:
2633	0: no save
2634	1: instruction saves next fp reg
2635	2: instruction saves next general reg
2636	3: instruction saves next branch reg */
2637static void
2638set_imask (unw_rec_list *region,
2639	   unsigned long regmask,
2640	   unsigned long t,
2641	   unsigned int type)
2642{
2643  unsigned char *imask;
2644  unsigned long imask_size;
2645  unsigned int i;
2646  int pos;
2647
2648  imask = region->r.record.r.mask.i;
2649  imask_size = region->r.record.r.imask_size;
2650  if (!imask)
2651    {
2652      imask_size = (region->r.record.r.rlen * 2 + 7) / 8 + 1;
2653      imask = XCNEWVEC (unsigned char, imask_size);
2654
2655      region->r.record.r.imask_size = imask_size;
2656      region->r.record.r.mask.i = imask;
2657    }
2658
2659  i = (t / 4) + 1;
2660  pos = 2 * (3 - t % 4);
2661  while (regmask)
2662    {
2663      if (i >= imask_size)
2664	{
2665	  as_bad (_("Ignoring attempt to spill beyond end of region"));
2666	  return;
2667	}
2668
2669      imask[i] |= (type & 0x3) << pos;
2670
2671      regmask &= (regmask - 1);
2672      pos -= 2;
2673      if (pos < 0)
2674	{
2675	  pos = 0;
2676	  ++i;
2677	}
2678    }
2679}
2680
2681/* Return the number of instruction slots from FIRST_ADDR to SLOT_ADDR.
2682   SLOT_FRAG is the frag containing SLOT_ADDR, and FIRST_FRAG is the frag
2683   containing FIRST_ADDR.  If BEFORE_RELAX, then we use worst-case estimates
2684   for frag sizes.  */
2685
2686static unsigned long
2687slot_index (unsigned long slot_addr,
2688	    fragS *slot_frag,
2689	    unsigned long first_addr,
2690	    fragS *first_frag,
2691	    int before_relax)
2692{
2693  unsigned long s_index = 0;
2694
2695  /* First time we are called, the initial address and frag are invalid.  */
2696  if (first_addr == 0)
2697    return 0;
2698
2699  /* If the two addresses are in different frags, then we need to add in
2700     the remaining size of this frag, and then the entire size of intermediate
2701     frags.  */
2702  while (slot_frag != first_frag)
2703    {
2704      unsigned long start_addr = (unsigned long) &first_frag->fr_literal;
2705
2706      if (! before_relax)
2707	{
2708	  /* We can get the final addresses only during and after
2709	     relaxation.  */
2710	  if (first_frag->fr_next && first_frag->fr_next->fr_address)
2711	    s_index += 3 * ((first_frag->fr_next->fr_address
2712			   - first_frag->fr_address
2713			     - first_frag->fr_fix) >> 4);
2714	}
2715      else
2716	/* We don't know what the final addresses will be. We try our
2717	   best to estimate.  */
2718	switch (first_frag->fr_type)
2719	  {
2720	  default:
2721	    break;
2722
2723	  case rs_space:
2724	    as_fatal (_("Only constant space allocation is supported"));
2725	    break;
2726
2727	  case rs_align:
2728	  case rs_align_code:
2729	  case rs_align_test:
2730	    /* Take alignment into account.  Assume the worst case
2731	       before relaxation.  */
2732	    s_index += 3 * ((1 << first_frag->fr_offset) >> 4);
2733	    break;
2734
2735	  case rs_org:
2736	    if (first_frag->fr_symbol)
2737	      {
2738		as_fatal (_("Only constant offsets are supported"));
2739		break;
2740	      }
2741	    /* Fall through.  */
2742	  case rs_fill:
2743	    s_index += 3 * (first_frag->fr_offset >> 4);
2744	    break;
2745	  }
2746
2747      /* Add in the full size of the frag converted to instruction slots.  */
2748      s_index += 3 * (first_frag->fr_fix >> 4);
2749      /* Subtract away the initial part before first_addr.  */
2750      s_index -= (3 * ((first_addr >> 4) - (start_addr >> 4))
2751		+ ((first_addr & 0x3) - (start_addr & 0x3)));
2752
2753      /* Move to the beginning of the next frag.  */
2754      first_frag = first_frag->fr_next;
2755      first_addr = (unsigned long) &first_frag->fr_literal;
2756
2757      /* This can happen if there is section switching in the middle of a
2758	 function, causing the frag chain for the function to be broken.
2759	 It is too difficult to recover safely from this problem, so we just
2760	 exit with an error.  */
2761      if (first_frag == NULL)
2762	as_fatal (_("Section switching in code is not supported."));
2763    }
2764
2765  /* Add in the used part of the last frag.  */
2766  s_index += (3 * ((slot_addr >> 4) - (first_addr >> 4))
2767	    + ((slot_addr & 0x3) - (first_addr & 0x3)));
2768  return s_index;
2769}
2770
2771/* Optimize unwind record directives.  */
2772
2773static unw_rec_list *
2774optimize_unw_records (unw_rec_list *list)
2775{
2776  if (!list)
2777    return NULL;
2778
2779  /* If the only unwind record is ".prologue" or ".prologue" followed
2780     by ".body", then we can optimize the unwind directives away.  */
2781  if (list->r.type == prologue
2782      && (list->next->r.type == endp
2783	  || (list->next->r.type == body && list->next->next->r.type == endp)))
2784    return NULL;
2785
2786  return list;
2787}
2788
2789/* Given a complete record list, process any records which have
2790   unresolved fields, (ie length counts for a prologue).  After
2791   this has been run, all necessary information should be available
2792   within each record to generate an image.  */
2793
2794static void
2795fixup_unw_records (unw_rec_list *list, int before_relax)
2796{
2797  unw_rec_list *ptr, *region = 0;
2798  unsigned long first_addr = 0, rlen = 0, t;
2799  fragS *first_frag = 0;
2800
2801  for (ptr = list; ptr; ptr = ptr->next)
2802    {
2803      if (ptr->slot_number == SLOT_NUM_NOT_SET)
2804	as_bad (_("Insn slot not set in unwind record."));
2805      t = slot_index (ptr->slot_number, ptr->slot_frag,
2806		      first_addr, first_frag, before_relax);
2807      switch (ptr->r.type)
2808	{
2809	case prologue:
2810	case prologue_gr:
2811	case body:
2812	  {
2813	    unw_rec_list *last;
2814	    int size;
2815	    unsigned long last_addr = 0;
2816	    fragS *last_frag = NULL;
2817
2818	    first_addr = ptr->slot_number;
2819	    first_frag = ptr->slot_frag;
2820	    /* Find either the next body/prologue start, or the end of
2821	       the function, and determine the size of the region.  */
2822	    for (last = ptr->next; last != NULL; last = last->next)
2823	      if (last->r.type == prologue || last->r.type == prologue_gr
2824		  || last->r.type == body || last->r.type == endp)
2825		{
2826		  last_addr = last->slot_number;
2827		  last_frag = last->slot_frag;
2828		  break;
2829		}
2830	    size = slot_index (last_addr, last_frag, first_addr, first_frag,
2831			       before_relax);
2832	    rlen = ptr->r.record.r.rlen = size;
2833	    if (ptr->r.type == body)
2834	      /* End of region.  */
2835	      region = 0;
2836	    else
2837	      region = ptr;
2838	    break;
2839	  }
2840	case epilogue:
2841	  if (t < rlen)
2842	    ptr->r.record.b.t = rlen - 1 - t;
2843	  else
2844	    /* This happens when a memory-stack-less procedure uses a
2845	       ".restore sp" directive at the end of a region to pop
2846	       the frame state.  */
2847	    ptr->r.record.b.t = 0;
2848	  break;
2849
2850	case mem_stack_f:
2851	case mem_stack_v:
2852	case rp_when:
2853	case pfs_when:
2854	case preds_when:
2855	case unat_when:
2856	case lc_when:
2857	case fpsr_when:
2858	case priunat_when_gr:
2859	case priunat_when_mem:
2860	case bsp_when:
2861	case bspstore_when:
2862	case rnat_when:
2863	  ptr->r.record.p.t = t;
2864	  break;
2865
2866	case spill_reg:
2867	case spill_sprel:
2868	case spill_psprel:
2869	case spill_reg_p:
2870	case spill_sprel_p:
2871	case spill_psprel_p:
2872	  ptr->r.record.x.t = t;
2873	  break;
2874
2875	case frgr_mem:
2876	  if (!region)
2877	    {
2878	      as_bad (_("frgr_mem record before region record!"));
2879	      return;
2880	    }
2881	  region->r.record.r.mask.fr_mem |= ptr->r.record.p.frmask;
2882	  region->r.record.r.mask.gr_mem |= ptr->r.record.p.grmask;
2883	  set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.frmask, t, 1);
2884	  set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.grmask, t, 2);
2885	  break;
2886	case fr_mem:
2887	  if (!region)
2888	    {
2889	      as_bad (_("fr_mem record before region record!"));
2890	      return;
2891	    }
2892	  region->r.record.r.mask.fr_mem |= ptr->r.record.p.frmask;
2893	  set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.frmask, t, 1);
2894	  break;
2895	case gr_mem:
2896	  if (!region)
2897	    {
2898	      as_bad (_("gr_mem record before region record!"));
2899	      return;
2900	    }
2901	  region->r.record.r.mask.gr_mem |= ptr->r.record.p.grmask;
2902	  set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.grmask, t, 2);
2903	  break;
2904	case br_mem:
2905	  if (!region)
2906	    {
2907	      as_bad (_("br_mem record before region record!"));
2908	      return;
2909	    }
2910	  region->r.record.r.mask.br_mem |= ptr->r.record.p.brmask;
2911	  set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.brmask, t, 3);
2912	  break;
2913
2914	case gr_gr:
2915	  if (!region)
2916	    {
2917	      as_bad (_("gr_gr record before region record!"));
2918	      return;
2919	    }
2920	  set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.grmask, t, 2);
2921	  break;
2922	case br_gr:
2923	  if (!region)
2924	    {
2925	      as_bad (_("br_gr record before region record!"));
2926	      return;
2927	    }
2928	  set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.brmask, t, 3);
2929	  break;
2930
2931	default:
2932	  break;
2933	}
2934    }
2935}
2936
2937/* Estimate the size of a frag before relaxing.  We only have one type of frag
2938   to handle here, which is the unwind info frag.  */
2939
2940int
2941ia64_estimate_size_before_relax (fragS *frag,
2942				 asection *segtype ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2943{
2944  unw_rec_list *list;
2945  int len, size, pad;
2946
2947  /* ??? This code is identical to the first part of ia64_convert_frag.  */
2948  list = (unw_rec_list *) frag->fr_opcode;
2949  fixup_unw_records (list, 0);
2950
2951  len = calc_record_size (list);
2952  /* pad to pointer-size boundary.  */
2953  pad = len % md.pointer_size;
2954  if (pad != 0)
2955    len += md.pointer_size - pad;
2956  /* Add 8 for the header.  */
2957  size = len + 8;
2958  /* Add a pointer for the personality offset.  */
2959  if (frag->fr_offset)
2960    size += md.pointer_size;
2961
2962  /* fr_var carries the max_chars that we created the fragment with.
2963     We must, of course, have allocated enough memory earlier.  */
2964  gas_assert (frag->fr_var >= size);
2965
2966  return frag->fr_fix + size;
2967}
2968
2969/* This function converts a rs_machine_dependent variant frag into a
2970  normal fill frag with the unwind image from the record list.  */
2971void
2972ia64_convert_frag (fragS *frag)
2973{
2974  unw_rec_list *list;
2975  int len, size, pad;
2976  valueT flag_value;
2977
2978  /* ??? This code is identical to ia64_estimate_size_before_relax.  */
2979  list = (unw_rec_list *) frag->fr_opcode;
2980  fixup_unw_records (list, 0);
2981
2982  len = calc_record_size (list);
2983  /* pad to pointer-size boundary.  */
2984  pad = len % md.pointer_size;
2985  if (pad != 0)
2986    len += md.pointer_size - pad;
2987  /* Add 8 for the header.  */
2988  size = len + 8;
2989  /* Add a pointer for the personality offset.  */
2990  if (frag->fr_offset)
2991    size += md.pointer_size;
2992
2993  /* fr_var carries the max_chars that we created the fragment with.
2994     We must, of course, have allocated enough memory earlier.  */
2995  gas_assert (frag->fr_var >= size);
2996
2997  /* Initialize the header area. fr_offset is initialized with
2998     unwind.personality_routine.  */
2999  if (frag->fr_offset)
3000    {
3001      if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
3002	flag_value = (bfd_vma) 3 << 32;
3003      else
3004	/* 32-bit unwind info block.  */
3005	flag_value = (bfd_vma) 0x1003 << 32;
3006    }
3007  else
3008    flag_value = 0;
3009
3010 md_number_to_chars (frag->fr_literal,
3011		     (((bfd_vma) 1 << 48) /* Version.  */
3012		      | flag_value        /* U & E handler flags.  */
3013		      | (len / md.pointer_size)), /* Length.  */
3014		     8);
3015
3016  /* Skip the header.  */
3017  vbyte_mem_ptr = frag->fr_literal + 8;
3018  process_unw_records (list, output_vbyte_mem);
3019
3020  /* Fill the padding bytes with zeros.  */
3021  if (pad != 0)
3022    md_number_to_chars (frag->fr_literal + len + 8 - md.pointer_size + pad, 0,
3023			md.pointer_size - pad);
3024  /* Fill the unwind personality with zeros.  */
3025  if (frag->fr_offset)
3026    md_number_to_chars (frag->fr_literal + size - md.pointer_size, 0,
3027			md.pointer_size);
3028
3029  frag->fr_fix += size;
3030  frag->fr_type = rs_fill;
3031  frag->fr_var = 0;
3032  frag->fr_offset = 0;
3033}
3034
3035static int
3036parse_predicate_and_operand (expressionS *e, unsigned *qp, const char *po)
3037{
3038  int sep = parse_operand_and_eval (e, ',');
3039
3040  *qp = e->X_add_number - REG_P;
3041  if (e->X_op != O_register || *qp > 63)
3042    {
3043      as_bad (_("First operand to .%s must be a predicate"), po);
3044      *qp = 0;
3045    }
3046  else if (*qp == 0)
3047    as_warn (_("Pointless use of p0 as first operand to .%s"), po);
3048  if (sep == ',')
3049    sep = parse_operand_and_eval (e, ',');
3050  else
3051    e->X_op = O_absent;
3052  return sep;
3053}
3054
3055static void
3056convert_expr_to_ab_reg (const expressionS *e,
3057			unsigned int *ab,
3058			unsigned int *regp,
3059			const char *po,
3060			int n)
3061{
3062  unsigned int reg = e->X_add_number;
3063
3064  *ab = *regp = 0; /* Anything valid is good here.  */
3065
3066  if (e->X_op != O_register)
3067    reg = REG_GR; /* Anything invalid is good here.  */
3068
3069  if (reg >= (REG_GR + 4) && reg <= (REG_GR + 7))
3070    {
3071      *ab = 0;
3072      *regp = reg - REG_GR;
3073    }
3074  else if ((reg >= (REG_FR + 2) && reg <= (REG_FR + 5))
3075	   || (reg >= (REG_FR + 16) && reg <= (REG_FR + 31)))
3076    {
3077      *ab = 1;
3078      *regp = reg - REG_FR;
3079    }
3080  else if (reg >= (REG_BR + 1) && reg <= (REG_BR + 5))
3081    {
3082      *ab = 2;
3083      *regp = reg - REG_BR;
3084    }
3085  else
3086    {
3087      *ab = 3;
3088      switch (reg)
3089	{
3090	case REG_PR:		*regp =  0; break;
3091	case REG_PSP:		*regp =  1; break;
3092	case REG_PRIUNAT:	*regp =  2; break;
3093	case REG_BR + 0:	*regp =  3; break;
3094	case REG_AR + AR_BSP:	*regp =  4; break;
3095	case REG_AR + AR_BSPSTORE: *regp = 5; break;
3096	case REG_AR + AR_RNAT:	*regp =  6; break;
3097	case REG_AR + AR_UNAT:	*regp =  7; break;
3098	case REG_AR + AR_FPSR:	*regp =  8; break;
3099	case REG_AR + AR_PFS:	*regp =  9; break;
3100	case REG_AR + AR_LC:	*regp = 10; break;
3101
3102	default:
3103	  as_bad (_("Operand %d to .%s must be a preserved register"), n, po);
3104	  break;
3105	}
3106    }
3107}
3108
3109static void
3110convert_expr_to_xy_reg (const expressionS *e,
3111			unsigned int *xy,
3112			unsigned int *regp,
3113			const char *po,
3114			int n)
3115{
3116  unsigned int reg = e->X_add_number;
3117
3118  *xy = *regp = 0; /* Anything valid is good here.  */
3119
3120  if (e->X_op != O_register)
3121    reg = REG_GR; /* Anything invalid is good here.  */
3122
3123  if (reg >= (REG_GR + 1) && reg <= (REG_GR + 127))
3124    {
3125      *xy = 0;
3126      *regp = reg - REG_GR;
3127    }
3128  else if (reg >= (REG_FR + 2) && reg <= (REG_FR + 127))
3129    {
3130      *xy = 1;
3131      *regp = reg - REG_FR;
3132    }
3133  else if (reg >= REG_BR && reg <= (REG_BR + 7))
3134    {
3135      *xy = 2;
3136      *regp = reg - REG_BR;
3137    }
3138  else
3139    as_bad (_("Operand %d to .%s must be a writable register"), n, po);
3140}
3141
3142static void
3143dot_align (int arg)
3144{
3145  /* The current frag is an alignment frag.  */
3146  align_frag = frag_now;
3147  s_align_bytes (arg);
3148}
3149
3150static void
3151dot_radix (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3152{
3153  char *radix;
3154  int ch;
3155
3156  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
3157
3158  if (is_it_end_of_statement ())
3159    return;
3160  ch = get_symbol_name (&radix);
3161  ia64_canonicalize_symbol_name (radix);
3162  if (strcasecmp (radix, "C"))
3163    as_bad (_("Radix `%s' unsupported or invalid"), radix);
3164  (void) restore_line_pointer (ch);
3165  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
3166}
3167
3168/* Helper function for .loc directives.  If the assembler is not generating
3169   line number info, then we need to remember which instructions have a .loc
3170   directive, and only call dwarf2_gen_line_info for those instructions.  */
3171
3172static void
3173dot_loc (int x)
3174{
3175  CURR_SLOT.loc_directive_seen = 1;
3176  dwarf2_directive_loc (x);
3177}
3178
3179/* .sbss, .bss etc. are macros that expand into ".section SECNAME".  */
3180static void
3181dot_special_section (int which)
3182{
3183  set_section ((char *) special_section_name[which]);
3184}
3185
3186/* Return -1 for warning and 0 for error.  */
3187
3188static int
3189unwind_diagnostic (const char * region, const char *directive)
3190{
3191  if (md.unwind_check == unwind_check_warning)
3192    {
3193      as_warn (_(".%s outside of %s"), directive, region);
3194      return -1;
3195    }
3196  else
3197    {
3198      as_bad (_(".%s outside of %s"), directive, region);
3199      ignore_rest_of_line ();
3200      return 0;
3201    }
3202}
3203
3204/* Return 1 if a directive is in a procedure, -1 if a directive isn't in
3205   a procedure but the unwind directive check is set to warning, 0 if
3206   a directive isn't in a procedure and the unwind directive check is set
3207   to error.  */
3208
3209static int
3210in_procedure (const char *directive)
3211{
3212  if (unwind.proc_pending.sym
3213      && (!unwind.saved_text_seg || strcmp (directive, "endp") == 0))
3214    return 1;
3215  return unwind_diagnostic ("procedure", directive);
3216}
3217
3218/* Return 1 if a directive is in a prologue, -1 if a directive isn't in
3219   a prologue but the unwind directive check is set to warning, 0 if
3220   a directive isn't in a prologue and the unwind directive check is set
3221   to error.  */
3222
3223static int
3224in_prologue (const char *directive)
3225{
3226  int in = in_procedure (directive);
3227
3228  if (in > 0 && !unwind.prologue)
3229    in = unwind_diagnostic ("prologue", directive);
3230  check_pending_save ();
3231  return in;
3232}
3233
3234/* Return 1 if a directive is in a body, -1 if a directive isn't in
3235   a body but the unwind directive check is set to warning, 0 if
3236   a directive isn't in a body and the unwind directive check is set
3237   to error.  */
3238
3239static int
3240in_body (const char *directive)
3241{
3242  int in = in_procedure (directive);
3243
3244  if (in > 0 && !unwind.body)
3245    in = unwind_diagnostic ("body region", directive);
3246  return in;
3247}
3248
3249static void
3250add_unwind_entry (unw_rec_list *ptr, int sep)
3251{
3252  if (ptr)
3253    {
3254      if (unwind.tail)
3255	unwind.tail->next = ptr;
3256      else
3257	unwind.list = ptr;
3258      unwind.tail = ptr;
3259
3260      /* The current entry can in fact be a chain of unwind entries.  */
3261      if (unwind.current_entry == NULL)
3262	unwind.current_entry = ptr;
3263    }
3264
3265  /* The current entry can in fact be a chain of unwind entries.  */
3266  if (unwind.current_entry == NULL)
3267    unwind.current_entry = ptr;
3268
3269  if (sep == ',')
3270    {
3271      char *name;
3272      /* Parse a tag permitted for the current directive.  */
3273      int ch;
3274
3275      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
3276      ch = get_symbol_name (&name);
3277      /* FIXME: For now, just issue a warning that this isn't implemented.  */
3278      {
3279	static int warned;
3280
3281	if (!warned)
3282	  {
3283	    warned = 1;
3284	    as_warn (_("Tags on unwind pseudo-ops aren't supported, yet"));
3285	  }
3286      }
3287      (void) restore_line_pointer (ch);
3288    }
3289  if (sep != NOT_A_CHAR)
3290    demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
3291}
3292
3293static void
3294dot_fframe (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3295{
3296  expressionS e;
3297  int sep;
3298
3299  if (!in_prologue ("fframe"))
3300    return;
3301
3302  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
3303
3304  if (e.X_op != O_constant)
3305    {
3306      as_bad (_("First operand to .fframe must be a constant"));
3307      e.X_add_number = 0;
3308    }
3309  add_unwind_entry (output_mem_stack_f (e.X_add_number), sep);
3310}
3311
3312static void
3313dot_vframe (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3314{
3315  expressionS e;
3316  unsigned reg;
3317  int sep;
3318
3319  if (!in_prologue ("vframe"))
3320    return;
3321
3322  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
3323  reg = e.X_add_number - REG_GR;
3324  if (e.X_op != O_register || reg > 127)
3325    {
3326      as_bad (_("First operand to .vframe must be a general register"));
3327      reg = 0;
3328    }
3329  add_unwind_entry (output_mem_stack_v (), sep);
3330  if (! (unwind.prologue_mask & 2))
3331    add_unwind_entry (output_psp_gr (reg), NOT_A_CHAR);
3332  else if (reg != unwind.prologue_gr
3333		  + (unsigned) popcount (unwind.prologue_mask & -(2 << 1)))
3334    as_warn (_("Operand of .vframe contradicts .prologue"));
3335}
3336
3337static void
3338dot_vframesp (int psp)
3339{
3340  expressionS e;
3341  int sep;
3342
3343  if (psp)
3344    as_warn (_(".vframepsp is meaningless, assuming .vframesp was meant"));
3345
3346  if (!in_prologue ("vframesp"))
3347    return;
3348
3349  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
3350  if (e.X_op != O_constant)
3351    {
3352      as_bad (_("Operand to .vframesp must be a constant (sp-relative offset)"));
3353      e.X_add_number = 0;
3354    }
3355  add_unwind_entry (output_mem_stack_v (), sep);
3356  add_unwind_entry (output_psp_sprel (e.X_add_number), NOT_A_CHAR);
3357}
3358
3359static void
3360dot_save (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3361{
3362  expressionS e1, e2;
3363  unsigned reg1, reg2;
3364  int sep;
3365
3366  if (!in_prologue ("save"))
3367    return;
3368
3369  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e1, ',');
3370  if (sep == ',')
3371    sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e2, ',');
3372  else
3373    e2.X_op = O_absent;
3374
3375  reg1 = e1.X_add_number;
3376  /* Make sure it's a valid ar.xxx reg, OR its br0, aka 'rp'.  */
3377  if (e1.X_op != O_register)
3378    {
3379      as_bad (_("First operand to .save not a register"));
3380      reg1 = REG_PR; /* Anything valid is good here.  */
3381    }
3382  reg2 = e2.X_add_number - REG_GR;
3383  if (e2.X_op != O_register || reg2 > 127)
3384    {
3385      as_bad (_("Second operand to .save not a valid register"));
3386      reg2 = 0;
3387    }
3388  switch (reg1)
3389    {
3390    case REG_AR + AR_BSP:
3391      add_unwind_entry (output_bsp_when (), sep);
3392      add_unwind_entry (output_bsp_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3393      break;
3394    case REG_AR + AR_BSPSTORE:
3395      add_unwind_entry (output_bspstore_when (), sep);
3396      add_unwind_entry (output_bspstore_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3397      break;
3398    case REG_AR + AR_RNAT:
3399      add_unwind_entry (output_rnat_when (), sep);
3400      add_unwind_entry (output_rnat_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3401      break;
3402    case REG_AR + AR_UNAT:
3403      add_unwind_entry (output_unat_when (), sep);
3404      add_unwind_entry (output_unat_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3405      break;
3406    case REG_AR + AR_FPSR:
3407      add_unwind_entry (output_fpsr_when (), sep);
3408      add_unwind_entry (output_fpsr_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3409      break;
3410    case REG_AR + AR_PFS:
3411      add_unwind_entry (output_pfs_when (), sep);
3412      if (! (unwind.prologue_mask & 4))
3413	add_unwind_entry (output_pfs_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3414      else if (reg2 != unwind.prologue_gr
3415		       + (unsigned) popcount (unwind.prologue_mask & -(4 << 1)))
3416	as_warn (_("Second operand of .save contradicts .prologue"));
3417      break;
3418    case REG_AR + AR_LC:
3419      add_unwind_entry (output_lc_when (), sep);
3420      add_unwind_entry (output_lc_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3421      break;
3422    case REG_BR:
3423      add_unwind_entry (output_rp_when (), sep);
3424      if (! (unwind.prologue_mask & 8))
3425	add_unwind_entry (output_rp_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3426      else if (reg2 != unwind.prologue_gr)
3427	as_warn (_("Second operand of .save contradicts .prologue"));
3428      break;
3429    case REG_PR:
3430      add_unwind_entry (output_preds_when (), sep);
3431      if (! (unwind.prologue_mask & 1))
3432	add_unwind_entry (output_preds_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3433      else if (reg2 != unwind.prologue_gr
3434		       + (unsigned) popcount (unwind.prologue_mask & -(1 << 1)))
3435	as_warn (_("Second operand of .save contradicts .prologue"));
3436      break;
3437    case REG_PRIUNAT:
3438      add_unwind_entry (output_priunat_when_gr (), sep);
3439      add_unwind_entry (output_priunat_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3440      break;
3441    default:
3442      as_bad (_("First operand to .save not a valid register"));
3443      add_unwind_entry (NULL, sep);
3444      break;
3445    }
3446}
3447
3448static void
3449dot_restore (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3450{
3451  expressionS e1;
3452  unsigned long ecount;	/* # of _additional_ regions to pop */
3453  int sep;
3454
3455  if (!in_body ("restore"))
3456    return;
3457
3458  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e1, ',');
3459  if (e1.X_op != O_register || e1.X_add_number != REG_GR + 12)
3460    as_bad (_("First operand to .restore must be stack pointer (sp)"));
3461
3462  if (sep == ',')
3463    {
3464      expressionS e2;
3465
3466      sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e2, ',');
3467      if (e2.X_op != O_constant || e2.X_add_number < 0)
3468	{
3469	  as_bad (_("Second operand to .restore must be a constant >= 0"));
3470	  e2.X_add_number = 0;
3471	}
3472      ecount = e2.X_add_number;
3473    }
3474  else
3475    ecount = unwind.prologue_count - 1;
3476
3477  if (ecount >= unwind.prologue_count)
3478    {
3479      as_bad (_("Epilogue count of %lu exceeds number of nested prologues (%u)"),
3480	      ecount + 1, unwind.prologue_count);
3481      ecount = 0;
3482    }
3483
3484  add_unwind_entry (output_epilogue (ecount), sep);
3485
3486  if (ecount < unwind.prologue_count)
3487    unwind.prologue_count -= ecount + 1;
3488  else
3489    unwind.prologue_count = 0;
3490}
3491
3492static void
3493dot_restorereg (int pred)
3494{
3495  unsigned int qp, ab, reg;
3496  expressionS e;
3497  int sep;
3498  const char * const po = pred ? "restorereg.p" : "restorereg";
3499
3500  if (!in_procedure (po))
3501    return;
3502
3503  if (pred)
3504    sep = parse_predicate_and_operand (&e, &qp, po);
3505  else
3506    {
3507      sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
3508      qp = 0;
3509    }
3510  convert_expr_to_ab_reg (&e, &ab, &reg, po, 1 + pred);
3511
3512  add_unwind_entry (output_spill_reg (ab, reg, 0, 0, qp), sep);
3513}
3514
3515static const char *special_linkonce_name[] =
3516  {
3517    ".gnu.linkonce.ia64unw.", ".gnu.linkonce.ia64unwi."
3518  };
3519
3520static void
3521start_unwind_section (const segT text_seg, int sec_index)
3522{
3523  /*
3524    Use a slightly ugly scheme to derive the unwind section names from
3525    the text section name:
3526
3527    text sect.  unwind table sect.
3528    name:       name:                      comments:
3529    ----------  -----------------          --------------------------------
3530    .text       .IA_64.unwind
3531    .text.foo   .IA_64.unwind.text.foo
3532    .foo        .IA_64.unwind.foo
3533    .gnu.linkonce.t.foo
3534		.gnu.linkonce.ia64unw.foo
3535    _info       .IA_64.unwind_info         gas issues error message (ditto)
3536    _infoFOO    .IA_64.unwind_infoFOO      gas issues error message (ditto)
3537
3538    This mapping is done so that:
3539
3540	(a) An object file with unwind info only in .text will use
3541	    unwind section names .IA_64.unwind and .IA_64.unwind_info.
3542	    This follows the letter of the ABI and also ensures backwards
3543	    compatibility with older toolchains.
3544
3545	(b) An object file with unwind info in multiple text sections
3546	    will use separate unwind sections for each text section.
3547	    This allows us to properly set the "sh_info" and "sh_link"
3548	    fields in SHT_IA_64_UNWIND as required by the ABI and also
3549	    lets GNU ld support programs with multiple segments
3550	    containing unwind info (as might be the case for certain
3551	    embedded applications).
3552
3553	(c) An error is issued if there would be a name clash.
3554  */
3555
3556  const char *text_name, *sec_text_name;
3557  char *sec_name;
3558  const char *prefix = special_section_name [sec_index];
3559  const char *suffix;
3560
3561  sec_text_name = segment_name (text_seg);
3562  text_name = sec_text_name;
3563  if (strncmp (text_name, "_info", 5) == 0)
3564    {
3565      as_bad (_("Illegal section name `%s' (causes unwind section name clash)"),
3566	      text_name);
3567      ignore_rest_of_line ();
3568      return;
3569    }
3570  if (strcmp (text_name, ".text") == 0)
3571    text_name = "";
3572
3573  /* Build the unwind section name by appending the (possibly stripped)
3574     text section name to the unwind prefix.  */
3575  suffix = text_name;
3576  if (strncmp (text_name, ".gnu.linkonce.t.",
3577	       sizeof (".gnu.linkonce.t.") - 1) == 0)
3578    {
3579      prefix = special_linkonce_name [sec_index - SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND];
3580      suffix += sizeof (".gnu.linkonce.t.") - 1;
3581    }
3582
3583  sec_name = concat (prefix, suffix, NULL);
3584
3585  /* Handle COMDAT group.  */
3586  if ((text_seg->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE) != 0
3587      && (elf_section_flags (text_seg) & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
3588    {
3589      char *section;
3590      const char *group_name = elf_group_name (text_seg);
3591
3592      if (group_name == NULL)
3593	{
3594	  as_bad (_("Group section `%s' has no group signature"),
3595		  sec_text_name);
3596	  ignore_rest_of_line ();
3597	  free (sec_name);
3598	  return;
3599	}
3600
3601      /* We have to construct a fake section directive.  */
3602      section = concat (sec_name, ",\"aG\",@progbits,", group_name, ",comdat", NULL);
3603      set_section (section);
3604      free (section);
3605    }
3606  else
3607    {
3608      set_section (sec_name);
3609      bfd_set_section_flags (now_seg, SEC_LOAD | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_READONLY);
3610    }
3611
3612  elf_linked_to_section (now_seg) = text_seg;
3613  free (sec_name);
3614}
3615
3616static void
3617generate_unwind_image (const segT text_seg)
3618{
3619  int size, pad;
3620  unw_rec_list *list;
3621
3622  /* Mark the end of the unwind info, so that we can compute the size of the
3623     last unwind region.  */
3624  add_unwind_entry (output_endp (), NOT_A_CHAR);
3625
3626  /* Force out pending instructions, to make sure all unwind records have
3627     a valid slot_number field.  */
3628  ia64_flush_insns ();
3629
3630  /* Generate the unwind record.  */
3631  list = optimize_unw_records (unwind.list);
3632  fixup_unw_records (list, 1);
3633  size = calc_record_size (list);
3634
3635  if (size > 0 || unwind.force_unwind_entry)
3636    {
3637      unwind.force_unwind_entry = 0;
3638      /* pad to pointer-size boundary.  */
3639      pad = size % md.pointer_size;
3640      if (pad != 0)
3641	size += md.pointer_size - pad;
3642      /* Add 8 for the header.  */
3643      size += 8;
3644      /* Add a pointer for the personality offset.  */
3645      if (unwind.personality_routine)
3646	size += md.pointer_size;
3647    }
3648
3649  /* If there are unwind records, switch sections, and output the info.  */
3650  if (size != 0)
3651    {
3652      expressionS exp;
3653      bfd_reloc_code_real_type reloc;
3654
3655      start_unwind_section (text_seg, SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND_INFO);
3656
3657      /* Make sure the section has 4 byte alignment for ILP32 and
3658	 8 byte alignment for LP64.  */
3659      frag_align (md.pointer_size_shift, 0, 0);
3660      record_alignment (now_seg, md.pointer_size_shift);
3661
3662      /* Set expression which points to start of unwind descriptor area.  */
3663      unwind.info = expr_build_dot ();
3664
3665      frag_var (rs_machine_dependent, size, size, 0, 0,
3666		(offsetT) (long) unwind.personality_routine,
3667		(char *) list);
3668
3669      /* Add the personality address to the image.  */
3670      if (unwind.personality_routine != 0)
3671	{
3672	  exp.X_op = O_symbol;
3673	  exp.X_add_symbol = unwind.personality_routine;
3674	  exp.X_add_number = 0;
3675
3676	  if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_BE)
3677	    {
3678	      if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
3679		reloc = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64MSB;
3680	      else
3681		reloc = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR32MSB;
3682	    }
3683	  else
3684	    {
3685	      if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
3686		reloc = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64LSB;
3687	      else
3688		reloc = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR32LSB;
3689	    }
3690
3691	  fix_new_exp (frag_now, frag_now_fix () - md.pointer_size,
3692		       md.pointer_size, &exp, 0, reloc);
3693	  unwind.personality_routine = 0;
3694	}
3695    }
3696
3697  free_saved_prologue_counts ();
3698  unwind.list = unwind.tail = unwind.current_entry = NULL;
3699}
3700
3701static void
3702dot_handlerdata (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3703{
3704  if (!in_procedure ("handlerdata"))
3705    return;
3706  unwind.force_unwind_entry = 1;
3707
3708  /* Remember which segment we're in so we can switch back after .endp */
3709  unwind.saved_text_seg = now_seg;
3710  unwind.saved_text_subseg = now_subseg;
3711
3712  /* Generate unwind info into unwind-info section and then leave that
3713     section as the currently active one so dataXX directives go into
3714     the language specific data area of the unwind info block.  */
3715  generate_unwind_image (now_seg);
3716  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
3717}
3718
3719static void
3720dot_unwentry (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3721{
3722  if (!in_procedure ("unwentry"))
3723    return;
3724  unwind.force_unwind_entry = 1;
3725  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
3726}
3727
3728static void
3729dot_altrp (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3730{
3731  expressionS e;
3732  unsigned reg;
3733
3734  if (!in_prologue ("altrp"))
3735    return;
3736
3737  parse_operand_and_eval (&e, 0);
3738  reg = e.X_add_number - REG_BR;
3739  if (e.X_op != O_register || reg > 7)
3740    {
3741      as_bad (_("First operand to .altrp not a valid branch register"));
3742      reg = 0;
3743    }
3744  add_unwind_entry (output_rp_br (reg), 0);
3745}
3746
3747static void
3748dot_savemem (int psprel)
3749{
3750  expressionS e1, e2;
3751  int sep;
3752  int reg1, val;
3753  const char * const po = psprel ? "savepsp" : "savesp";
3754
3755  if (!in_prologue (po))
3756    return;
3757
3758  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e1, ',');
3759  if (sep == ',')
3760    sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e2, ',');
3761  else
3762    e2.X_op = O_absent;
3763
3764  reg1 = e1.X_add_number;
3765  val = e2.X_add_number;
3766
3767  /* Make sure it's a valid ar.xxx reg, OR its br0, aka 'rp'.  */
3768  if (e1.X_op != O_register)
3769    {
3770      as_bad (_("First operand to .%s not a register"), po);
3771      reg1 = REG_PR; /* Anything valid is good here.  */
3772    }
3773  if (e2.X_op != O_constant)
3774    {
3775      as_bad (_("Second operand to .%s not a constant"), po);
3776      val = 0;
3777    }
3778
3779  switch (reg1)
3780    {
3781    case REG_AR + AR_BSP:
3782      add_unwind_entry (output_bsp_when (), sep);
3783      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3784			 ? output_bsp_psprel
3785			 : output_bsp_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3786      break;
3787    case REG_AR + AR_BSPSTORE:
3788      add_unwind_entry (output_bspstore_when (), sep);
3789      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3790			 ? output_bspstore_psprel
3791			 : output_bspstore_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3792      break;
3793    case REG_AR + AR_RNAT:
3794      add_unwind_entry (output_rnat_when (), sep);
3795      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3796			 ? output_rnat_psprel
3797			 : output_rnat_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3798      break;
3799    case REG_AR + AR_UNAT:
3800      add_unwind_entry (output_unat_when (), sep);
3801      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3802			 ? output_unat_psprel
3803			 : output_unat_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3804      break;
3805    case REG_AR + AR_FPSR:
3806      add_unwind_entry (output_fpsr_when (), sep);
3807      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3808			 ? output_fpsr_psprel
3809			 : output_fpsr_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3810      break;
3811    case REG_AR + AR_PFS:
3812      add_unwind_entry (output_pfs_when (), sep);
3813      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3814			 ? output_pfs_psprel
3815			 : output_pfs_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3816      break;
3817    case REG_AR + AR_LC:
3818      add_unwind_entry (output_lc_when (), sep);
3819      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3820			 ? output_lc_psprel
3821			 : output_lc_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3822      break;
3823    case REG_BR:
3824      add_unwind_entry (output_rp_when (), sep);
3825      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3826			 ? output_rp_psprel
3827			 : output_rp_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3828      break;
3829    case REG_PR:
3830      add_unwind_entry (output_preds_when (), sep);
3831      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3832			 ? output_preds_psprel
3833			 : output_preds_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3834      break;
3835    case REG_PRIUNAT:
3836      add_unwind_entry (output_priunat_when_mem (), sep);
3837      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3838			 ? output_priunat_psprel
3839			 : output_priunat_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3840      break;
3841    default:
3842      as_bad (_("First operand to .%s not a valid register"), po);
3843      add_unwind_entry (NULL, sep);
3844      break;
3845    }
3846}
3847
3848static void
3849dot_saveg (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3850{
3851  expressionS e;
3852  unsigned grmask;
3853  int sep;
3854
3855  if (!in_prologue ("save.g"))
3856    return;
3857
3858  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
3859
3860  grmask = e.X_add_number;
3861  if (e.X_op != O_constant
3862      || e.X_add_number <= 0
3863      || e.X_add_number > 0xf)
3864    {
3865      as_bad (_("First operand to .save.g must be a positive 4-bit constant"));
3866      grmask = 0;
3867    }
3868
3869  if (sep == ',')
3870    {
3871      unsigned reg;
3872      int n = popcount (grmask);
3873
3874      parse_operand_and_eval (&e, 0);
3875      reg = e.X_add_number - REG_GR;
3876      if (e.X_op != O_register || reg > 127)
3877	{
3878	  as_bad (_("Second operand to .save.g must be a general register"));
3879	  reg = 0;
3880	}
3881      else if (reg > 128U - n)
3882	{
3883	  as_bad (_("Second operand to .save.g must be the first of %d general registers"), n);
3884	  reg = 0;
3885	}
3886      add_unwind_entry (output_gr_gr (grmask, reg), 0);
3887    }
3888  else
3889    add_unwind_entry (output_gr_mem (grmask), 0);
3890}
3891
3892static void
3893dot_savef (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3894{
3895  expressionS e;
3896
3897  if (!in_prologue ("save.f"))
3898    return;
3899
3900  parse_operand_and_eval (&e, 0);
3901
3902  if (e.X_op != O_constant
3903      || e.X_add_number <= 0
3904      || e.X_add_number > 0xfffff)
3905    {
3906      as_bad (_("Operand to .save.f must be a positive 20-bit constant"));
3907      e.X_add_number = 0;
3908    }
3909  add_unwind_entry (output_fr_mem (e.X_add_number), 0);
3910}
3911
3912static void
3913dot_saveb (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3914{
3915  expressionS e;
3916  unsigned brmask;
3917  int sep;
3918
3919  if (!in_prologue ("save.b"))
3920    return;
3921
3922  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
3923
3924  brmask = e.X_add_number;
3925  if (e.X_op != O_constant
3926      || e.X_add_number <= 0
3927      || e.X_add_number > 0x1f)
3928    {
3929      as_bad (_("First operand to .save.b must be a positive 5-bit constant"));
3930      brmask = 0;
3931    }
3932
3933  if (sep == ',')
3934    {
3935      unsigned reg;
3936      int n = popcount (brmask);
3937
3938      parse_operand_and_eval (&e, 0);
3939      reg = e.X_add_number - REG_GR;
3940      if (e.X_op != O_register || reg > 127)
3941	{
3942	  as_bad (_("Second operand to .save.b must be a general register"));
3943	  reg = 0;
3944	}
3945      else if (reg > 128U - n)
3946	{
3947	  as_bad (_("Second operand to .save.b must be the first of %d general registers"), n);
3948	  reg = 0;
3949	}
3950      add_unwind_entry (output_br_gr (brmask, reg), 0);
3951    }
3952  else
3953    add_unwind_entry (output_br_mem (brmask), 0);
3954}
3955
3956static void
3957dot_savegf (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3958{
3959  expressionS e1, e2;
3960
3961  if (!in_prologue ("save.gf"))
3962    return;
3963
3964  if (parse_operand_and_eval (&e1, ',') == ',')
3965    parse_operand_and_eval (&e2, 0);
3966  else
3967    e2.X_op = O_absent;
3968
3969  if (e1.X_op != O_constant
3970      || e1.X_add_number < 0
3971      || e1.X_add_number > 0xf)
3972    {
3973      as_bad (_("First operand to .save.gf must be a non-negative 4-bit constant"));
3974      e1.X_op = O_absent;
3975      e1.X_add_number = 0;
3976    }
3977  if (e2.X_op != O_constant
3978      || e2.X_add_number < 0
3979      || e2.X_add_number > 0xfffff)
3980    {
3981      as_bad (_("Second operand to .save.gf must be a non-negative 20-bit constant"));
3982      e2.X_op = O_absent;
3983      e2.X_add_number = 0;
3984    }
3985  if (e1.X_op == O_constant
3986      && e2.X_op == O_constant
3987      && e1.X_add_number == 0
3988      && e2.X_add_number == 0)
3989    as_bad (_("Operands to .save.gf may not be both zero"));
3990
3991  add_unwind_entry (output_frgr_mem (e1.X_add_number, e2.X_add_number), 0);
3992}
3993
3994static void
3995dot_spill (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3996{
3997  expressionS e;
3998
3999  if (!in_prologue ("spill"))
4000    return;
4001
4002  parse_operand_and_eval (&e, 0);
4003
4004  if (e.X_op != O_constant)
4005    {
4006      as_bad (_("Operand to .spill must be a constant"));
4007      e.X_add_number = 0;
4008    }
4009  add_unwind_entry (output_spill_base (e.X_add_number), 0);
4010}
4011
4012static void
4013dot_spillreg (int pred)
4014{
4015  int sep;
4016  unsigned int qp, ab, xy, reg, treg;
4017  expressionS e;
4018  const char * const po = pred ? "spillreg.p" : "spillreg";
4019
4020  if (!in_procedure (po))
4021    return;
4022
4023  if (pred)
4024    sep = parse_predicate_and_operand (&e, &qp, po);
4025  else
4026    {
4027      sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
4028      qp = 0;
4029    }
4030  convert_expr_to_ab_reg (&e, &ab, &reg, po, 1 + pred);
4031
4032  if (sep == ',')
4033    sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
4034  else
4035    e.X_op = O_absent;
4036  convert_expr_to_xy_reg (&e, &xy, &treg, po, 2 + pred);
4037
4038  add_unwind_entry (output_spill_reg (ab, reg, treg, xy, qp), sep);
4039}
4040
4041static void
4042dot_spillmem (int psprel)
4043{
4044  expressionS e;
4045  int pred = (psprel < 0), sep;
4046  unsigned int qp, ab, reg;
4047  const char * po;
4048
4049  if (pred)
4050    {
4051      psprel = ~psprel;
4052      po = psprel ? "spillpsp.p" : "spillsp.p";
4053    }
4054  else
4055    po = psprel ? "spillpsp" : "spillsp";
4056
4057  if (!in_procedure (po))
4058    return;
4059
4060  if (pred)
4061    sep = parse_predicate_and_operand (&e, &qp, po);
4062  else
4063    {
4064      sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
4065      qp = 0;
4066    }
4067  convert_expr_to_ab_reg (&e, &ab, &reg, po, 1 + pred);
4068
4069  if (sep == ',')
4070    sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
4071  else
4072    e.X_op = O_absent;
4073  if (e.X_op != O_constant)
4074    {
4075      as_bad (_("Operand %d to .%s must be a constant"), 2 + pred, po);
4076      e.X_add_number = 0;
4077    }
4078
4079  if (psprel)
4080    add_unwind_entry (output_spill_psprel (ab, reg, e.X_add_number, qp), sep);
4081  else
4082    add_unwind_entry (output_spill_sprel (ab, reg, e.X_add_number, qp), sep);
4083}
4084
4085static unsigned int
4086get_saved_prologue_count (unsigned long lbl)
4087{
4088  label_prologue_count *lpc = unwind.saved_prologue_counts;
4089
4090  while (lpc != NULL && lpc->label_number != lbl)
4091    lpc = lpc->next;
4092
4093  if (lpc != NULL)
4094    return lpc->prologue_count;
4095
4096  as_bad (_("Missing .label_state %ld"), lbl);
4097  return 1;
4098}
4099
4100static void
4101save_prologue_count (unsigned long lbl, unsigned int count)
4102{
4103  label_prologue_count *lpc = unwind.saved_prologue_counts;
4104
4105  while (lpc != NULL && lpc->label_number != lbl)
4106    lpc = lpc->next;
4107
4108  if (lpc != NULL)
4109    lpc->prologue_count = count;
4110  else
4111    {
4112      label_prologue_count *new_lpc = XNEW (label_prologue_count);
4113
4114      new_lpc->next = unwind.saved_prologue_counts;
4115      new_lpc->label_number = lbl;
4116      new_lpc->prologue_count = count;
4117      unwind.saved_prologue_counts = new_lpc;
4118    }
4119}
4120
4121static void
4122free_saved_prologue_counts (void)
4123{
4124  label_prologue_count *lpc = unwind.saved_prologue_counts;
4125  label_prologue_count *next;
4126
4127  while (lpc != NULL)
4128    {
4129      next = lpc->next;
4130      free (lpc);
4131      lpc = next;
4132    }
4133
4134  unwind.saved_prologue_counts = NULL;
4135}
4136
4137static void
4138dot_label_state (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4139{
4140  expressionS e;
4141
4142  if (!in_body ("label_state"))
4143    return;
4144
4145  parse_operand_and_eval (&e, 0);
4146  if (e.X_op == O_constant)
4147    save_prologue_count (e.X_add_number, unwind.prologue_count);
4148  else
4149    {
4150      as_bad (_("Operand to .label_state must be a constant"));
4151      e.X_add_number = 0;
4152    }
4153  add_unwind_entry (output_label_state (e.X_add_number), 0);
4154}
4155
4156static void
4157dot_copy_state (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4158{
4159  expressionS e;
4160
4161  if (!in_body ("copy_state"))
4162    return;
4163
4164  parse_operand_and_eval (&e, 0);
4165  if (e.X_op == O_constant)
4166    unwind.prologue_count = get_saved_prologue_count (e.X_add_number);
4167  else
4168    {
4169      as_bad (_("Operand to .copy_state must be a constant"));
4170      e.X_add_number = 0;
4171    }
4172  add_unwind_entry (output_copy_state (e.X_add_number), 0);
4173}
4174
4175static void
4176dot_unwabi (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4177{
4178  expressionS e1, e2;
4179  unsigned char sep;
4180
4181  if (!in_prologue ("unwabi"))
4182    return;
4183
4184  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e1, ',');
4185  if (sep == ',')
4186    parse_operand_and_eval (&e2, 0);
4187  else
4188    e2.X_op = O_absent;
4189
4190  if (e1.X_op != O_constant)
4191    {
4192      as_bad (_("First operand to .unwabi must be a constant"));
4193      e1.X_add_number = 0;
4194    }
4195
4196  if (e2.X_op != O_constant)
4197    {
4198      as_bad (_("Second operand to .unwabi must be a constant"));
4199      e2.X_add_number = 0;
4200    }
4201
4202  add_unwind_entry (output_unwabi (e1.X_add_number, e2.X_add_number), 0);
4203}
4204
4205static void
4206dot_personality (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4207{
4208  char *name, *p, c;
4209
4210  if (!in_procedure ("personality"))
4211    return;
4212  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4213  c = get_symbol_name (&name);
4214  p = input_line_pointer;
4215  unwind.personality_routine = symbol_find_or_make (name);
4216  unwind.force_unwind_entry = 1;
4217  *p = c;
4218  SKIP_WHITESPACE_AFTER_NAME ();
4219  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4220}
4221
4222static void
4223dot_proc (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4224{
4225  char *name, *p, c;
4226  symbolS *sym;
4227  proc_pending *pending, *last_pending;
4228
4229  if (unwind.proc_pending.sym)
4230    {
4231      (md.unwind_check == unwind_check_warning
4232       ? as_warn
4233       : as_bad) (_("Missing .endp after previous .proc"));
4234      while (unwind.proc_pending.next)
4235	{
4236	  pending = unwind.proc_pending.next;
4237	  unwind.proc_pending.next = pending->next;
4238	  free (pending);
4239	}
4240    }
4241  last_pending = NULL;
4242
4243  /* Parse names of main and alternate entry points and mark them as
4244     function symbols:  */
4245  while (1)
4246    {
4247      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4248      c = get_symbol_name (&name);
4249      p = input_line_pointer;
4250      if (!*name)
4251	as_bad (_("Empty argument of .proc"));
4252      else
4253	{
4254	  sym = symbol_find_or_make (name);
4255	  if (S_IS_DEFINED (sym))
4256	    as_bad (_("`%s' was already defined"), name);
4257	  else if (!last_pending)
4258	    {
4259	      unwind.proc_pending.sym = sym;
4260	      last_pending = &unwind.proc_pending;
4261	    }
4262	  else
4263	    {
4264	      pending = XNEW (proc_pending);
4265	      pending->sym = sym;
4266	      last_pending = last_pending->next = pending;
4267	    }
4268	  symbol_get_bfdsym (sym)->flags |= BSF_FUNCTION;
4269	}
4270      *p = c;
4271      SKIP_WHITESPACE_AFTER_NAME ();
4272      if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
4273	break;
4274      ++input_line_pointer;
4275    }
4276  if (!last_pending)
4277    {
4278      unwind.proc_pending.sym = expr_build_dot ();
4279      last_pending = &unwind.proc_pending;
4280    }
4281  last_pending->next = NULL;
4282  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4283  do_align (4, NULL, 0, 0);
4284
4285  unwind.prologue = 0;
4286  unwind.prologue_count = 0;
4287  unwind.body = 0;
4288  unwind.insn = 0;
4289  unwind.list = unwind.tail = unwind.current_entry = NULL;
4290  unwind.personality_routine = 0;
4291}
4292
4293static void
4294dot_body (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4295{
4296  if (!in_procedure ("body"))
4297    return;
4298  if (!unwind.prologue && !unwind.body && unwind.insn)
4299    as_warn (_("Initial .body should precede any instructions"));
4300  check_pending_save ();
4301
4302  unwind.prologue = 0;
4303  unwind.prologue_mask = 0;
4304  unwind.body = 1;
4305
4306  add_unwind_entry (output_body (), 0);
4307}
4308
4309static void
4310dot_prologue (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4311{
4312  unsigned mask = 0, grsave = 0;
4313
4314  if (!in_procedure ("prologue"))
4315    return;
4316  if (unwind.prologue)
4317    {
4318      as_bad (_(".prologue within prologue"));
4319      ignore_rest_of_line ();
4320      return;
4321    }
4322  if (!unwind.body && unwind.insn)
4323    as_warn (_("Initial .prologue should precede any instructions"));
4324
4325  if (!is_it_end_of_statement ())
4326    {
4327      expressionS e;
4328      int n, sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
4329
4330      if (e.X_op != O_constant
4331	  || e.X_add_number < 0
4332	  || e.X_add_number > 0xf)
4333	as_bad (_("First operand to .prologue must be a positive 4-bit constant"));
4334      else if (e.X_add_number == 0)
4335	as_warn (_("Pointless use of zero first operand to .prologue"));
4336      else
4337	mask = e.X_add_number;
4338
4339      n = popcount (mask);
4340
4341      if (sep == ',')
4342	parse_operand_and_eval (&e, 0);
4343      else
4344	e.X_op = O_absent;
4345
4346      if (e.X_op == O_constant
4347	  && e.X_add_number >= 0
4348	  && e.X_add_number < 128)
4349	{
4350	  if (md.unwind_check == unwind_check_error)
4351	    as_warn (_("Using a constant as second operand to .prologue is deprecated"));
4352	  grsave = e.X_add_number;
4353	}
4354      else if (e.X_op != O_register
4355	       || (grsave = e.X_add_number - REG_GR) > 127)
4356	{
4357	  as_bad (_("Second operand to .prologue must be a general register"));
4358	  grsave = 0;
4359	}
4360      else if (grsave > 128U - n)
4361	{
4362	  as_bad (_("Second operand to .prologue must be the first of %d general registers"), n);
4363	  grsave = 0;
4364	}
4365    }
4366
4367  if (mask)
4368    add_unwind_entry (output_prologue_gr (mask, grsave), 0);
4369  else
4370    add_unwind_entry (output_prologue (), 0);
4371
4372  unwind.prologue = 1;
4373  unwind.prologue_mask = mask;
4374  unwind.prologue_gr = grsave;
4375  unwind.body = 0;
4376  ++unwind.prologue_count;
4377}
4378
4379static void
4380dot_endp (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4381{
4382  expressionS e;
4383  int bytes_per_address;
4384  long where;
4385  segT saved_seg;
4386  subsegT saved_subseg;
4387  proc_pending *pending;
4388  int unwind_check = md.unwind_check;
4389
4390  md.unwind_check = unwind_check_error;
4391  if (!in_procedure ("endp"))
4392    return;
4393  md.unwind_check = unwind_check;
4394
4395  if (unwind.saved_text_seg)
4396    {
4397      saved_seg = unwind.saved_text_seg;
4398      saved_subseg = unwind.saved_text_subseg;
4399      unwind.saved_text_seg = NULL;
4400    }
4401  else
4402    {
4403      saved_seg = now_seg;
4404      saved_subseg = now_subseg;
4405    }
4406
4407  insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
4408
4409  /* If there wasn't a .handlerdata, we haven't generated an image yet.  */
4410  if (!unwind.info)
4411    generate_unwind_image (saved_seg);
4412
4413  if (unwind.info || unwind.force_unwind_entry)
4414    {
4415      symbolS *proc_end;
4416
4417      subseg_set (md.last_text_seg, 0);
4418      proc_end = expr_build_dot ();
4419
4420      start_unwind_section (saved_seg, SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND);
4421
4422      /* Make sure that section has 4 byte alignment for ILP32 and
4423         8 byte alignment for LP64.  */
4424      record_alignment (now_seg, md.pointer_size_shift);
4425
4426      /* Need space for 3 pointers for procedure start, procedure end,
4427	 and unwind info.  */
4428      memset (frag_more (3 * md.pointer_size), 0, 3 * md.pointer_size);
4429      where = frag_now_fix () - (3 * md.pointer_size);
4430      bytes_per_address = bfd_arch_bits_per_address (stdoutput) / 8;
4431
4432      /* Issue the values of  a) Proc Begin, b) Proc End, c) Unwind Record.  */
4433      e.X_op = O_pseudo_fixup;
4434      e.X_op_symbol = pseudo_func[FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE].u.sym;
4435      e.X_add_number = 0;
4436      if (!S_IS_LOCAL (unwind.proc_pending.sym)
4437	  && S_IS_DEFINED (unwind.proc_pending.sym))
4438	e.X_add_symbol = symbol_temp_new (S_GET_SEGMENT (unwind.proc_pending.sym),
4439					  S_GET_VALUE (unwind.proc_pending.sym),
4440					  symbol_get_frag (unwind.proc_pending.sym));
4441      else
4442	e.X_add_symbol = unwind.proc_pending.sym;
4443      ia64_cons_fix_new (frag_now, where, bytes_per_address, &e,
4444			 BFD_RELOC_NONE);
4445
4446      e.X_op = O_pseudo_fixup;
4447      e.X_op_symbol = pseudo_func[FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE].u.sym;
4448      e.X_add_number = 0;
4449      e.X_add_symbol = proc_end;
4450      ia64_cons_fix_new (frag_now, where + bytes_per_address,
4451			 bytes_per_address, &e, BFD_RELOC_NONE);
4452
4453      if (unwind.info)
4454	{
4455	  e.X_op = O_pseudo_fixup;
4456	  e.X_op_symbol = pseudo_func[FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE].u.sym;
4457	  e.X_add_number = 0;
4458	  e.X_add_symbol = unwind.info;
4459	  ia64_cons_fix_new (frag_now, where + (bytes_per_address * 2),
4460			     bytes_per_address, &e, BFD_RELOC_NONE);
4461	}
4462    }
4463  subseg_set (saved_seg, saved_subseg);
4464
4465  /* Set symbol sizes.  */
4466  pending = &unwind.proc_pending;
4467  if (S_GET_NAME (pending->sym))
4468    {
4469      do
4470	{
4471	  symbolS *sym = pending->sym;
4472
4473	  if (!S_IS_DEFINED (sym))
4474	    as_bad (_("`%s' was not defined within procedure"), S_GET_NAME (sym));
4475	  else if (S_GET_SIZE (sym) == 0
4476		   && symbol_get_obj (sym)->size == NULL)
4477	    {
4478	      fragS *frag = symbol_get_frag (sym);
4479
4480	      if (frag)
4481		{
4482		  if (frag == frag_now && SEG_NORMAL (now_seg))
4483		    S_SET_SIZE (sym, frag_now_fix () - S_GET_VALUE (sym));
4484		  else
4485		    {
4486		      symbol_get_obj (sym)->size = XNEW (expressionS);
4487		      symbol_get_obj (sym)->size->X_op = O_subtract;
4488		      symbol_get_obj (sym)->size->X_add_symbol
4489			= symbol_new (FAKE_LABEL_NAME, now_seg,
4490				      frag_now_fix (), frag_now);
4491		      symbol_get_obj (sym)->size->X_op_symbol = sym;
4492		      symbol_get_obj (sym)->size->X_add_number = 0;
4493		    }
4494		}
4495	    }
4496	} while ((pending = pending->next) != NULL);
4497    }
4498
4499  /* Parse names of main and alternate entry points.  */
4500  while (1)
4501    {
4502      char *name, *p, c;
4503
4504      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4505      c = get_symbol_name (&name);
4506      p = input_line_pointer;
4507      if (!*name)
4508	(md.unwind_check == unwind_check_warning
4509	 ? as_warn
4510	 : as_bad) (_("Empty argument of .endp"));
4511      else
4512	{
4513	  symbolS *sym = symbol_find (name);
4514
4515	  for (pending = &unwind.proc_pending; pending; pending = pending->next)
4516	    {
4517	      if (sym == pending->sym)
4518		{
4519		  pending->sym = NULL;
4520		  break;
4521		}
4522	    }
4523	  if (!sym || !pending)
4524	    as_warn (_("`%s' was not specified with previous .proc"), name);
4525	}
4526      *p = c;
4527      SKIP_WHITESPACE_AFTER_NAME ();
4528      if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
4529	break;
4530      ++input_line_pointer;
4531    }
4532  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4533
4534  /* Deliberately only checking for the main entry point here; the
4535     language spec even says all arguments to .endp are ignored.  */
4536  if (unwind.proc_pending.sym
4537      && S_GET_NAME (unwind.proc_pending.sym)
4538      && strcmp (S_GET_NAME (unwind.proc_pending.sym), FAKE_LABEL_NAME))
4539    as_warn (_("`%s' should be an operand to this .endp"),
4540	     S_GET_NAME (unwind.proc_pending.sym));
4541  while (unwind.proc_pending.next)
4542    {
4543      pending = unwind.proc_pending.next;
4544      unwind.proc_pending.next = pending->next;
4545      free (pending);
4546    }
4547  unwind.proc_pending.sym = unwind.info = NULL;
4548}
4549
4550static void
4551dot_template (int template_val)
4552{
4553  CURR_SLOT.user_template = template_val;
4554}
4555
4556static void
4557dot_regstk (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4558{
4559  int ins, locs, outs, rots;
4560
4561  if (is_it_end_of_statement ())
4562    ins = locs = outs = rots = 0;
4563  else
4564    {
4565      ins = get_absolute_expression ();
4566      if (*input_line_pointer++ != ',')
4567	goto err;
4568      locs = get_absolute_expression ();
4569      if (*input_line_pointer++ != ',')
4570	goto err;
4571      outs = get_absolute_expression ();
4572      if (*input_line_pointer++ != ',')
4573	goto err;
4574      rots = get_absolute_expression ();
4575    }
4576  set_regstack (ins, locs, outs, rots);
4577  return;
4578
4579 err:
4580  as_bad (_("Comma expected"));
4581  ignore_rest_of_line ();
4582}
4583
4584static void
4585dot_rot (int type)
4586{
4587  offsetT num_regs;
4588  valueT num_alloced = 0;
4589  struct dynreg **drpp, *dr;
4590  int ch, base_reg = 0;
4591  char *name, *start;
4592  size_t len;
4593
4594  switch (type)
4595    {
4596    case DYNREG_GR: base_reg = REG_GR + 32; break;
4597    case DYNREG_FR: base_reg = REG_FR + 32; break;
4598    case DYNREG_PR: base_reg = REG_P + 16; break;
4599    default: break;
4600    }
4601
4602  /* First, remove existing names from hash table.  */
4603  for (dr = md.dynreg[type]; dr && dr->num_regs; dr = dr->next)
4604    {
4605      hash_delete (md.dynreg_hash, dr->name, FALSE);
4606      /* FIXME: Free dr->name.  */
4607      dr->num_regs = 0;
4608    }
4609
4610  drpp = &md.dynreg[type];
4611  while (1)
4612    {
4613      ch = get_symbol_name (&start);
4614      len = strlen (ia64_canonicalize_symbol_name (start));
4615      *input_line_pointer = ch;
4616
4617      SKIP_WHITESPACE_AFTER_NAME ();
4618      if (*input_line_pointer != '[')
4619	{
4620	  as_bad (_("Expected '['"));
4621	  goto err;
4622	}
4623      ++input_line_pointer;	/* skip '[' */
4624
4625      num_regs = get_absolute_expression ();
4626
4627      if (*input_line_pointer++ != ']')
4628	{
4629	  as_bad (_("Expected ']'"));
4630	  goto err;
4631	}
4632      if (num_regs <= 0)
4633	{
4634	  as_bad (_("Number of elements must be positive"));
4635	  goto err;
4636	}
4637      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4638
4639      num_alloced += num_regs;
4640      switch (type)
4641	{
4642	case DYNREG_GR:
4643	  if (num_alloced > md.rot.num_regs)
4644	    {
4645	      as_bad (_("Used more than the declared %d rotating registers"),
4646		      md.rot.num_regs);
4647	      goto err;
4648	    }
4649	  break;
4650	case DYNREG_FR:
4651	  if (num_alloced > 96)
4652	    {
4653	      as_bad (_("Used more than the available 96 rotating registers"));
4654	      goto err;
4655	    }
4656	  break;
4657	case DYNREG_PR:
4658	  if (num_alloced > 48)
4659	    {
4660	      as_bad (_("Used more than the available 48 rotating registers"));
4661	      goto err;
4662	    }
4663	  break;
4664
4665	default:
4666	  break;
4667	}
4668
4669      if (!*drpp)
4670	{
4671	  *drpp = XOBNEW (&notes, struct dynreg);
4672	  memset (*drpp, 0, sizeof (*dr));
4673	}
4674
4675      name = XOBNEWVEC (&notes, char, len + 1);
4676      memcpy (name, start, len);
4677      name[len] = '\0';
4678
4679      dr = *drpp;
4680      dr->name = name;
4681      dr->num_regs = num_regs;
4682      dr->base = base_reg;
4683      drpp = &dr->next;
4684      base_reg += num_regs;
4685
4686      if (hash_insert (md.dynreg_hash, name, dr))
4687	{
4688	  as_bad (_("Attempt to redefine register set `%s'"), name);
4689	  obstack_free (&notes, name);
4690	  goto err;
4691	}
4692
4693      if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
4694	break;
4695      ++input_line_pointer;	/* skip comma */
4696      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4697    }
4698  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4699  return;
4700
4701 err:
4702  ignore_rest_of_line ();
4703}
4704
4705static void
4706dot_byteorder (int byteorder)
4707{
4708  segment_info_type *seginfo = seg_info (now_seg);
4709
4710  if (byteorder == -1)
4711    {
4712      if (seginfo->tc_segment_info_data.endian == 0)
4713	seginfo->tc_segment_info_data.endian = default_big_endian ? 1 : 2;
4714      byteorder = seginfo->tc_segment_info_data.endian == 1;
4715    }
4716  else
4717    seginfo->tc_segment_info_data.endian = byteorder ? 1 : 2;
4718
4719  if (target_big_endian != byteorder)
4720    {
4721      target_big_endian = byteorder;
4722      if (target_big_endian)
4723	{
4724	  ia64_number_to_chars = number_to_chars_bigendian;
4725	  ia64_float_to_chars = ia64_float_to_chars_bigendian;
4726	}
4727      else
4728	{
4729	  ia64_number_to_chars = number_to_chars_littleendian;
4730	  ia64_float_to_chars = ia64_float_to_chars_littleendian;
4731	}
4732    }
4733}
4734
4735static void
4736dot_psr (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4737{
4738  char *option;
4739  int ch;
4740
4741  while (1)
4742    {
4743      ch = get_symbol_name (&option);
4744      if (strcmp (option, "lsb") == 0)
4745	md.flags &= ~EF_IA_64_BE;
4746      else if (strcmp (option, "msb") == 0)
4747	md.flags |= EF_IA_64_BE;
4748      else if (strcmp (option, "abi32") == 0)
4749	md.flags &= ~EF_IA_64_ABI64;
4750      else if (strcmp (option, "abi64") == 0)
4751	md.flags |= EF_IA_64_ABI64;
4752      else
4753	as_bad (_("Unknown psr option `%s'"), option);
4754      *input_line_pointer = ch;
4755
4756      SKIP_WHITESPACE_AFTER_NAME ();
4757      if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
4758	break;
4759
4760      ++input_line_pointer;
4761      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4762    }
4763  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4764}
4765
4766static void
4767dot_ln (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4768{
4769  new_logical_line (0, get_absolute_expression ());
4770  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4771}
4772
4773static void
4774cross_section (int ref, void (*builder) (int), int ua)
4775{
4776  char *start, *end;
4777  int saved_auto_align;
4778  unsigned int section_count;
4779  char *name;
4780  char c;
4781
4782  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4783  start = input_line_pointer;
4784  c = get_symbol_name (&name);
4785  if (input_line_pointer == start)
4786    {
4787      as_bad (_("Missing section name"));
4788      ignore_rest_of_line ();
4789      return;
4790    }
4791  * input_line_pointer = c;
4792  SKIP_WHITESPACE_AFTER_NAME ();
4793  end = input_line_pointer;
4794  if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
4795    {
4796      as_bad (_("Comma expected after section name"));
4797      ignore_rest_of_line ();
4798      return;
4799    }
4800  *end = '\0';
4801  end = input_line_pointer + 1;		/* skip comma */
4802  input_line_pointer = start;
4803  md.keep_pending_output = 1;
4804  section_count = bfd_count_sections (stdoutput);
4805  obj_elf_section (0);
4806  if (section_count != bfd_count_sections (stdoutput))
4807    as_warn (_("Creating sections with .xdataN/.xrealN/.xstringZ is deprecated."));
4808  input_line_pointer = end;
4809  saved_auto_align = md.auto_align;
4810  if (ua)
4811    md.auto_align = 0;
4812  (*builder) (ref);
4813  if (ua)
4814    md.auto_align = saved_auto_align;
4815  obj_elf_previous (0);
4816  md.keep_pending_output = 0;
4817}
4818
4819static void
4820dot_xdata (int size)
4821{
4822  cross_section (size, cons, 0);
4823}
4824
4825/* Why doesn't float_cons() call md_cons_align() the way cons() does?  */
4826
4827static void
4828stmt_float_cons (int kind)
4829{
4830  size_t alignment;
4831
4832  switch (kind)
4833    {
4834    case 'd':
4835      alignment = 3;
4836      break;
4837
4838    case 'x':
4839    case 'X':
4840      alignment = 4;
4841      break;
4842
4843    case 'f':
4844    default:
4845      alignment = 2;
4846      break;
4847    }
4848  do_align (alignment, NULL, 0, 0);
4849  float_cons (kind);
4850}
4851
4852static void
4853stmt_cons_ua (int size)
4854{
4855  int saved_auto_align = md.auto_align;
4856
4857  md.auto_align = 0;
4858  cons (size);
4859  md.auto_align = saved_auto_align;
4860}
4861
4862static void
4863dot_xfloat_cons (int kind)
4864{
4865  cross_section (kind, stmt_float_cons, 0);
4866}
4867
4868static void
4869dot_xstringer (int zero)
4870{
4871  cross_section (zero, stringer, 0);
4872}
4873
4874static void
4875dot_xdata_ua (int size)
4876{
4877  cross_section (size, cons, 1);
4878}
4879
4880static void
4881dot_xfloat_cons_ua (int kind)
4882{
4883  cross_section (kind, float_cons, 1);
4884}
4885
4886/* .reg.val <regname>,value */
4887
4888static void
4889dot_reg_val (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4890{
4891  expressionS reg;
4892
4893  expression_and_evaluate (&reg);
4894  if (reg.X_op != O_register)
4895    {
4896      as_bad (_("Register name expected"));
4897      ignore_rest_of_line ();
4898    }
4899  else if (*input_line_pointer++ != ',')
4900    {
4901      as_bad (_("Comma expected"));
4902      ignore_rest_of_line ();
4903    }
4904  else
4905    {
4906      valueT value = get_absolute_expression ();
4907      int regno = reg.X_add_number;
4908      if (regno <= REG_GR || regno > REG_GR + 127)
4909	as_warn (_("Register value annotation ignored"));
4910      else
4911	{
4912	  gr_values[regno - REG_GR].known = 1;
4913	  gr_values[regno - REG_GR].value = value;
4914	  gr_values[regno - REG_GR].path = md.path;
4915	}
4916    }
4917  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4918}
4919
4920/*
4921  .serialize.data
4922  .serialize.instruction
4923 */
4924static void
4925dot_serialize (int type)
4926{
4927  insn_group_break (0, 0, 0);
4928  if (type)
4929    instruction_serialization ();
4930  else
4931    data_serialization ();
4932  insn_group_break (0, 0, 0);
4933  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4934}
4935
4936/* select dv checking mode
4937   .auto
4938   .explicit
4939   .default
4940
4941   A stop is inserted when changing modes
4942 */
4943
4944static void
4945dot_dv_mode (int type)
4946{
4947  if (md.manual_bundling)
4948    as_warn (_("Directive invalid within a bundle"));
4949
4950  if (type == 'E' || type == 'A')
4951    md.mode_explicitly_set = 0;
4952  else
4953    md.mode_explicitly_set = 1;
4954
4955  md.detect_dv = 1;
4956  switch (type)
4957    {
4958    case 'A':
4959    case 'a':
4960      if (md.explicit_mode)
4961	insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
4962      md.explicit_mode = 0;
4963      break;
4964    case 'E':
4965    case 'e':
4966      if (!md.explicit_mode)
4967	insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
4968      md.explicit_mode = 1;
4969      break;
4970    default:
4971    case 'd':
4972      if (md.explicit_mode != md.default_explicit_mode)
4973	insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
4974      md.explicit_mode = md.default_explicit_mode;
4975      md.mode_explicitly_set = 0;
4976      break;
4977    }
4978}
4979
4980static void
4981print_prmask (valueT mask)
4982{
4983  int regno;
4984  const char *comma = "";
4985  for (regno = 0; regno < 64; regno++)
4986    {
4987      if (mask & ((valueT) 1 << regno))
4988	{
4989	  fprintf (stderr, "%s p%d", comma, regno);
4990	  comma = ",";
4991	}
4992    }
4993}
4994
4995/*
4996  .pred.rel.clear [p1 [,p2 [,...]]]     (also .pred.rel "clear" or @clear)
4997  .pred.rel.imply p1, p2                (also .pred.rel "imply" or @imply)
4998  .pred.rel.mutex p1, p2 [,...]         (also .pred.rel "mutex" or @mutex)
4999  .pred.safe_across_calls p1 [, p2 [,...]]
5000 */
5001
5002static void
5003dot_pred_rel (int type)
5004{
5005  valueT mask = 0;
5006  int count = 0;
5007  int p1 = -1, p2 = -1;
5008
5009  if (type == 0)
5010    {
5011      if (*input_line_pointer == '"')
5012	{
5013	  int len;
5014	  char *form = demand_copy_C_string (&len);
5015
5016	  if (strcmp (form, "mutex") == 0)
5017	    type = 'm';
5018	  else if (strcmp (form, "clear") == 0)
5019	    type = 'c';
5020	  else if (strcmp (form, "imply") == 0)
5021	    type = 'i';
5022	  obstack_free (&notes, form);
5023	}
5024      else if (*input_line_pointer == '@')
5025	{
5026	  char *form;
5027	  char c;
5028
5029	  ++input_line_pointer;
5030	  c = get_symbol_name (&form);
5031
5032	  if (strcmp (form, "mutex") == 0)
5033	    type = 'm';
5034	  else if (strcmp (form, "clear") == 0)
5035	    type = 'c';
5036	  else if (strcmp (form, "imply") == 0)
5037	    type = 'i';
5038	  (void) restore_line_pointer (c);
5039	}
5040      else
5041	{
5042	  as_bad (_("Missing predicate relation type"));
5043	  ignore_rest_of_line ();
5044	  return;
5045	}
5046      if (type == 0)
5047	{
5048	  as_bad (_("Unrecognized predicate relation type"));
5049	  ignore_rest_of_line ();
5050	  return;
5051	}
5052      if (*input_line_pointer == ',')
5053	++input_line_pointer;
5054      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
5055    }
5056
5057  while (1)
5058    {
5059      valueT bits = 1;
5060      int sep, regno;
5061      expressionS pr, *pr1, *pr2;
5062
5063      sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&pr, ',');
5064      if (pr.X_op == O_register
5065	  && pr.X_add_number >= REG_P
5066	  && pr.X_add_number <= REG_P + 63)
5067	{
5068	  regno = pr.X_add_number - REG_P;
5069	  bits <<= regno;
5070	  count++;
5071	  if (p1 == -1)
5072	    p1 = regno;
5073	  else if (p2 == -1)
5074	    p2 = regno;
5075	}
5076      else if (type != 'i'
5077	  && pr.X_op == O_subtract
5078	  && (pr1 = symbol_get_value_expression (pr.X_add_symbol))
5079	  && pr1->X_op == O_register
5080	  && pr1->X_add_number >= REG_P
5081	  && pr1->X_add_number <= REG_P + 63
5082	  && (pr2 = symbol_get_value_expression (pr.X_op_symbol))
5083	  && pr2->X_op == O_register
5084	  && pr2->X_add_number >= REG_P
5085	  && pr2->X_add_number <= REG_P + 63)
5086	{
5087	  /* It's a range.  */
5088	  int stop;
5089
5090	  regno = pr1->X_add_number - REG_P;
5091	  stop = pr2->X_add_number - REG_P;
5092	  if (regno >= stop)
5093	    {
5094	      as_bad (_("Bad register range"));
5095	      ignore_rest_of_line ();
5096	      return;
5097	    }
5098	  bits = ((bits << stop) << 1) - (bits << regno);
5099	  count += stop - regno + 1;
5100	}
5101      else
5102	{
5103	  as_bad (_("Predicate register expected"));
5104	  ignore_rest_of_line ();
5105	  return;
5106	}
5107      if (mask & bits)
5108	as_warn (_("Duplicate predicate register ignored"));
5109      mask |= bits;
5110      if (sep != ',')
5111	break;
5112    }
5113
5114  switch (type)
5115    {
5116    case 'c':
5117      if (count == 0)
5118	mask = ~(valueT) 0;
5119      clear_qp_mutex (mask);
5120      clear_qp_implies (mask, (valueT) 0);
5121      break;
5122    case 'i':
5123      if (count != 2 || p1 == -1 || p2 == -1)
5124	as_bad (_("Predicate source and target required"));
5125      else if (p1 == 0 || p2 == 0)
5126	as_bad (_("Use of p0 is not valid in this context"));
5127      else
5128	add_qp_imply (p1, p2);
5129      break;
5130    case 'm':
5131      if (count < 2)
5132	{
5133	  as_bad (_("At least two PR arguments expected"));
5134	  break;
5135	}
5136      else if (mask & 1)
5137	{
5138	  as_bad (_("Use of p0 is not valid in this context"));
5139	  break;
5140	}
5141      add_qp_mutex (mask);
5142      break;
5143    case 's':
5144      /* note that we don't override any existing relations */
5145      if (count == 0)
5146	{
5147	  as_bad (_("At least one PR argument expected"));
5148	  break;
5149	}
5150      if (md.debug_dv)
5151	{
5152	  fprintf (stderr, "Safe across calls: ");
5153	  print_prmask (mask);
5154	  fprintf (stderr, "\n");
5155	}
5156      qp_safe_across_calls = mask;
5157      break;
5158    }
5159  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
5160}
5161
5162/* .entry label [, label [, ...]]
5163   Hint to DV code that the given labels are to be considered entry points.
5164   Otherwise, only global labels are considered entry points.  */
5165
5166static void
5167dot_entry (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5168{
5169  const char *err;
5170  char *name;
5171  int c;
5172  symbolS *symbolP;
5173
5174  do
5175    {
5176      c = get_symbol_name (&name);
5177      symbolP = symbol_find_or_make (name);
5178
5179      err = hash_insert (md.entry_hash, S_GET_NAME (symbolP), (void *) symbolP);
5180      if (err)
5181	as_fatal (_("Inserting \"%s\" into entry hint table failed: %s"),
5182		  name, err);
5183
5184      *input_line_pointer = c;
5185      SKIP_WHITESPACE_AFTER_NAME ();
5186      c = *input_line_pointer;
5187      if (c == ',')
5188	{
5189	  input_line_pointer++;
5190	  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
5191	  if (*input_line_pointer == '\n')
5192	    c = '\n';
5193	}
5194    }
5195  while (c == ',');
5196
5197  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
5198}
5199
5200/* .mem.offset offset, base
5201   "base" is used to distinguish between offsets from a different base.  */
5202
5203static void
5204dot_mem_offset (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5205{
5206  md.mem_offset.hint = 1;
5207  md.mem_offset.offset = get_absolute_expression ();
5208  if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
5209    {
5210      as_bad (_("Comma expected"));
5211      ignore_rest_of_line ();
5212      return;
5213    }
5214  ++input_line_pointer;
5215  md.mem_offset.base = get_absolute_expression ();
5216  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
5217}
5218
5219/* ia64-specific pseudo-ops:  */
5220const pseudo_typeS md_pseudo_table[] =
5221  {
5222    { "radix", dot_radix, 0 },
5223    { "lcomm", s_lcomm_bytes, 1 },
5224    { "loc", dot_loc, 0 },
5225    { "bss", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_BSS },
5226    { "sbss", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_SBSS },
5227    { "sdata", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_SDATA },
5228    { "rodata", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_RODATA },
5229    { "comment", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_COMMENT },
5230    { "ia_64.unwind", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND },
5231    { "ia_64.unwind_info", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND_INFO },
5232    { "init_array", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_INIT_ARRAY },
5233    { "fini_array", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_FINI_ARRAY },
5234    { "proc", dot_proc, 0 },
5235    { "body", dot_body, 0 },
5236    { "prologue", dot_prologue, 0 },
5237    { "endp", dot_endp, 0 },
5238
5239    { "fframe", dot_fframe, 0 },
5240    { "vframe", dot_vframe, 0 },
5241    { "vframesp", dot_vframesp, 0 },
5242    { "vframepsp", dot_vframesp, 1 },
5243    { "save", dot_save, 0 },
5244    { "restore", dot_restore, 0 },
5245    { "restorereg", dot_restorereg, 0 },
5246    { "restorereg.p", dot_restorereg, 1 },
5247    { "handlerdata", dot_handlerdata, 0 },
5248    { "unwentry", dot_unwentry, 0 },
5249    { "altrp", dot_altrp, 0 },
5250    { "savesp", dot_savemem, 0 },
5251    { "savepsp", dot_savemem, 1 },
5252    { "save.g", dot_saveg, 0 },
5253    { "save.f", dot_savef, 0 },
5254    { "save.b", dot_saveb, 0 },
5255    { "save.gf", dot_savegf, 0 },
5256    { "spill", dot_spill, 0 },
5257    { "spillreg", dot_spillreg, 0 },
5258    { "spillsp", dot_spillmem, 0 },
5259    { "spillpsp", dot_spillmem, 1 },
5260    { "spillreg.p", dot_spillreg, 1 },
5261    { "spillsp.p", dot_spillmem, ~0 },
5262    { "spillpsp.p", dot_spillmem, ~1 },
5263    { "label_state", dot_label_state, 0 },
5264    { "copy_state", dot_copy_state, 0 },
5265    { "unwabi", dot_unwabi, 0 },
5266    { "personality", dot_personality, 0 },
5267    { "mii", dot_template, 0x0 },
5268    { "mli", dot_template, 0x2 }, /* old format, for compatibility */
5269    { "mlx", dot_template, 0x2 },
5270    { "mmi", dot_template, 0x4 },
5271    { "mfi", dot_template, 0x6 },
5272    { "mmf", dot_template, 0x7 },
5273    { "mib", dot_template, 0x8 },
5274    { "mbb", dot_template, 0x9 },
5275    { "bbb", dot_template, 0xb },
5276    { "mmb", dot_template, 0xc },
5277    { "mfb", dot_template, 0xe },
5278    { "align", dot_align, 0 },
5279    { "regstk", dot_regstk, 0 },
5280    { "rotr", dot_rot, DYNREG_GR },
5281    { "rotf", dot_rot, DYNREG_FR },
5282    { "rotp", dot_rot, DYNREG_PR },
5283    { "lsb", dot_byteorder, 0 },
5284    { "msb", dot_byteorder, 1 },
5285    { "psr", dot_psr, 0 },
5286    { "alias", dot_alias, 0 },
5287    { "secalias", dot_alias, 1 },
5288    { "ln", dot_ln, 0 },		/* source line info (for debugging) */
5289
5290    { "xdata1", dot_xdata, 1 },
5291    { "xdata2", dot_xdata, 2 },
5292    { "xdata4", dot_xdata, 4 },
5293    { "xdata8", dot_xdata, 8 },
5294    { "xdata16", dot_xdata, 16 },
5295    { "xreal4", dot_xfloat_cons, 'f' },
5296    { "xreal8", dot_xfloat_cons, 'd' },
5297    { "xreal10", dot_xfloat_cons, 'x' },
5298    { "xreal16", dot_xfloat_cons, 'X' },
5299    { "xstring", dot_xstringer, 8 + 0 },
5300    { "xstringz", dot_xstringer, 8 + 1 },
5301
5302    /* unaligned versions:  */
5303    { "xdata2.ua", dot_xdata_ua, 2 },
5304    { "xdata4.ua", dot_xdata_ua, 4 },
5305    { "xdata8.ua", dot_xdata_ua, 8 },
5306    { "xdata16.ua", dot_xdata_ua, 16 },
5307    { "xreal4.ua", dot_xfloat_cons_ua, 'f' },
5308    { "xreal8.ua", dot_xfloat_cons_ua, 'd' },
5309    { "xreal10.ua", dot_xfloat_cons_ua, 'x' },
5310    { "xreal16.ua", dot_xfloat_cons_ua, 'X' },
5311
5312    /* annotations/DV checking support */
5313    { "entry", dot_entry, 0 },
5314    { "mem.offset", dot_mem_offset, 0 },
5315    { "pred.rel", dot_pred_rel, 0 },
5316    { "pred.rel.clear", dot_pred_rel, 'c' },
5317    { "pred.rel.imply", dot_pred_rel, 'i' },
5318    { "pred.rel.mutex", dot_pred_rel, 'm' },
5319    { "pred.safe_across_calls", dot_pred_rel, 's' },
5320    { "reg.val", dot_reg_val, 0 },
5321    { "serialize.data", dot_serialize, 0 },
5322    { "serialize.instruction", dot_serialize, 1 },
5323    { "auto", dot_dv_mode, 'a' },
5324    { "explicit", dot_dv_mode, 'e' },
5325    { "default", dot_dv_mode, 'd' },
5326
5327    /* ??? These are needed to make gas/testsuite/gas/elf/ehopt.s work.
5328       IA-64 aligns data allocation pseudo-ops by default, so we have to
5329       tell it that these ones are supposed to be unaligned.  Long term,
5330       should rewrite so that only IA-64 specific data allocation pseudo-ops
5331       are aligned by default.  */
5332    {"2byte", stmt_cons_ua, 2},
5333    {"4byte", stmt_cons_ua, 4},
5334    {"8byte", stmt_cons_ua, 8},
5335
5336#ifdef TE_VMS
5337    {"vms_common", obj_elf_vms_common, 0},
5338#endif
5339
5340    { NULL, 0, 0 }
5341  };
5342
5343static const struct pseudo_opcode
5344  {
5345    const char *name;
5346    void (*handler) (int);
5347    int arg;
5348  }
5349pseudo_opcode[] =
5350  {
5351    /* these are more like pseudo-ops, but don't start with a dot */
5352    { "data1", cons, 1 },
5353    { "data2", cons, 2 },
5354    { "data4", cons, 4 },
5355    { "data8", cons, 8 },
5356    { "data16", cons, 16 },
5357    { "real4", stmt_float_cons, 'f' },
5358    { "real8", stmt_float_cons, 'd' },
5359    { "real10", stmt_float_cons, 'x' },
5360    { "real16", stmt_float_cons, 'X' },
5361    { "string", stringer, 8 + 0 },
5362    { "stringz", stringer, 8 + 1 },
5363
5364    /* unaligned versions:  */
5365    { "data2.ua", stmt_cons_ua, 2 },
5366    { "data4.ua", stmt_cons_ua, 4 },
5367    { "data8.ua", stmt_cons_ua, 8 },
5368    { "data16.ua", stmt_cons_ua, 16 },
5369    { "real4.ua", float_cons, 'f' },
5370    { "real8.ua", float_cons, 'd' },
5371    { "real10.ua", float_cons, 'x' },
5372    { "real16.ua", float_cons, 'X' },
5373  };
5374
5375/* Declare a register by creating a symbol for it and entering it in
5376   the symbol table.  */
5377
5378static symbolS *
5379declare_register (const char *name, unsigned int regnum)
5380{
5381  const char *err;
5382  symbolS *sym;
5383
5384  sym = symbol_create (name, reg_section, regnum, &zero_address_frag);
5385
5386  err = hash_insert (md.reg_hash, S_GET_NAME (sym), (void *) sym);
5387  if (err)
5388    as_fatal ("Inserting \"%s\" into register table failed: %s",
5389	      name, err);
5390
5391  return sym;
5392}
5393
5394static void
5395declare_register_set (const char *prefix,
5396		      unsigned int num_regs,
5397		      unsigned int base_regnum)
5398{
5399  char name[8];
5400  unsigned int i;
5401
5402  for (i = 0; i < num_regs; ++i)
5403    {
5404      snprintf (name, sizeof (name), "%s%u", prefix, i);
5405      declare_register (name, base_regnum + i);
5406    }
5407}
5408
5409static unsigned int
5410operand_width (enum ia64_opnd opnd)
5411{
5412  const struct ia64_operand *odesc = &elf64_ia64_operands[opnd];
5413  unsigned int bits = 0;
5414  int i;
5415
5416  bits = 0;
5417  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (odesc->field) && odesc->field[i].bits; ++i)
5418    bits += odesc->field[i].bits;
5419
5420  return bits;
5421}
5422
5423static enum operand_match_result
5424operand_match (const struct ia64_opcode *idesc, int res_index, expressionS *e)
5425{
5426  enum ia64_opnd opnd = idesc->operands[res_index];
5427  int bits, relocatable = 0;
5428  struct insn_fix *fix;
5429  bfd_signed_vma val;
5430
5431  switch (opnd)
5432    {
5433      /* constants:  */
5434
5435    case IA64_OPND_AR_CCV:
5436      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_AR + 32)
5437	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5438      break;
5439
5440    case IA64_OPND_AR_CSD:
5441      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_AR + 25)
5442	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5443      break;
5444
5445    case IA64_OPND_AR_PFS:
5446      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_AR + 64)
5447	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5448      break;
5449
5450    case IA64_OPND_GR0:
5451      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_GR + 0)
5452	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5453      break;
5454
5455    case IA64_OPND_IP:
5456      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_IP)
5457	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5458      break;
5459
5460    case IA64_OPND_PR:
5461      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_PR)
5462	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5463      break;
5464
5465    case IA64_OPND_PR_ROT:
5466      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_PR_ROT)
5467	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5468      break;
5469
5470    case IA64_OPND_PSR:
5471      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_PSR)
5472	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5473      break;
5474
5475    case IA64_OPND_PSR_L:
5476      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_PSR_L)
5477	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5478      break;
5479
5480    case IA64_OPND_PSR_UM:
5481      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_PSR_UM)
5482	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5483      break;
5484
5485    case IA64_OPND_C1:
5486      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5487	{
5488	  if (e->X_add_number == 1)
5489	    return OPERAND_MATCH;
5490	  else
5491	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5492	}
5493      break;
5494
5495    case IA64_OPND_C8:
5496      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5497	{
5498	  if (e->X_add_number == 8)
5499	    return OPERAND_MATCH;
5500	  else
5501	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5502	}
5503      break;
5504
5505    case IA64_OPND_C16:
5506      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5507	{
5508	  if (e->X_add_number == 16)
5509	    return OPERAND_MATCH;
5510	  else
5511	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5512	}
5513      break;
5514
5515      /* register operands:  */
5516
5517    case IA64_OPND_AR3:
5518      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_AR
5519	  && e->X_add_number < REG_AR + 128)
5520	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5521      break;
5522
5523    case IA64_OPND_B1:
5524    case IA64_OPND_B2:
5525      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_BR
5526	  && e->X_add_number < REG_BR + 8)
5527	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5528      break;
5529
5530    case IA64_OPND_CR3:
5531      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_CR
5532	  && e->X_add_number < REG_CR + 128)
5533	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5534      break;
5535
5536    case IA64_OPND_DAHR3:
5537      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_DAHR
5538	  && e->X_add_number < REG_DAHR + 8)
5539	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5540      break;
5541
5542    case IA64_OPND_F1:
5543    case IA64_OPND_F2:
5544    case IA64_OPND_F3:
5545    case IA64_OPND_F4:
5546      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_FR
5547	  && e->X_add_number < REG_FR + 128)
5548	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5549      break;
5550
5551    case IA64_OPND_P1:
5552    case IA64_OPND_P2:
5553      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_P
5554	  && e->X_add_number < REG_P + 64)
5555	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5556      break;
5557
5558    case IA64_OPND_R1:
5559    case IA64_OPND_R2:
5560    case IA64_OPND_R3:
5561      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_GR
5562	  && e->X_add_number < REG_GR + 128)
5563	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5564      break;
5565
5566    case IA64_OPND_R3_2:
5567      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_GR)
5568	{
5569	  if (e->X_add_number < REG_GR + 4)
5570	    return OPERAND_MATCH;
5571	  else if (e->X_add_number < REG_GR + 128)
5572	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5573	}
5574      break;
5575
5576      /* indirect operands:  */
5577    case IA64_OPND_CPUID_R3:
5578    case IA64_OPND_DBR_R3:
5579    case IA64_OPND_DTR_R3:
5580    case IA64_OPND_ITR_R3:
5581    case IA64_OPND_IBR_R3:
5582    case IA64_OPND_MSR_R3:
5583    case IA64_OPND_PKR_R3:
5584    case IA64_OPND_PMC_R3:
5585    case IA64_OPND_PMD_R3:
5586    case IA64_OPND_DAHR_R3:
5587    case IA64_OPND_RR_R3:
5588      if (e->X_op == O_index && e->X_op_symbol
5589	  && (S_GET_VALUE (e->X_op_symbol) - IND_CPUID
5590	      == opnd - IA64_OPND_CPUID_R3))
5591	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5592      break;
5593
5594    case IA64_OPND_MR3:
5595      if (e->X_op == O_index && !e->X_op_symbol)
5596	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5597      break;
5598
5599      /* immediate operands:  */
5600    case IA64_OPND_CNT2a:
5601    case IA64_OPND_LEN4:
5602    case IA64_OPND_LEN6:
5603      bits = operand_width (idesc->operands[res_index]);
5604      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5605	{
5606	  if ((bfd_vma) (e->X_add_number - 1) < ((bfd_vma) 1 << bits))
5607	    return OPERAND_MATCH;
5608	  else
5609	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5610	}
5611      break;
5612
5613    case IA64_OPND_CNT2b:
5614      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5615	{
5616	  if ((bfd_vma) (e->X_add_number - 1) < 3)
5617	    return OPERAND_MATCH;
5618	  else
5619	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5620	}
5621      break;
5622
5623    case IA64_OPND_CNT2c:
5624      val = e->X_add_number;
5625      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5626	{
5627	  if ((val == 0 || val == 7 || val == 15 || val == 16))
5628	    return OPERAND_MATCH;
5629	  else
5630	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5631	}
5632      break;
5633
5634    case IA64_OPND_SOR:
5635      /* SOR must be an integer multiple of 8 */
5636      if (e->X_op == O_constant && e->X_add_number & 0x7)
5637	return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5638      /* Fall through.  */
5639    case IA64_OPND_SOF:
5640    case IA64_OPND_SOL:
5641      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5642	{
5643	  if ((bfd_vma) e->X_add_number <= 96)
5644	    return OPERAND_MATCH;
5645	  else
5646	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5647	}
5648      break;
5649
5650    case IA64_OPND_IMMU62:
5651      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5652	{
5653	  if ((bfd_vma) e->X_add_number < ((bfd_vma) 1 << 62))
5654	    return OPERAND_MATCH;
5655	  else
5656	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5657	}
5658      else
5659	{
5660	  /* FIXME -- need 62-bit relocation type */
5661	  as_bad (_("62-bit relocation not yet implemented"));
5662	}
5663      break;
5664
5665    case IA64_OPND_IMMU64:
5666      if (e->X_op == O_symbol || e->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup
5667	  || e->X_op == O_subtract)
5668	{
5669	  fix = CURR_SLOT.fixup + CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5670	  fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64;
5671	  if (e->X_op != O_subtract)
5672	    {
5673	      fix->code = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (e->X_op_symbol, fix->code);
5674	      if (e->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup)
5675		e->X_op = O_symbol;
5676	    }
5677
5678	  fix->opnd = idesc->operands[res_index];
5679	  fix->expr = *e;
5680	  fix->is_pcrel = 0;
5681	  ++CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5682	  return OPERAND_MATCH;
5683	}
5684      else if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5685	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5686      break;
5687
5688    case IA64_OPND_IMMU5b:
5689      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5690	{
5691	  val = e->X_add_number;
5692	  if (val >= 32 && val <= 63)
5693	    return OPERAND_MATCH;
5694	  else
5695	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5696	}
5697      break;
5698
5699    case IA64_OPND_CCNT5:
5700    case IA64_OPND_CNT5:
5701    case IA64_OPND_CNT6:
5702    case IA64_OPND_CPOS6a:
5703    case IA64_OPND_CPOS6b:
5704    case IA64_OPND_CPOS6c:
5705    case IA64_OPND_IMMU2:
5706    case IA64_OPND_IMMU7a:
5707    case IA64_OPND_IMMU7b:
5708    case IA64_OPND_IMMU16:
5709    case IA64_OPND_IMMU19:
5710    case IA64_OPND_IMMU21:
5711    case IA64_OPND_IMMU24:
5712    case IA64_OPND_MBTYPE4:
5713    case IA64_OPND_MHTYPE8:
5714    case IA64_OPND_POS6:
5715      bits = operand_width (idesc->operands[res_index]);
5716      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5717	{
5718	  if ((bfd_vma) e->X_add_number < ((bfd_vma) 1 << bits))
5719	    return OPERAND_MATCH;
5720	  else
5721	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5722	}
5723      break;
5724
5725    case IA64_OPND_IMMU9:
5726      bits = operand_width (idesc->operands[res_index]);
5727      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5728	{
5729	  if ((bfd_vma) e->X_add_number < ((bfd_vma) 1 << bits))
5730	    {
5731	      int lobits = e->X_add_number & 0x3;
5732	      if (((bfd_vma) e->X_add_number & 0x3C) != 0 && lobits == 0)
5733		e->X_add_number |= (bfd_vma) 0x3;
5734	      return OPERAND_MATCH;
5735	    }
5736	  else
5737	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5738	}
5739      break;
5740
5741    case IA64_OPND_IMM44:
5742      /* least 16 bits must be zero */
5743      if ((e->X_add_number & 0xffff) != 0)
5744	/* XXX technically, this is wrong: we should not be issuing warning
5745	   messages until we're sure this instruction pattern is going to
5746	   be used! */
5747	as_warn (_("lower 16 bits of mask ignored"));
5748
5749      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5750	{
5751	  if (((e->X_add_number >= 0
5752		&& (bfd_vma) e->X_add_number < ((bfd_vma) 1 << 44))
5753	       || (e->X_add_number < 0
5754		   && (bfd_vma) -e->X_add_number <= ((bfd_vma) 1 << 44))))
5755	    {
5756	      /* sign-extend */
5757	      if (e->X_add_number >= 0
5758		  && (e->X_add_number & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 43)) != 0)
5759		{
5760		  e->X_add_number |= ~(((bfd_vma) 1 << 44) - 1);
5761		}
5762	      return OPERAND_MATCH;
5763	    }
5764	  else
5765	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5766	}
5767      break;
5768
5769    case IA64_OPND_IMM17:
5770      /* bit 0 is a don't care (pr0 is hardwired to 1) */
5771      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5772	{
5773	  if (((e->X_add_number >= 0
5774		&& (bfd_vma) e->X_add_number < ((bfd_vma) 1 << 17))
5775	       || (e->X_add_number < 0
5776		   && (bfd_vma) -e->X_add_number <= ((bfd_vma) 1 << 17))))
5777	    {
5778	      /* sign-extend */
5779	      if (e->X_add_number >= 0
5780		  && (e->X_add_number & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 16)) != 0)
5781		{
5782		  e->X_add_number |= ~(((bfd_vma) 1 << 17) - 1);
5783		}
5784	      return OPERAND_MATCH;
5785	    }
5786	  else
5787	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5788	}
5789      break;
5790
5791    case IA64_OPND_IMM14:
5792    case IA64_OPND_IMM22:
5793      relocatable = 1;
5794      /* Fall through.  */
5795    case IA64_OPND_IMM1:
5796    case IA64_OPND_IMM8:
5797    case IA64_OPND_IMM8U4:
5798    case IA64_OPND_IMM8M1:
5799    case IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U4:
5800    case IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U8:
5801    case IA64_OPND_IMM9a:
5802    case IA64_OPND_IMM9b:
5803      bits = operand_width (idesc->operands[res_index]);
5804      if (relocatable && (e->X_op == O_symbol
5805			  || e->X_op == O_subtract
5806			  || e->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup))
5807	{
5808	  fix = CURR_SLOT.fixup + CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5809
5810	  if (idesc->operands[res_index] == IA64_OPND_IMM14)
5811	    fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM14;
5812	  else
5813	    fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22;
5814
5815	  if (e->X_op != O_subtract)
5816	    {
5817	      fix->code = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (e->X_op_symbol, fix->code);
5818	      if (e->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup)
5819		e->X_op = O_symbol;
5820	    }
5821
5822	  fix->opnd = idesc->operands[res_index];
5823	  fix->expr = *e;
5824	  fix->is_pcrel = 0;
5825	  ++CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5826	  return OPERAND_MATCH;
5827	}
5828      else if (e->X_op != O_constant
5829	       && ! (e->X_op == O_big && opnd == IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U8))
5830	return OPERAND_MISMATCH;
5831
5832      if (opnd == IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U4)
5833	{
5834	  /* Zero is not valid for unsigned compares that take an adjusted
5835	     constant immediate range.  */
5836	  if (e->X_add_number == 0)
5837	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5838
5839	  /* Sign-extend 32-bit unsigned numbers, so that the following range
5840	     checks will work.  */
5841	  val = e->X_add_number;
5842	  if ((val & (~(bfd_vma) 0 << 32)) == 0)
5843	    val = (val ^ ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31)) - ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31);
5844
5845	  /* Check for 0x100000000.  This is valid because
5846	     0x100000000-1 is the same as ((uint32_t) -1).  */
5847	  if (val == ((bfd_signed_vma) 1 << 32))
5848	    return OPERAND_MATCH;
5849
5850	  val = val - 1;
5851	}
5852      else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U8)
5853	{
5854	  /* Zero is not valid for unsigned compares that take an adjusted
5855	     constant immediate range.  */
5856	  if (e->X_add_number == 0)
5857	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5858
5859	  /* Check for 0x10000000000000000.  */
5860	  if (e->X_op == O_big)
5861	    {
5862	      if (generic_bignum[0] == 0
5863		  && generic_bignum[1] == 0
5864		  && generic_bignum[2] == 0
5865		  && generic_bignum[3] == 0
5866		  && generic_bignum[4] == 1)
5867		return OPERAND_MATCH;
5868	      else
5869		return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5870	    }
5871	  else
5872	    val = e->X_add_number - 1;
5873	}
5874      else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_IMM8M1)
5875	val = e->X_add_number - 1;
5876      else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_IMM8U4)
5877	{
5878	  /* Sign-extend 32-bit unsigned numbers, so that the following range
5879	     checks will work.  */
5880	  val = e->X_add_number;
5881	  if ((val & (~(bfd_vma) 0 << 32)) == 0)
5882	    val = (val ^ ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31)) - ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31);
5883	}
5884      else
5885	val = e->X_add_number;
5886
5887      if ((val >= 0 && (bfd_vma) val < ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1)))
5888	  || (val < 0 && (bfd_vma) -val <= ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1))))
5889	return OPERAND_MATCH;
5890      else
5891	return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5892
5893    case IA64_OPND_INC3:
5894      /* +/- 1, 4, 8, 16 */
5895      val = e->X_add_number;
5896      if (val < 0)
5897	val = -val;
5898      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5899	{
5900	  if ((val == 1 || val == 4 || val == 8 || val == 16))
5901	    return OPERAND_MATCH;
5902	  else
5903	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5904	}
5905      break;
5906
5907    case IA64_OPND_TGT25:
5908    case IA64_OPND_TGT25b:
5909    case IA64_OPND_TGT25c:
5910    case IA64_OPND_TGT64:
5911      if (e->X_op == O_symbol)
5912	{
5913	  fix = CURR_SLOT.fixup + CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5914	  if (opnd == IA64_OPND_TGT25)
5915	    fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21F;
5916	  else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_TGT25b)
5917	    fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21M;
5918	  else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_TGT25c)
5919	    fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21B;
5920	  else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_TGT64)
5921	    fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL60B;
5922	  else
5923	    abort ();
5924
5925	  fix->code = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (e->X_op_symbol, fix->code);
5926	  fix->opnd = idesc->operands[res_index];
5927	  fix->expr = *e;
5928	  fix->is_pcrel = 1;
5929	  ++CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5930	  return OPERAND_MATCH;
5931	}
5932      /* Fall through.  */
5933    case IA64_OPND_TAG13:
5934    case IA64_OPND_TAG13b:
5935      switch (e->X_op)
5936	{
5937	case O_constant:
5938	  return OPERAND_MATCH;
5939
5940	case O_symbol:
5941	  fix = CURR_SLOT.fixup + CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5942	  /* There are no external relocs for TAG13/TAG13b fields, so we
5943	     create a dummy reloc.  This will not live past md_apply_fix.  */
5944	  fix->code = BFD_RELOC_UNUSED;
5945	  fix->code = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (e->X_op_symbol, fix->code);
5946	  fix->opnd = idesc->operands[res_index];
5947	  fix->expr = *e;
5948	  fix->is_pcrel = 1;
5949	  ++CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5950	  return OPERAND_MATCH;
5951
5952	default:
5953	  break;
5954	}
5955      break;
5956
5957    case IA64_OPND_LDXMOV:
5958      fix = CURR_SLOT.fixup + CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5959      fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LDXMOV;
5960      fix->opnd = idesc->operands[res_index];
5961      fix->expr = *e;
5962      fix->is_pcrel = 0;
5963      ++CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5964      return OPERAND_MATCH;
5965
5966    case IA64_OPND_STRD5b:
5967      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5968	{
5969	  /* 5-bit signed scaled by 64 */
5970	  if ((e->X_add_number <=  	( 0xf  << 6 ))
5971	       && (e->X_add_number >=  -( 0x10 << 6 )))
5972	    {
5973
5974	      /* Must be a multiple of 64 */
5975	      if ((e->X_add_number & 0x3f) != 0)
5976	        as_warn (_("stride must be a multiple of 64; lower 6 bits ignored"));
5977
5978	      e->X_add_number &= ~ 0x3f;
5979	      return OPERAND_MATCH;
5980	    }
5981	  else
5982	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5983	}
5984      break;
5985    case IA64_OPND_CNT6a:
5986      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5987	{
5988	  /* 6-bit unsigned biased by 1 -- count 0 is meaningless */
5989	  if ((e->X_add_number     <=   64)
5990	       && (e->X_add_number > 0) )
5991	    {
5992	      return OPERAND_MATCH;
5993	    }
5994	  else
5995	    return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5996	}
5997      break;
5998
5999    default:
6000      break;
6001    }
6002  return OPERAND_MISMATCH;
6003}
6004
6005static int
6006parse_operand (expressionS *e, int more)
6007{
6008  int sep = '\0';
6009
6010  memset (e, 0, sizeof (*e));
6011  e->X_op = O_absent;
6012  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
6013  expression (e);
6014  sep = *input_line_pointer;
6015  if (more && (sep == ',' || sep == more))
6016    ++input_line_pointer;
6017  return sep;
6018}
6019
6020static int
6021parse_operand_and_eval (expressionS *e, int more)
6022{
6023  int sep = parse_operand (e, more);
6024  resolve_expression (e);
6025  return sep;
6026}
6027
6028static int
6029parse_operand_maybe_eval (expressionS *e, int more, enum ia64_opnd op)
6030{
6031  int sep = parse_operand (e, more);
6032  switch (op)
6033    {
6034    case IA64_OPND_IMM14:
6035    case IA64_OPND_IMM22:
6036    case IA64_OPND_IMMU64:
6037    case IA64_OPND_TGT25:
6038    case IA64_OPND_TGT25b:
6039    case IA64_OPND_TGT25c:
6040    case IA64_OPND_TGT64:
6041    case IA64_OPND_TAG13:
6042    case IA64_OPND_TAG13b:
6043    case IA64_OPND_LDXMOV:
6044      break;
6045    default:
6046      resolve_expression (e);
6047      break;
6048    }
6049  return sep;
6050}
6051
6052/* Returns the next entry in the opcode table that matches the one in
6053   IDESC, and frees the entry in IDESC.  If no matching entry is
6054   found, NULL is returned instead.  */
6055
6056static struct ia64_opcode *
6057get_next_opcode (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
6058{
6059  struct ia64_opcode *next = ia64_find_next_opcode (idesc);
6060  ia64_free_opcode (idesc);
6061  return next;
6062}
6063
6064/* Parse the operands for the opcode and find the opcode variant that
6065   matches the specified operands, or NULL if no match is possible.  */
6066
6067static struct ia64_opcode *
6068parse_operands (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
6069{
6070  int i = 0, highest_unmatched_operand, num_operands = 0, num_outputs = 0;
6071  int error_pos, out_of_range_pos, curr_out_of_range_pos, sep = 0;
6072  int reg1, reg2;
6073  char reg_class;
6074  enum ia64_opnd expected_operand = IA64_OPND_NIL;
6075  enum operand_match_result result;
6076  char mnemonic[129];
6077  char *first_arg = 0, *end, *saved_input_pointer;
6078  unsigned int sof;
6079
6080  gas_assert (strlen (idesc->name) <= 128);
6081
6082  strcpy (mnemonic, idesc->name);
6083  if (idesc->operands[2] == IA64_OPND_SOF
6084      || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_SOF)
6085    {
6086      /* To make the common idiom "alloc loc?=ar.pfs,0,1,0,0" work, we
6087	 can't parse the first operand until we have parsed the
6088	 remaining operands of the "alloc" instruction.  */
6089      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
6090      first_arg = input_line_pointer;
6091      end = strchr (input_line_pointer, '=');
6092      if (!end)
6093	{
6094	  as_bad (_("Expected separator `='"));
6095	  return 0;
6096	}
6097      input_line_pointer = end + 1;
6098      ++i;
6099      ++num_outputs;
6100    }
6101
6102  for (; ; ++i)
6103    {
6104      if (i < NELEMS (CURR_SLOT.opnd))
6105	{
6106	  sep = parse_operand_maybe_eval (CURR_SLOT.opnd + i, '=',
6107					  idesc->operands[i]);
6108	  if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_op == O_absent)
6109	    break;
6110	}
6111      else
6112	{
6113	  expressionS dummy;
6114
6115	  sep = parse_operand (&dummy, '=');
6116	  if (dummy.X_op == O_absent)
6117	    break;
6118	}
6119
6120      ++num_operands;
6121
6122      if (sep != '=' && sep != ',')
6123	break;
6124
6125      if (sep == '=')
6126	{
6127	  if (num_outputs > 0)
6128	    as_bad (_("Duplicate equal sign (=) in instruction"));
6129	  else
6130	    num_outputs = i + 1;
6131	}
6132    }
6133  if (sep != '\0')
6134    {
6135      as_bad (_("Illegal operand separator `%c'"), sep);
6136      return 0;
6137    }
6138
6139  if (idesc->operands[2] == IA64_OPND_SOF
6140      || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_SOF)
6141    {
6142      /* Map alloc r1=ar.pfs,i,l,o,r to alloc r1=ar.pfs,(i+l+o),(i+l),r.
6143	 Note, however, that due to that mapping operand numbers in error
6144	 messages for any of the constant operands will not be correct.  */
6145      know (strcmp (idesc->name, "alloc") == 0);
6146      /* The first operand hasn't been parsed/initialized, yet (but
6147	 num_operands intentionally doesn't account for that).  */
6148      i = num_operands > 4 ? 2 : 1;
6149#define FORCE_CONST(n) (CURR_SLOT.opnd[n].X_op == O_constant \
6150			? CURR_SLOT.opnd[n].X_add_number \
6151			: 0)
6152      sof = set_regstack (FORCE_CONST(i),
6153			  FORCE_CONST(i + 1),
6154			  FORCE_CONST(i + 2),
6155			  FORCE_CONST(i + 3));
6156#undef FORCE_CONST
6157
6158      /* now we can parse the first arg:  */
6159      saved_input_pointer = input_line_pointer;
6160      input_line_pointer = first_arg;
6161      sep = parse_operand_maybe_eval (CURR_SLOT.opnd + 0, '=',
6162				      idesc->operands[0]);
6163      if (sep != '=')
6164	--num_outputs;	/* force error */
6165      input_line_pointer = saved_input_pointer;
6166
6167      CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number = sof;
6168      if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 1].X_op == O_constant
6169	  && CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 2].X_op == O_constant)
6170	CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 1].X_add_number
6171	  = sof - CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 2].X_add_number;
6172      else
6173	CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 1].X_op = O_illegal;
6174      CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 2] = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 3];
6175    }
6176
6177  highest_unmatched_operand = -4;
6178  curr_out_of_range_pos = -1;
6179  error_pos = 0;
6180  for (; idesc; idesc = get_next_opcode (idesc))
6181    {
6182      if (num_outputs != idesc->num_outputs)
6183	continue;		/* mismatch in # of outputs */
6184      if (highest_unmatched_operand < 0)
6185	highest_unmatched_operand |= 1;
6186      if (num_operands > NELEMS (idesc->operands)
6187	  || (num_operands < NELEMS (idesc->operands)
6188	   && idesc->operands[num_operands])
6189	  || (num_operands > 0 && !idesc->operands[num_operands - 1]))
6190	continue;		/* mismatch in number of arguments */
6191      if (highest_unmatched_operand < 0)
6192	highest_unmatched_operand |= 2;
6193
6194      CURR_SLOT.num_fixups = 0;
6195
6196      /* Try to match all operands.  If we see an out-of-range operand,
6197	 then continue trying to match the rest of the operands, since if
6198	 the rest match, then this idesc will give the best error message.  */
6199
6200      out_of_range_pos = -1;
6201      for (i = 0; i < num_operands && idesc->operands[i]; ++i)
6202	{
6203	  result = operand_match (idesc, i, CURR_SLOT.opnd + i);
6204	  if (result != OPERAND_MATCH)
6205	    {
6206	      if (result != OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE)
6207		break;
6208	      if (out_of_range_pos < 0)
6209		/* remember position of the first out-of-range operand: */
6210		out_of_range_pos = i;
6211	    }
6212	}
6213
6214      /* If we did not match all operands, or if at least one operand was
6215	 out-of-range, then this idesc does not match.  Keep track of which
6216	 idesc matched the most operands before failing.  If we have two
6217	 idescs that failed at the same position, and one had an out-of-range
6218	 operand, then prefer the out-of-range operand.  Thus if we have
6219	 "add r0=0x1000000,r1" we get an error saying the constant is out
6220	 of range instead of an error saying that the constant should have been
6221	 a register.  */
6222
6223      if (i != num_operands || out_of_range_pos >= 0)
6224	{
6225	  if (i > highest_unmatched_operand
6226	      || (i == highest_unmatched_operand
6227		  && out_of_range_pos > curr_out_of_range_pos))
6228	    {
6229	      highest_unmatched_operand = i;
6230	      if (out_of_range_pos >= 0)
6231		{
6232		  expected_operand = idesc->operands[out_of_range_pos];
6233		  error_pos = out_of_range_pos;
6234		}
6235	      else
6236		{
6237		  expected_operand = idesc->operands[i];
6238		  error_pos = i;
6239		}
6240	      curr_out_of_range_pos = out_of_range_pos;
6241	    }
6242	  continue;
6243	}
6244
6245      break;
6246    }
6247  if (!idesc)
6248    {
6249      if (expected_operand)
6250	as_bad (_("Operand %u of `%s' should be %s"),
6251		error_pos + 1, mnemonic,
6252		elf64_ia64_operands[expected_operand].desc);
6253      else if (highest_unmatched_operand < 0 && !(highest_unmatched_operand & 1))
6254	as_bad (_("Wrong number of output operands"));
6255      else if (highest_unmatched_operand < 0 && !(highest_unmatched_operand & 2))
6256	as_bad (_("Wrong number of input operands"));
6257      else
6258	as_bad (_("Operand mismatch"));
6259      return 0;
6260    }
6261
6262  /* Check that the instruction doesn't use
6263     - r0, f0, or f1 as output operands
6264     - the same predicate twice as output operands
6265     - r0 as address of a base update load or store
6266     - the same GR as output and address of a base update load
6267     - two even- or two odd-numbered FRs as output operands of a floating
6268       point parallel load.
6269     At most two (conflicting) output (or output-like) operands can exist,
6270     (floating point parallel loads have three outputs, but the base register,
6271     if updated, cannot conflict with the actual outputs).  */
6272  reg2 = reg1 = -1;
6273  for (i = 0; i < num_operands; ++i)
6274    {
6275      int regno = 0;
6276
6277      reg_class = 0;
6278      switch (idesc->operands[i])
6279	{
6280	case IA64_OPND_R1:
6281	case IA64_OPND_R2:
6282	case IA64_OPND_R3:
6283	  if (i < num_outputs)
6284	    {
6285	      if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number == REG_GR)
6286		reg_class = 'r';
6287	      else if (reg1 < 0)
6288		reg1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6289	      else if (reg2 < 0)
6290		reg2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6291	    }
6292	  break;
6293	case IA64_OPND_P1:
6294	case IA64_OPND_P2:
6295	  if (i < num_outputs)
6296	    {
6297	      if (reg1 < 0)
6298		reg1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6299	      else if (reg2 < 0)
6300		reg2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6301	    }
6302	  break;
6303	case IA64_OPND_F1:
6304	case IA64_OPND_F2:
6305	case IA64_OPND_F3:
6306	case IA64_OPND_F4:
6307	  if (i < num_outputs)
6308	    {
6309	      if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number >= REG_FR
6310		  && CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number <= REG_FR + 1)
6311		{
6312		  reg_class = 'f';
6313		  regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_FR;
6314		}
6315	      else if (reg1 < 0)
6316		reg1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6317	      else if (reg2 < 0)
6318		reg2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6319	    }
6320	  break;
6321	case IA64_OPND_MR3:
6322	  if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_POSTINC)
6323	    {
6324	      if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number == REG_GR)
6325		reg_class = 'm';
6326	      else if (reg1 < 0)
6327		reg1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6328	      else if (reg2 < 0)
6329		reg2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6330	    }
6331	  break;
6332	default:
6333	  break;
6334	}
6335      switch (reg_class)
6336	{
6337	case 0:
6338	  break;
6339	default:
6340	  as_warn (_("Invalid use of `%c%d' as output operand"), reg_class, regno);
6341	  break;
6342	case 'm':
6343	  as_warn (_("Invalid use of `r%d' as base update address operand"), regno);
6344	  break;
6345	}
6346    }
6347  if (reg1 == reg2)
6348    {
6349      if (reg1 >= REG_GR && reg1 <= REG_GR + 127)
6350	{
6351	  reg1 -= REG_GR;
6352	  reg_class = 'r';
6353	}
6354      else if (reg1 >= REG_P && reg1 <= REG_P + 63)
6355	{
6356	  reg1 -= REG_P;
6357	  reg_class = 'p';
6358	}
6359      else if (reg1 >= REG_FR && reg1 <= REG_FR + 127)
6360	{
6361	  reg1 -= REG_FR;
6362	  reg_class = 'f';
6363	}
6364      else
6365	reg_class = 0;
6366      if (reg_class)
6367	as_warn (_("Invalid duplicate use of `%c%d'"), reg_class, reg1);
6368    }
6369  else if (((reg1 >= REG_FR && reg1 <= REG_FR + 31
6370	     && reg2 >= REG_FR && reg2 <= REG_FR + 31)
6371	    || (reg1 >= REG_FR + 32 && reg1 <= REG_FR + 127
6372	     && reg2 >= REG_FR + 32 && reg2 <= REG_FR + 127))
6373	   && ! ((reg1 ^ reg2) & 1))
6374    as_warn (_("Invalid simultaneous use of `f%d' and `f%d'"),
6375	     reg1 - REG_FR, reg2 - REG_FR);
6376  else if ((reg1 >= REG_FR && reg1 <= REG_FR + 31
6377	    && reg2 >= REG_FR + 32 && reg2 <= REG_FR + 127)
6378	   || (reg1 >= REG_FR + 32 && reg1 <= REG_FR + 127
6379	    && reg2 >= REG_FR && reg2 <= REG_FR + 31))
6380    as_warn (_("Dangerous simultaneous use of `f%d' and `f%d'"),
6381	     reg1 - REG_FR, reg2 - REG_FR);
6382  return idesc;
6383}
6384
6385static void
6386build_insn (struct slot *slot, bfd_vma *insnp)
6387{
6388  const struct ia64_operand *odesc, *o2desc;
6389  struct ia64_opcode *idesc = slot->idesc;
6390  bfd_vma insn;
6391  bfd_signed_vma val;
6392  const char *err;
6393  int i;
6394
6395  insn = idesc->opcode | slot->qp_regno;
6396
6397  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands) && idesc->operands[i]; ++i)
6398    {
6399      if (slot->opnd[i].X_op == O_register
6400	  || slot->opnd[i].X_op == O_constant
6401	  || slot->opnd[i].X_op == O_index)
6402	val = slot->opnd[i].X_add_number;
6403      else if (slot->opnd[i].X_op == O_big)
6404	{
6405	  /* This must be the value 0x10000000000000000.  */
6406	  gas_assert (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U8);
6407	  val = 0;
6408	}
6409      else
6410	val = 0;
6411
6412      switch (idesc->operands[i])
6413	{
6414	case IA64_OPND_IMMU64:
6415	  *insnp++ = (val >> 22) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
6416	  insn |= (((val & 0x7f) << 13) | (((val >> 7) & 0x1ff) << 27)
6417		   | (((val >> 16) & 0x1f) << 22) | (((val >> 21) & 0x1) << 21)
6418		   | (((val >> 63) & 0x1) << 36));
6419	  continue;
6420
6421	case IA64_OPND_IMMU62:
6422	  val &= 0x3fffffffffffffffULL;
6423	  if (val != slot->opnd[i].X_add_number)
6424	    as_warn (_("Value truncated to 62 bits"));
6425	  *insnp++ = (val >> 21) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
6426	  insn |= (((val & 0xfffff) << 6) | (((val >> 20) & 0x1) << 36));
6427	  continue;
6428
6429	case IA64_OPND_TGT64:
6430	  val >>= 4;
6431	  *insnp++ = ((val >> 20) & 0x7fffffffffLL) << 2;
6432	  insn |= ((((val >> 59) & 0x1) << 36)
6433		   | (((val >> 0) & 0xfffff) << 13));
6434	  continue;
6435
6436	case IA64_OPND_AR3:
6437	  val -= REG_AR;
6438	  break;
6439
6440	case IA64_OPND_B1:
6441	case IA64_OPND_B2:
6442	  val -= REG_BR;
6443	  break;
6444
6445	case IA64_OPND_CR3:
6446	  val -= REG_CR;
6447	  break;
6448
6449	case IA64_OPND_DAHR3:
6450	  val -= REG_DAHR;
6451	  break;
6452
6453	case IA64_OPND_F1:
6454	case IA64_OPND_F2:
6455	case IA64_OPND_F3:
6456	case IA64_OPND_F4:
6457	  val -= REG_FR;
6458	  break;
6459
6460	case IA64_OPND_P1:
6461	case IA64_OPND_P2:
6462	  val -= REG_P;
6463	  break;
6464
6465	case IA64_OPND_R1:
6466	case IA64_OPND_R2:
6467	case IA64_OPND_R3:
6468	case IA64_OPND_R3_2:
6469	case IA64_OPND_CPUID_R3:
6470	case IA64_OPND_DBR_R3:
6471	case IA64_OPND_DTR_R3:
6472	case IA64_OPND_ITR_R3:
6473	case IA64_OPND_IBR_R3:
6474	case IA64_OPND_MR3:
6475	case IA64_OPND_MSR_R3:
6476	case IA64_OPND_PKR_R3:
6477	case IA64_OPND_PMC_R3:
6478	case IA64_OPND_PMD_R3:
6479	case IA64_OPND_DAHR_R3:
6480	case IA64_OPND_RR_R3:
6481	  val -= REG_GR;
6482	  break;
6483
6484	default:
6485	  break;
6486	}
6487
6488      odesc = elf64_ia64_operands + idesc->operands[i];
6489      err = (*odesc->insert) (odesc, val, &insn);
6490      if (err)
6491	as_bad_where (slot->src_file, slot->src_line,
6492		      _("Bad operand value: %s"), err);
6493      if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_PSEUDO)
6494	{
6495	  if ((idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_F2_EQ_F3)
6496	      && odesc == elf64_ia64_operands + IA64_OPND_F3)
6497	    {
6498	      o2desc = elf64_ia64_operands + IA64_OPND_F2;
6499	      (*o2desc->insert) (o2desc, val, &insn);
6500	    }
6501	  if ((idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_LEN_EQ_64MCNT)
6502	      && (odesc == elf64_ia64_operands + IA64_OPND_CPOS6a
6503		  || odesc == elf64_ia64_operands + IA64_OPND_POS6))
6504	    {
6505	      o2desc = elf64_ia64_operands + IA64_OPND_LEN6;
6506	      (*o2desc->insert) (o2desc, 64 - val, &insn);
6507	    }
6508	}
6509    }
6510  *insnp = insn;
6511}
6512
6513static void
6514emit_one_bundle (void)
6515{
6516  int manual_bundling_off = 0, manual_bundling = 0;
6517  enum ia64_unit required_unit, insn_unit = 0;
6518  enum ia64_insn_type type[3], insn_type;
6519  unsigned int template_val, orig_template;
6520  bfd_vma insn[3] = { -1, -1, -1 };
6521  struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
6522  int end_of_insn_group = 0, user_template = -1;
6523  int n, i, j, first, curr, last_slot;
6524  bfd_vma t0 = 0, t1 = 0;
6525  struct label_fix *lfix;
6526  bfd_boolean mark_label;
6527  struct insn_fix *ifix;
6528  char mnemonic[16];
6529  fixS *fix;
6530  char *f;
6531  int addr_mod;
6532
6533  first = (md.curr_slot + NUM_SLOTS - md.num_slots_in_use) % NUM_SLOTS;
6534  know (first >= 0 && first < NUM_SLOTS);
6535  n = MIN (3, md.num_slots_in_use);
6536
6537  /* Determine template: user user_template if specified, best match
6538     otherwise:  */
6539
6540  if (md.slot[first].user_template >= 0)
6541    user_template = template_val = md.slot[first].user_template;
6542  else
6543    {
6544      /* Auto select appropriate template.  */
6545      memset (type, 0, sizeof (type));
6546      curr = first;
6547      for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
6548	{
6549	  if (md.slot[curr].label_fixups && i != 0)
6550	    break;
6551	  type[i] = md.slot[curr].idesc->type;
6552	  curr = (curr + 1) % NUM_SLOTS;
6553	}
6554      template_val = best_template[type[0]][type[1]][type[2]];
6555    }
6556
6557  /* initialize instructions with appropriate nops:  */
6558  for (i = 0; i < 3; ++i)
6559    insn[i] = nop[ia64_templ_desc[template_val].exec_unit[i]];
6560
6561  f = frag_more (16);
6562
6563  /* Check to see if this bundle is at an offset that is a multiple of 16-bytes
6564     from the start of the frag.  */
6565  addr_mod = frag_now_fix () & 15;
6566  if (frag_now->has_code && frag_now->insn_addr != addr_mod)
6567    as_bad (_("instruction address is not a multiple of 16"));
6568  frag_now->insn_addr = addr_mod;
6569  frag_now->has_code = 1;
6570
6571  /* now fill in slots with as many insns as possible:  */
6572  curr = first;
6573  idesc = md.slot[curr].idesc;
6574  end_of_insn_group = 0;
6575  last_slot = -1;
6576  for (i = 0; i < 3 && md.num_slots_in_use > 0; ++i)
6577    {
6578      /* If we have unwind records, we may need to update some now.  */
6579      unw_rec_list *ptr = md.slot[curr].unwind_record;
6580      unw_rec_list *end_ptr = NULL;
6581
6582      if (ptr)
6583	{
6584	  /* Find the last prologue/body record in the list for the current
6585	     insn, and set the slot number for all records up to that point.
6586	     This needs to be done now, because prologue/body records refer to
6587	     the current point, not the point after the instruction has been
6588	     issued.  This matters because there may have been nops emitted
6589	     meanwhile.  Any non-prologue non-body record followed by a
6590	     prologue/body record must also refer to the current point.  */
6591	  unw_rec_list *last_ptr;
6592
6593	  for (j = 1; end_ptr == NULL && j < md.num_slots_in_use; ++j)
6594	    end_ptr = md.slot[(curr + j) % NUM_SLOTS].unwind_record;
6595	  for (last_ptr = NULL; ptr != end_ptr; ptr = ptr->next)
6596	    if (ptr->r.type == prologue || ptr->r.type == prologue_gr
6597		|| ptr->r.type == body)
6598	      last_ptr = ptr;
6599	  if (last_ptr)
6600	    {
6601	      /* Make last_ptr point one after the last prologue/body
6602		 record.  */
6603	      last_ptr = last_ptr->next;
6604	      for (ptr = md.slot[curr].unwind_record; ptr != last_ptr;
6605		   ptr = ptr->next)
6606		{
6607		  ptr->slot_number = (unsigned long) f + i;
6608		  ptr->slot_frag = frag_now;
6609		}
6610	      /* Remove the initialized records, so that we won't accidentally
6611		 update them again if we insert a nop and continue.  */
6612	      md.slot[curr].unwind_record = last_ptr;
6613	    }
6614	}
6615
6616      manual_bundling_off = md.slot[curr].manual_bundling_off;
6617      if (md.slot[curr].manual_bundling_on)
6618	{
6619	  if (curr == first)
6620	    manual_bundling = 1;
6621	  else
6622	  break; /* Need to start a new bundle.  */
6623	}
6624
6625      /* If this instruction specifies a template, then it must be the first
6626	 instruction of a bundle.  */
6627      if (curr != first && md.slot[curr].user_template >= 0)
6628	break;
6629
6630      if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_SLOT2)
6631	{
6632	  if (manual_bundling && !manual_bundling_off)
6633	    {
6634	      as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6635			    _("`%s' must be last in bundle"), idesc->name);
6636	      if (i < 2)
6637		manual_bundling = -1; /* Suppress meaningless post-loop errors.  */
6638	    }
6639	  i = 2;
6640	}
6641      if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_LAST)
6642	{
6643	  int required_slot;
6644	  unsigned int required_template;
6645
6646	  /* If we need a stop bit after an M slot, our only choice is
6647	     template 5 (M;;MI).  If we need a stop bit after a B
6648	     slot, our only choice is to place it at the end of the
6649	     bundle, because the only available templates are MIB,
6650	     MBB, BBB, MMB, and MFB.  We don't handle anything other
6651	     than M and B slots because these are the only kind of
6652	     instructions that can have the IA64_OPCODE_LAST bit set.  */
6653	  required_template = template_val;
6654	  switch (idesc->type)
6655	    {
6656	    case IA64_TYPE_M:
6657	      required_slot = 0;
6658	      required_template = 5;
6659	      break;
6660
6661	    case IA64_TYPE_B:
6662	      required_slot = 2;
6663	      break;
6664
6665	    default:
6666	      as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6667			    _("Internal error: don't know how to force %s to end of instruction group"),
6668			    idesc->name);
6669	      required_slot = i;
6670	      break;
6671	    }
6672	  if (manual_bundling
6673	      && (i > required_slot
6674		  || (required_slot == 2 && !manual_bundling_off)
6675		  || (user_template >= 0
6676		      /* Changing from MMI to M;MI is OK.  */
6677		      && (template_val ^ required_template) > 1)))
6678	    {
6679	      as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6680			    _("`%s' must be last in instruction group"),
6681			    idesc->name);
6682	      if (i < 2 && required_slot == 2 && !manual_bundling_off)
6683		manual_bundling = -1; /* Suppress meaningless post-loop errors.  */
6684	    }
6685	  if (required_slot < i)
6686	    /* Can't fit this instruction.  */
6687	    break;
6688
6689	  i = required_slot;
6690	  if (required_template != template_val)
6691	    {
6692	      /* If we switch the template, we need to reset the NOPs
6693	         after slot i.  The slot-types of the instructions ahead
6694	         of i never change, so we don't need to worry about
6695	         changing NOPs in front of this slot.  */
6696	      for (j = i; j < 3; ++j)
6697	        insn[j] = nop[ia64_templ_desc[required_template].exec_unit[j]];
6698
6699	      /* We just picked a template that includes the stop bit in the
6700		 middle, so we don't need another one emitted later.  */
6701	      md.slot[curr].end_of_insn_group = 0;
6702	    }
6703	  template_val = required_template;
6704	}
6705      if (curr != first && md.slot[curr].label_fixups)
6706	{
6707	  if (manual_bundling)
6708	    {
6709	      as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6710			    _("Label must be first in a bundle"));
6711	      manual_bundling = -1; /* Suppress meaningless post-loop errors.  */
6712	    }
6713	  /* This insn must go into the first slot of a bundle.  */
6714	  break;
6715	}
6716
6717      if (end_of_insn_group && md.num_slots_in_use >= 1)
6718	{
6719	  /* We need an instruction group boundary in the middle of a
6720	     bundle.  See if we can switch to an other template with
6721	     an appropriate boundary.  */
6722
6723	  orig_template = template_val;
6724	  if (i == 1 && (user_template == 4
6725			 || (user_template < 0
6726			     && (ia64_templ_desc[template_val].exec_unit[0]
6727				 == IA64_UNIT_M))))
6728	    {
6729	      template_val = 5;
6730	      end_of_insn_group = 0;
6731	    }
6732	  else if (i == 2 && (user_template == 0
6733			      || (user_template < 0
6734				  && (ia64_templ_desc[template_val].exec_unit[1]
6735				      == IA64_UNIT_I)))
6736		   /* This test makes sure we don't switch the template if
6737		      the next instruction is one that needs to be first in
6738		      an instruction group.  Since all those instructions are
6739		      in the M group, there is no way such an instruction can
6740		      fit in this bundle even if we switch the template.  The
6741		      reason we have to check for this is that otherwise we
6742		      may end up generating "MI;;I M.." which has the deadly
6743		      effect that the second M instruction is no longer the
6744		      first in the group! --davidm 99/12/16  */
6745		   && (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_FIRST) == 0)
6746	    {
6747	      template_val = 1;
6748	      end_of_insn_group = 0;
6749	    }
6750	  else if (i == 1
6751		   && user_template == 0
6752		   && !(idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_FIRST))
6753	    /* Use the next slot.  */
6754	    continue;
6755	  else if (curr != first)
6756	    /* can't fit this insn */
6757	    break;
6758
6759	  if (template_val != orig_template)
6760	    /* if we switch the template, we need to reset the NOPs
6761	       after slot i.  The slot-types of the instructions ahead
6762	       of i never change, so we don't need to worry about
6763	       changing NOPs in front of this slot.  */
6764	    for (j = i; j < 3; ++j)
6765	      insn[j] = nop[ia64_templ_desc[template_val].exec_unit[j]];
6766	}
6767      required_unit = ia64_templ_desc[template_val].exec_unit[i];
6768
6769      /* resolve dynamic opcodes such as "break", "hint", and "nop":  */
6770      if (idesc->type == IA64_TYPE_DYN)
6771	{
6772	  enum ia64_opnd opnd1, opnd2;
6773
6774	  if ((strcmp (idesc->name, "nop") == 0)
6775	      || (strcmp (idesc->name, "break") == 0))
6776	    insn_unit = required_unit;
6777	  else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "hint") == 0)
6778	    {
6779	      insn_unit = required_unit;
6780	      if (required_unit == IA64_UNIT_B)
6781		{
6782		  switch (md.hint_b)
6783		    {
6784		    case hint_b_ok:
6785		      break;
6786		    case hint_b_warning:
6787		      as_warn (_("hint in B unit may be treated as nop"));
6788		      break;
6789		    case hint_b_error:
6790		      /* When manual bundling is off and there is no
6791			 user template, we choose a different unit so
6792			 that hint won't go into the current slot. We
6793			 will fill the current bundle with nops and
6794			 try to put hint into the next bundle.  */
6795		      if (!manual_bundling && user_template < 0)
6796			insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_I;
6797		      else
6798			as_bad (_("hint in B unit can't be used"));
6799		      break;
6800		    }
6801		}
6802	    }
6803	  else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "chk.s") == 0
6804	      || strcmp (idesc->name, "mov") == 0)
6805	    {
6806	      insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_M;
6807	      if (required_unit == IA64_UNIT_I
6808		  || (required_unit == IA64_UNIT_F && template_val == 6))
6809		insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_I;
6810	    }
6811	  else
6812	    as_fatal (_("emit_one_bundle: unexpected dynamic op"));
6813
6814	  snprintf (mnemonic, sizeof (mnemonic), "%s.%c",
6815		    idesc->name, "?imbfxx"[insn_unit]);
6816	  opnd1 = idesc->operands[0];
6817	  opnd2 = idesc->operands[1];
6818	  ia64_free_opcode (idesc);
6819	  idesc = ia64_find_opcode (mnemonic);
6820	  /* moves to/from ARs have collisions */
6821	  if (opnd1 == IA64_OPND_AR3 || opnd2 == IA64_OPND_AR3)
6822	    {
6823	      while (idesc != NULL
6824		     && (idesc->operands[0] != opnd1
6825			 || idesc->operands[1] != opnd2))
6826		idesc = get_next_opcode (idesc);
6827	    }
6828	  md.slot[curr].idesc = idesc;
6829	}
6830      else
6831	{
6832	  insn_type = idesc->type;
6833	  insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_NIL;
6834	  switch (insn_type)
6835	    {
6836	    case IA64_TYPE_A:
6837	      if (required_unit == IA64_UNIT_I || required_unit == IA64_UNIT_M)
6838		insn_unit = required_unit;
6839	      break;
6840	    case IA64_TYPE_X: insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_L; break;
6841	    case IA64_TYPE_I: insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_I; break;
6842	    case IA64_TYPE_M: insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_M; break;
6843	    case IA64_TYPE_B: insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_B; break;
6844	    case IA64_TYPE_F: insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_F; break;
6845	    default:				       break;
6846	    }
6847	}
6848
6849      if (insn_unit != required_unit)
6850	continue;		/* Try next slot.  */
6851
6852      /* Now is a good time to fix up the labels for this insn.  */
6853      mark_label = FALSE;
6854      for (lfix = md.slot[curr].label_fixups; lfix; lfix = lfix->next)
6855	{
6856	  S_SET_VALUE (lfix->sym, frag_now_fix () - 16);
6857	  symbol_set_frag (lfix->sym, frag_now);
6858	  mark_label |= lfix->dw2_mark_labels;
6859	}
6860      for (lfix = md.slot[curr].tag_fixups; lfix; lfix = lfix->next)
6861	{
6862	  S_SET_VALUE (lfix->sym, frag_now_fix () - 16 + i);
6863	  symbol_set_frag (lfix->sym, frag_now);
6864	}
6865
6866      if (debug_type == DEBUG_DWARF2
6867	  || md.slot[curr].loc_directive_seen
6868	  || mark_label)
6869	{
6870	  bfd_vma addr = frag_now->fr_address + frag_now_fix () - 16 + i;
6871
6872	  md.slot[curr].loc_directive_seen = 0;
6873	  if (mark_label)
6874	    md.slot[curr].debug_line.flags |= DWARF2_FLAG_BASIC_BLOCK;
6875
6876	  dwarf2_gen_line_info (addr, &md.slot[curr].debug_line);
6877	}
6878
6879      build_insn (md.slot + curr, insn + i);
6880
6881      ptr = md.slot[curr].unwind_record;
6882      if (ptr)
6883	{
6884	  /* Set slot numbers for all remaining unwind records belonging to the
6885	     current insn.  There can not be any prologue/body unwind records
6886	     here.  */
6887	  for (; ptr != end_ptr; ptr = ptr->next)
6888	    {
6889	      ptr->slot_number = (unsigned long) f + i;
6890	      ptr->slot_frag = frag_now;
6891	    }
6892	  md.slot[curr].unwind_record = NULL;
6893	}
6894
6895      for (j = 0; j < md.slot[curr].num_fixups; ++j)
6896	{
6897	  ifix = md.slot[curr].fixup + j;
6898	  fix = fix_new_exp (frag_now, frag_now_fix () - 16 + i, 8,
6899			     &ifix->expr, ifix->is_pcrel, ifix->code);
6900	  fix->tc_fix_data.opnd = ifix->opnd;
6901	  fix->fx_file = md.slot[curr].src_file;
6902	  fix->fx_line = md.slot[curr].src_line;
6903	}
6904
6905      end_of_insn_group = md.slot[curr].end_of_insn_group;
6906
6907      /* This adjustment to "i" must occur after the fix, otherwise the fix
6908	 is assigned to the wrong slot, and the VMS linker complains.  */
6909      if (required_unit == IA64_UNIT_L)
6910	{
6911	  know (i == 1);
6912	  /* skip one slot for long/X-unit instructions */
6913	  ++i;
6914	}
6915      --md.num_slots_in_use;
6916      last_slot = i;
6917
6918      /* clear slot:  */
6919      ia64_free_opcode (md.slot[curr].idesc);
6920      memset (md.slot + curr, 0, sizeof (md.slot[curr]));
6921      md.slot[curr].user_template = -1;
6922
6923      if (manual_bundling_off)
6924	{
6925	  manual_bundling = 0;
6926	  break;
6927	}
6928      curr = (curr + 1) % NUM_SLOTS;
6929      idesc = md.slot[curr].idesc;
6930    }
6931
6932  /* A user template was specified, but the first following instruction did
6933     not fit.  This can happen with or without manual bundling.  */
6934  if (md.num_slots_in_use > 0 && last_slot < 0)
6935    {
6936      as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6937		    _("`%s' does not fit into %s template"),
6938		    idesc->name, ia64_templ_desc[template_val].name);
6939      /* Drop first insn so we don't livelock.  */
6940      --md.num_slots_in_use;
6941      know (curr == first);
6942      ia64_free_opcode (md.slot[curr].idesc);
6943      memset (md.slot + curr, 0, sizeof (md.slot[curr]));
6944      md.slot[curr].user_template = -1;
6945    }
6946  else if (manual_bundling > 0)
6947    {
6948      if (md.num_slots_in_use > 0)
6949	{
6950	  if (last_slot >= 2)
6951	    as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6952			  _("`%s' does not fit into bundle"), idesc->name);
6953	  else
6954	    {
6955	      const char *where;
6956
6957	      if (template_val == 2)
6958		where = "X slot";
6959	      else if (last_slot == 0)
6960		where = "slots 2 or 3";
6961	      else
6962		where = "slot 3";
6963	      as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6964			    _("`%s' can't go in %s of %s template"),
6965			    idesc->name, where, ia64_templ_desc[template_val].name);
6966	    }
6967	}
6968      else
6969	as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6970		      _("Missing '}' at end of file"));
6971    }
6972
6973  know (md.num_slots_in_use < NUM_SLOTS);
6974
6975  t0 = end_of_insn_group | (template_val << 1) | (insn[0] << 5) | (insn[1] << 46);
6976  t1 = ((insn[1] >> 18) & 0x7fffff) | (insn[2] << 23);
6977
6978  number_to_chars_littleendian (f + 0, t0, 8);
6979  number_to_chars_littleendian (f + 8, t1, 8);
6980}
6981
6982int
6983md_parse_option (int c, const char *arg)
6984{
6985
6986  switch (c)
6987    {
6988    /* Switches from the Intel assembler.  */
6989    case 'm':
6990      if (strcmp (arg, "ilp64") == 0
6991	  || strcmp (arg, "lp64") == 0
6992	  || strcmp (arg, "p64") == 0)
6993	{
6994	  md.flags |= EF_IA_64_ABI64;
6995	}
6996      else if (strcmp (arg, "ilp32") == 0)
6997	{
6998	  md.flags &= ~EF_IA_64_ABI64;
6999	}
7000      else if (strcmp (arg, "le") == 0)
7001	{
7002	  md.flags &= ~EF_IA_64_BE;
7003	  default_big_endian = 0;
7004	}
7005      else if (strcmp (arg, "be") == 0)
7006	{
7007	  md.flags |= EF_IA_64_BE;
7008	  default_big_endian = 1;
7009	}
7010      else if (strncmp (arg, "unwind-check=", 13) == 0)
7011	{
7012	  arg += 13;
7013	  if (strcmp (arg, "warning") == 0)
7014	    md.unwind_check = unwind_check_warning;
7015	  else if (strcmp (arg, "error") == 0)
7016	    md.unwind_check = unwind_check_error;
7017	  else
7018	    return 0;
7019	}
7020      else if (strncmp (arg, "hint.b=", 7) == 0)
7021	{
7022	  arg += 7;
7023	  if (strcmp (arg, "ok") == 0)
7024	    md.hint_b = hint_b_ok;
7025	  else if (strcmp (arg, "warning") == 0)
7026	    md.hint_b = hint_b_warning;
7027	  else if (strcmp (arg, "error") == 0)
7028	    md.hint_b = hint_b_error;
7029	  else
7030	    return 0;
7031	}
7032      else if (strncmp (arg, "tune=", 5) == 0)
7033	{
7034	  arg += 5;
7035	  if (strcmp (arg, "itanium1") == 0)
7036	    md.tune = itanium1;
7037	  else if (strcmp (arg, "itanium2") == 0)
7038	    md.tune = itanium2;
7039	  else
7040	    return 0;
7041	}
7042      else
7043	return 0;
7044      break;
7045
7046    case 'N':
7047      if (strcmp (arg, "so") == 0)
7048	{
7049	  /* Suppress signon message.  */
7050	}
7051      else if (strcmp (arg, "pi") == 0)
7052	{
7053	  /* Reject privileged instructions.  FIXME */
7054	}
7055      else if (strcmp (arg, "us") == 0)
7056	{
7057	  /* Allow union of signed and unsigned range.  FIXME */
7058	}
7059      else if (strcmp (arg, "close_fcalls") == 0)
7060	{
7061	  /* Do not resolve global function calls.  */
7062	}
7063      else
7064	return 0;
7065      break;
7066
7067    case 'C':
7068      /* temp[="prefix"]  Insert temporary labels into the object file
7069			  symbol table prefixed by "prefix".
7070			  Default prefix is ":temp:".
7071       */
7072      break;
7073
7074    case 'a':
7075      /* indirect=<tgt>	Assume unannotated indirect branches behavior
7076			according to <tgt> --
7077			exit:	branch out from the current context (default)
7078			labels:	all labels in context may be branch targets
7079       */
7080      if (strncmp (arg, "indirect=", 9) != 0)
7081        return 0;
7082      break;
7083
7084    case 'x':
7085      /* -X conflicts with an ignored option, use -x instead */
7086      md.detect_dv = 1;
7087      if (!arg || strcmp (arg, "explicit") == 0)
7088	{
7089	  /* set default mode to explicit */
7090	  md.default_explicit_mode = 1;
7091	  break;
7092	}
7093      else if (strcmp (arg, "auto") == 0)
7094	{
7095	  md.default_explicit_mode = 0;
7096	}
7097      else if (strcmp (arg, "none") == 0)
7098	{
7099	  md.detect_dv = 0;
7100	}
7101      else if (strcmp (arg, "debug") == 0)
7102	{
7103	  md.debug_dv = 1;
7104	}
7105      else if (strcmp (arg, "debugx") == 0)
7106	{
7107	  md.default_explicit_mode = 1;
7108	  md.debug_dv = 1;
7109	}
7110      else if (strcmp (arg, "debugn") == 0)
7111	{
7112	  md.debug_dv = 1;
7113	  md.detect_dv = 0;
7114	}
7115      else
7116	{
7117	  as_bad (_("Unrecognized option '-x%s'"), arg);
7118	}
7119      break;
7120
7121    case 'S':
7122      /* nops		Print nops statistics.  */
7123      break;
7124
7125    /* GNU specific switches for gcc.  */
7126    case OPTION_MCONSTANT_GP:
7127      md.flags |= EF_IA_64_CONS_GP;
7128      break;
7129
7130    case OPTION_MAUTO_PIC:
7131      md.flags |= EF_IA_64_NOFUNCDESC_CONS_GP;
7132      break;
7133
7134    default:
7135      return 0;
7136    }
7137
7138  return 1;
7139}
7140
7141void
7142md_show_usage (FILE *stream)
7143{
7144  fputs (_("\
7145IA-64 options:\n\
7146  --mconstant-gp	  mark output file as using the constant-GP model\n\
7147			  (sets ELF header flag EF_IA_64_CONS_GP)\n\
7148  --mauto-pic		  mark output file as using the constant-GP model\n\
7149			  without function descriptors (sets ELF header flag\n\
7150			  EF_IA_64_NOFUNCDESC_CONS_GP)\n\
7151  -milp32|-milp64|-mlp64|-mp64	select data model (default -mlp64)\n\
7152  -mle | -mbe		  select little- or big-endian byte order (default -mle)\n\
7153  -mtune=[itanium1|itanium2]\n\
7154			  tune for a specific CPU (default -mtune=itanium2)\n\
7155  -munwind-check=[warning|error]\n\
7156			  unwind directive check (default -munwind-check=warning)\n\
7157  -mhint.b=[ok|warning|error]\n\
7158			  hint.b check (default -mhint.b=error)\n\
7159  -x | -xexplicit	  turn on dependency violation checking\n"), stream);
7160  /* Note for translators: "automagically" can be translated as "automatically" here.  */
7161  fputs (_("\
7162  -xauto		  automagically remove dependency violations (default)\n\
7163  -xnone		  turn off dependency violation checking\n\
7164  -xdebug		  debug dependency violation checker\n\
7165  -xdebugn		  debug dependency violation checker but turn off\n\
7166			  dependency violation checking\n\
7167  -xdebugx		  debug dependency violation checker and turn on\n\
7168			  dependency violation checking\n"),
7169	stream);
7170}
7171
7172void
7173ia64_after_parse_args (void)
7174{
7175  if (debug_type == DEBUG_STABS)
7176    as_fatal (_("--gstabs is not supported for ia64"));
7177}
7178
7179/* Return true if TYPE fits in TEMPL at SLOT.  */
7180
7181static int
7182match (int templ, int type, int slot)
7183{
7184  enum ia64_unit unit;
7185  int result;
7186
7187  unit = ia64_templ_desc[templ].exec_unit[slot];
7188  switch (type)
7189    {
7190    case IA64_TYPE_DYN: result = 1; break; /* for nop and break */
7191    case IA64_TYPE_A:
7192      result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_I || unit == IA64_UNIT_M);
7193      break;
7194    case IA64_TYPE_X:	result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_L); break;
7195    case IA64_TYPE_I:	result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_I); break;
7196    case IA64_TYPE_M:	result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_M); break;
7197    case IA64_TYPE_B:	result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_B); break;
7198    case IA64_TYPE_F:	result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_F); break;
7199    default:		result = 0; break;
7200    }
7201  return result;
7202}
7203
7204/* For Itanium 1, add a bit of extra goodness if a nop of type F or B would fit
7205   in TEMPL at SLOT.  For Itanium 2, add a bit of extra goodness if a nop of
7206   type M or I would fit in TEMPL at SLOT.  */
7207
7208static inline int
7209extra_goodness (int templ, int slot)
7210{
7211  switch (md.tune)
7212    {
7213    case itanium1:
7214      if (slot == 1 && match (templ, IA64_TYPE_F, slot))
7215	return 2;
7216      else if (slot == 2 && match (templ, IA64_TYPE_B, slot))
7217	return 1;
7218      else
7219	return 0;
7220      break;
7221    case itanium2:
7222      if (match (templ, IA64_TYPE_M, slot)
7223	  || match (templ, IA64_TYPE_I, slot))
7224	/* Favor M- and I-unit NOPs.  We definitely want to avoid
7225	   F-unit and B-unit may cause split-issue or less-than-optimal
7226	   branch-prediction.  */
7227	return 2;
7228      else
7229	return 0;
7230      break;
7231    default:
7232      abort ();
7233      return 0;
7234    }
7235}
7236
7237/* This function is called once, at assembler startup time.  It sets
7238   up all the tables, etc. that the MD part of the assembler will need
7239   that can be determined before arguments are parsed.  */
7240void
7241md_begin (void)
7242{
7243  int i, j, k, t, goodness, best, ok;
7244  const char *err;
7245  char name[8];
7246
7247  md.auto_align = 1;
7248  md.explicit_mode = md.default_explicit_mode;
7249
7250  bfd_set_section_alignment (text_section, 4);
7251
7252  /* Make sure function pointers get initialized.  */
7253  target_big_endian = -1;
7254  dot_byteorder (default_big_endian);
7255
7256  alias_hash = hash_new ();
7257  alias_name_hash = hash_new ();
7258  secalias_hash = hash_new ();
7259  secalias_name_hash = hash_new ();
7260
7261  pseudo_func[FUNC_DTP_MODULE].u.sym =
7262    symbol_new (".<dtpmod>", undefined_section, FUNC_DTP_MODULE,
7263		&zero_address_frag);
7264
7265  pseudo_func[FUNC_DTP_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7266    symbol_new (".<dtprel>", undefined_section, FUNC_DTP_RELATIVE,
7267		&zero_address_frag);
7268
7269  pseudo_func[FUNC_FPTR_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7270    symbol_new (".<fptr>", undefined_section, FUNC_FPTR_RELATIVE,
7271		&zero_address_frag);
7272
7273  pseudo_func[FUNC_GP_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7274    symbol_new (".<gprel>", undefined_section, FUNC_GP_RELATIVE,
7275		&zero_address_frag);
7276
7277  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7278    symbol_new (".<ltoff>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_RELATIVE,
7279		&zero_address_frag);
7280
7281  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_RELATIVE_X].u.sym =
7282    symbol_new (".<ltoffx>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_RELATIVE_X,
7283		&zero_address_frag);
7284
7285  pseudo_func[FUNC_PC_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7286    symbol_new (".<pcrel>", undefined_section, FUNC_PC_RELATIVE,
7287		&zero_address_frag);
7288
7289  pseudo_func[FUNC_PLT_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7290    symbol_new (".<pltoff>", undefined_section, FUNC_PLT_RELATIVE,
7291		&zero_address_frag);
7292
7293  pseudo_func[FUNC_SEC_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7294    symbol_new (".<secrel>", undefined_section, FUNC_SEC_RELATIVE,
7295		&zero_address_frag);
7296
7297  pseudo_func[FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7298    symbol_new (".<segrel>", undefined_section, FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE,
7299		&zero_address_frag);
7300
7301  pseudo_func[FUNC_TP_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7302    symbol_new (".<tprel>", undefined_section, FUNC_TP_RELATIVE,
7303		&zero_address_frag);
7304
7305  pseudo_func[FUNC_LTV_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7306    symbol_new (".<ltv>", undefined_section, FUNC_LTV_RELATIVE,
7307		&zero_address_frag);
7308
7309  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7310    symbol_new (".<ltoff.fptr>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE,
7311		&zero_address_frag);
7312
7313  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE].u.sym =
7314    symbol_new (".<ltoff.dtpmod>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE,
7315		&zero_address_frag);
7316
7317  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7318    symbol_new (".<ltoff.dptrel>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE,
7319		&zero_address_frag);
7320
7321  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7322    symbol_new (".<ltoff.tprel>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE,
7323		&zero_address_frag);
7324
7325  pseudo_func[FUNC_IPLT_RELOC].u.sym =
7326    symbol_new (".<iplt>", undefined_section, FUNC_IPLT_RELOC,
7327		&zero_address_frag);
7328
7329#ifdef TE_VMS
7330  pseudo_func[FUNC_SLOTCOUNT_RELOC].u.sym =
7331    symbol_new (".<slotcount>", undefined_section, FUNC_SLOTCOUNT_RELOC,
7332		&zero_address_frag);
7333#endif
7334
7335 if (md.tune != itanium1)
7336   {
7337     /* Convert MFI NOPs bundles into MMI NOPs bundles.  */
7338     le_nop[0] = 0x8;
7339     le_nop_stop[0] = 0x9;
7340   }
7341
7342  /* Compute the table of best templates.  We compute goodness as a
7343     base 4 value, in which each match counts for 3.  Match-failures
7344     result in NOPs and we use extra_goodness() to pick the execution
7345     units that are best suited for issuing the NOP.  */
7346  for (i = 0; i < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++i)
7347    for (j = 0; j < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++j)
7348      for (k = 0; k < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++k)
7349	{
7350	  best = 0;
7351	  for (t = 0; t < NELEMS (ia64_templ_desc); ++t)
7352	    {
7353	      goodness = 0;
7354	      if (match (t, i, 0))
7355		{
7356		  if (match (t, j, 1))
7357		    {
7358		      if ((t == 2 && j == IA64_TYPE_X) || match (t, k, 2))
7359			goodness = 3 + 3 + 3;
7360		      else
7361			goodness = 3 + 3 + extra_goodness (t, 2);
7362		    }
7363		  else if (match (t, j, 2))
7364		    goodness = 3 + 3 + extra_goodness (t, 1);
7365		  else
7366		    {
7367		      goodness = 3;
7368		      goodness += extra_goodness (t, 1);
7369		      goodness += extra_goodness (t, 2);
7370		    }
7371		}
7372	      else if (match (t, i, 1))
7373		{
7374		  if ((t == 2 && i == IA64_TYPE_X) || match (t, j, 2))
7375		    goodness = 3 + 3;
7376		  else
7377		    goodness = 3 + extra_goodness (t, 2);
7378		}
7379	      else if (match (t, i, 2))
7380		goodness = 3 + extra_goodness (t, 1);
7381
7382	      if (goodness > best)
7383		{
7384		  best = goodness;
7385		  best_template[i][j][k] = t;
7386		}
7387	    }
7388	}
7389
7390#ifdef DEBUG_TEMPLATES
7391  /* For debugging changes to the best_template calculations.  We don't care
7392     about combinations with invalid instructions, so start the loops at 1.  */
7393  for (i = 0; i < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++i)
7394    for (j = 0; j < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++j)
7395      for (k = 0; k < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++k)
7396	{
7397	  char type_letter[IA64_NUM_TYPES] = { 'n', 'a', 'i', 'm', 'b', 'f',
7398					       'x', 'd' };
7399	  fprintf (stderr, "%c%c%c %s\n", type_letter[i], type_letter[j],
7400		   type_letter[k],
7401		   ia64_templ_desc[best_template[i][j][k]].name);
7402	}
7403#endif
7404
7405  for (i = 0; i < NUM_SLOTS; ++i)
7406    md.slot[i].user_template = -1;
7407
7408  md.pseudo_hash = hash_new ();
7409  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (pseudo_opcode); ++i)
7410    {
7411      err = hash_insert (md.pseudo_hash, pseudo_opcode[i].name,
7412			 (void *) (pseudo_opcode + i));
7413      if (err)
7414	as_fatal (_("ia64.md_begin: can't hash `%s': %s"),
7415		  pseudo_opcode[i].name, err);
7416    }
7417
7418  md.reg_hash = hash_new ();
7419  md.dynreg_hash = hash_new ();
7420  md.const_hash = hash_new ();
7421  md.entry_hash = hash_new ();
7422
7423  /* general registers:  */
7424  declare_register_set ("r", 128, REG_GR);
7425  declare_register ("gp", REG_GR +  1);
7426  declare_register ("sp", REG_GR + 12);
7427  declare_register ("tp", REG_GR + 13);
7428  declare_register_set ("ret", 4, REG_GR + 8);
7429
7430  /* floating point registers:  */
7431  declare_register_set ("f", 128, REG_FR);
7432  declare_register_set ("farg", 8, REG_FR + 8);
7433  declare_register_set ("fret", 8, REG_FR + 8);
7434
7435  /* branch registers:  */
7436  declare_register_set ("b", 8, REG_BR);
7437  declare_register ("rp", REG_BR + 0);
7438
7439  /* predicate registers:  */
7440  declare_register_set ("p", 64, REG_P);
7441  declare_register ("pr", REG_PR);
7442  declare_register ("pr.rot", REG_PR_ROT);
7443
7444  /* application registers:  */
7445  declare_register_set ("ar", 128, REG_AR);
7446  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (ar); ++i)
7447    declare_register (ar[i].name, REG_AR + ar[i].regnum);
7448
7449  /* control registers:  */
7450  declare_register_set ("cr", 128, REG_CR);
7451  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (cr); ++i)
7452    declare_register (cr[i].name, REG_CR + cr[i].regnum);
7453
7454  /* dahr registers:  */
7455  declare_register_set ("dahr", 8, REG_DAHR);
7456
7457  declare_register ("ip", REG_IP);
7458  declare_register ("cfm", REG_CFM);
7459  declare_register ("psr", REG_PSR);
7460  declare_register ("psr.l", REG_PSR_L);
7461  declare_register ("psr.um", REG_PSR_UM);
7462
7463  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (indirect_reg); ++i)
7464    {
7465      unsigned int regnum = indirect_reg[i].regnum;
7466
7467      md.indregsym[regnum - IND_CPUID] = declare_register (indirect_reg[i].name, regnum);
7468    }
7469
7470  /* pseudo-registers used to specify unwind info:  */
7471  declare_register ("psp", REG_PSP);
7472
7473  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (const_bits); ++i)
7474    {
7475      err = hash_insert (md.const_hash, const_bits[i].name,
7476			 (void *) (const_bits + i));
7477      if (err)
7478	as_fatal (_("Inserting \"%s\" into constant hash table failed: %s"),
7479		  name, err);
7480    }
7481
7482  /* Set the architecture and machine depending on defaults and command line
7483     options.  */
7484  if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
7485    ok = bfd_set_arch_mach (stdoutput, bfd_arch_ia64, bfd_mach_ia64_elf64);
7486  else
7487    ok = bfd_set_arch_mach (stdoutput, bfd_arch_ia64, bfd_mach_ia64_elf32);
7488
7489  if (! ok)
7490     as_warn (_("Could not set architecture and machine"));
7491
7492  /* Set the pointer size and pointer shift size depending on md.flags */
7493
7494  if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
7495    {
7496      md.pointer_size = 8;         /* pointers are 8 bytes */
7497      md.pointer_size_shift = 3;   /* alignment is 8 bytes = 2^2 */
7498    }
7499  else
7500    {
7501      md.pointer_size = 4;         /* pointers are 4 bytes */
7502      md.pointer_size_shift = 2;   /* alignment is 4 bytes = 2^2 */
7503    }
7504
7505  md.mem_offset.hint = 0;
7506  md.path = 0;
7507  md.maxpaths = 0;
7508  md.entry_labels = NULL;
7509}
7510
7511/* Set the default options in md.  Cannot do this in md_begin because
7512   that is called after md_parse_option which is where we set the
7513   options in md based on command line options.  */
7514
7515void
7516ia64_init (int argc ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **argv ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7517{
7518  md.flags = MD_FLAGS_DEFAULT;
7519#ifndef TE_VMS
7520  /* Don't turn on dependency checking for VMS, doesn't work.  */
7521  md.detect_dv = 1;
7522#endif
7523  /* FIXME: We should change it to unwind_check_error someday.  */
7524  md.unwind_check = unwind_check_warning;
7525  md.hint_b = hint_b_error;
7526  md.tune = itanium2;
7527}
7528
7529/* Return a string for the target object file format.  */
7530
7531const char *
7532ia64_target_format (void)
7533{
7534  if (OUTPUT_FLAVOR == bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7535    {
7536      if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_BE)
7537	{
7538	  if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
7539#if defined(TE_AIX50)
7540	    return "elf64-ia64-aix-big";
7541#elif defined(TE_HPUX)
7542	    return "elf64-ia64-hpux-big";
7543#else
7544	    return "elf64-ia64-big";
7545#endif
7546	  else
7547#if defined(TE_AIX50)
7548	    return "elf32-ia64-aix-big";
7549#elif defined(TE_HPUX)
7550	    return "elf32-ia64-hpux-big";
7551#else
7552	    return "elf32-ia64-big";
7553#endif
7554	}
7555      else
7556	{
7557	  if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
7558#if defined (TE_AIX50)
7559	    return "elf64-ia64-aix-little";
7560#elif defined (TE_VMS)
7561	  {
7562	    md.flags |= EF_IA_64_ARCHVER_1;
7563	    return "elf64-ia64-vms";
7564	  }
7565#else
7566	    return "elf64-ia64-little";
7567#endif
7568	  else
7569#ifdef TE_AIX50
7570	    return "elf32-ia64-aix-little";
7571#else
7572	    return "elf32-ia64-little";
7573#endif
7574	}
7575    }
7576  else
7577    return "unknown-format";
7578}
7579
7580void
7581ia64_end_of_source (void)
7582{
7583  /* terminate insn group upon reaching end of file:  */
7584  insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
7585
7586  /* emits slots we haven't written yet:  */
7587  ia64_flush_insns ();
7588
7589  bfd_set_private_flags (stdoutput, md.flags);
7590
7591  md.mem_offset.hint = 0;
7592}
7593
7594void
7595ia64_start_line (void)
7596{
7597  static int first;
7598
7599  if (!first) {
7600    /* Make sure we don't reference input_line_pointer[-1] when that's
7601       not valid.  */
7602    first = 1;
7603    return;
7604  }
7605
7606  if (md.qp.X_op == O_register)
7607    as_bad (_("qualifying predicate not followed by instruction"));
7608  md.qp.X_op = O_absent;
7609
7610  if (ignore_input ())
7611    return;
7612
7613  if (input_line_pointer[0] == ';' && input_line_pointer[-1] == ';')
7614    {
7615      if (md.detect_dv && !md.explicit_mode)
7616	{
7617	  static int warned;
7618
7619	  if (!warned)
7620	    {
7621	      warned = 1;
7622	      as_warn (_("Explicit stops are ignored in auto mode"));
7623	    }
7624	}
7625      else
7626	insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
7627    }
7628  else if (input_line_pointer[-1] == '{')
7629    {
7630      if (md.manual_bundling)
7631	as_warn (_("Found '{' when manual bundling is already turned on"));
7632      else
7633	CURR_SLOT.manual_bundling_on = 1;
7634      md.manual_bundling = 1;
7635
7636      /* Bundling is only acceptable in explicit mode
7637	 or when in default automatic mode.  */
7638      if (md.detect_dv && !md.explicit_mode)
7639	{
7640	  if (!md.mode_explicitly_set
7641	      && !md.default_explicit_mode)
7642	    dot_dv_mode ('E');
7643	  else
7644	    as_warn (_("Found '{' after explicit switch to automatic mode"));
7645	}
7646    }
7647  else if (input_line_pointer[-1] == '}')
7648    {
7649      if (!md.manual_bundling)
7650	as_warn (_("Found '}' when manual bundling is off"));
7651      else
7652	PREV_SLOT.manual_bundling_off = 1;
7653      md.manual_bundling = 0;
7654
7655      /* switch back to automatic mode, if applicable */
7656      if (md.detect_dv
7657	  && md.explicit_mode
7658	  && !md.mode_explicitly_set
7659	  && !md.default_explicit_mode)
7660	dot_dv_mode ('A');
7661    }
7662}
7663
7664/* This is a hook for ia64_frob_label, so that it can distinguish tags from
7665   labels.  */
7666static int defining_tag = 0;
7667
7668int
7669ia64_unrecognized_line (int ch)
7670{
7671  switch (ch)
7672    {
7673    case '(':
7674      expression_and_evaluate (&md.qp);
7675      if (*input_line_pointer++ != ')')
7676	{
7677	  as_bad (_("Expected ')'"));
7678	  return 0;
7679	}
7680      if (md.qp.X_op != O_register)
7681	{
7682	  as_bad (_("Qualifying predicate expected"));
7683	  return 0;
7684	}
7685      if (md.qp.X_add_number < REG_P || md.qp.X_add_number >= REG_P + 64)
7686	{
7687	  as_bad (_("Predicate register expected"));
7688	  return 0;
7689	}
7690      return 1;
7691
7692    case '[':
7693      {
7694	char *s;
7695	char c;
7696	symbolS *tag;
7697	int temp;
7698
7699	if (md.qp.X_op == O_register)
7700	  {
7701	    as_bad (_("Tag must come before qualifying predicate."));
7702	    return 0;
7703	  }
7704
7705	/* This implements just enough of read_a_source_file in read.c to
7706	   recognize labels.  */
7707	if (is_name_beginner (*input_line_pointer))
7708	  {
7709	    c = get_symbol_name (&s);
7710	  }
7711	else if (LOCAL_LABELS_FB
7712		 && ISDIGIT (*input_line_pointer))
7713	  {
7714	    temp = 0;
7715	    while (ISDIGIT (*input_line_pointer))
7716	      temp = (temp * 10) + *input_line_pointer++ - '0';
7717	    fb_label_instance_inc (temp);
7718	    s = fb_label_name (temp, 0);
7719	    c = *input_line_pointer;
7720	  }
7721	else
7722	  {
7723	    s = NULL;
7724	    c = '\0';
7725	  }
7726	if (c != ':')
7727	  {
7728	    /* Put ':' back for error messages' sake.  */
7729	    *input_line_pointer++ = ':';
7730	    as_bad (_("Expected ':'"));
7731	    return 0;
7732	  }
7733
7734	defining_tag = 1;
7735	tag = colon (s);
7736	defining_tag = 0;
7737	/* Put ':' back for error messages' sake.  */
7738	*input_line_pointer++ = ':';
7739	if (*input_line_pointer++ != ']')
7740	  {
7741	    as_bad (_("Expected ']'"));
7742	    return 0;
7743	  }
7744	if (! tag)
7745	  {
7746	    as_bad (_("Tag name expected"));
7747	    return 0;
7748	  }
7749	return 1;
7750      }
7751
7752    default:
7753      break;
7754    }
7755
7756  /* Not a valid line.  */
7757  return 0;
7758}
7759
7760void
7761ia64_frob_label (struct symbol *sym)
7762{
7763  struct label_fix *fix;
7764
7765  /* Tags need special handling since they are not bundle breaks like
7766     labels.  */
7767  if (defining_tag)
7768    {
7769      fix = XOBNEW (&notes, struct label_fix);
7770      fix->sym = sym;
7771      fix->next = CURR_SLOT.tag_fixups;
7772      fix->dw2_mark_labels = FALSE;
7773      CURR_SLOT.tag_fixups = fix;
7774
7775      return;
7776    }
7777
7778  if (bfd_section_flags (now_seg) & SEC_CODE)
7779    {
7780      md.last_text_seg = now_seg;
7781      fix = XOBNEW (&notes, struct label_fix);
7782      fix->sym = sym;
7783      fix->next = CURR_SLOT.label_fixups;
7784      fix->dw2_mark_labels = dwarf2_loc_mark_labels;
7785      CURR_SLOT.label_fixups = fix;
7786
7787      /* Keep track of how many code entry points we've seen.  */
7788      if (md.path == md.maxpaths)
7789	{
7790	  md.maxpaths += 20;
7791	  md.entry_labels = XRESIZEVEC (const char *, md.entry_labels,
7792					md.maxpaths);
7793	}
7794      md.entry_labels[md.path++] = S_GET_NAME (sym);
7795    }
7796}
7797
7798#ifdef TE_HPUX
7799/* The HP-UX linker will give unresolved symbol errors for symbols
7800   that are declared but unused.  This routine removes declared,
7801   unused symbols from an object.  */
7802int
7803ia64_frob_symbol (struct symbol *sym)
7804{
7805  if ((S_GET_SEGMENT (sym) == bfd_und_section_ptr && ! symbol_used_p (sym) &&
7806       ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (S_GET_OTHER (sym)) == STV_DEFAULT)
7807      || (S_GET_SEGMENT (sym) == bfd_abs_section_ptr
7808	  && ! S_IS_EXTERNAL (sym)))
7809    return 1;
7810  return 0;
7811}
7812#endif
7813
7814void
7815ia64_flush_pending_output (void)
7816{
7817  if (!md.keep_pending_output
7818      && bfd_section_flags (now_seg) & SEC_CODE)
7819    {
7820      /* ??? This causes many unnecessary stop bits to be emitted.
7821	 Unfortunately, it isn't clear if it is safe to remove this.  */
7822      insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
7823      ia64_flush_insns ();
7824    }
7825}
7826
7827/* Do ia64-specific expression optimization.  All that's done here is
7828   to transform index expressions that are either due to the indexing
7829   of rotating registers or due to the indexing of indirect register
7830   sets.  */
7831int
7832ia64_optimize_expr (expressionS *l, operatorT op, expressionS *r)
7833{
7834  if (op != O_index)
7835    return 0;
7836  resolve_expression (l);
7837  if (l->X_op == O_register)
7838    {
7839      unsigned num_regs = l->X_add_number >> 16;
7840
7841      resolve_expression (r);
7842      if (num_regs)
7843	{
7844	  /* Left side is a .rotX-allocated register.  */
7845	  if (r->X_op != O_constant)
7846	    {
7847	      as_bad (_("Rotating register index must be a non-negative constant"));
7848	      r->X_add_number = 0;
7849	    }
7850	  else if ((valueT) r->X_add_number >= num_regs)
7851	    {
7852	      as_bad (_("Index out of range 0..%u"), num_regs - 1);
7853	      r->X_add_number = 0;
7854	    }
7855	  l->X_add_number = (l->X_add_number & 0xffff) + r->X_add_number;
7856	  return 1;
7857	}
7858      else if (l->X_add_number >= IND_CPUID && l->X_add_number <= IND_RR)
7859	{
7860	  if (r->X_op != O_register
7861	      || r->X_add_number < REG_GR
7862	      || r->X_add_number > REG_GR + 127)
7863	    {
7864	      as_bad (_("Indirect register index must be a general register"));
7865	      r->X_add_number = REG_GR;
7866	    }
7867	  l->X_op = O_index;
7868	  l->X_op_symbol = md.indregsym[l->X_add_number - IND_CPUID];
7869	  l->X_add_number = r->X_add_number;
7870	  return 1;
7871	}
7872    }
7873  as_bad (_("Index can only be applied to rotating or indirect registers"));
7874  /* Fall back to some register use of which has as little as possible
7875     side effects, to minimize subsequent error messages.  */
7876  l->X_op = O_register;
7877  l->X_add_number = REG_GR + 3;
7878  return 1;
7879}
7880
7881int
7882ia64_parse_name (char *name, expressionS *e, char *nextcharP)
7883{
7884  struct const_desc *cdesc;
7885  struct dynreg *dr = 0;
7886  unsigned int idx;
7887  struct symbol *sym;
7888  char *end;
7889
7890  if (*name == '@')
7891    {
7892      enum pseudo_type pseudo_type = PSEUDO_FUNC_NONE;
7893
7894      /* Find what relocation pseudo-function we're dealing with.  */
7895      for (idx = 0; idx < NELEMS (pseudo_func); ++idx)
7896	if (pseudo_func[idx].name
7897	    && pseudo_func[idx].name[0] == name[1]
7898	    && strcmp (pseudo_func[idx].name + 1, name + 2) == 0)
7899	  {
7900	    pseudo_type = pseudo_func[idx].type;
7901	    break;
7902	  }
7903      switch (pseudo_type)
7904	{
7905	case PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC:
7906	  end = input_line_pointer;
7907	  if (*nextcharP != '(')
7908	    {
7909	      as_bad (_("Expected '('"));
7910	      break;
7911	    }
7912	  /* Skip '('.  */
7913	  ++input_line_pointer;
7914	  expression (e);
7915	  if (*input_line_pointer != ')')
7916	    {
7917	      as_bad (_("Missing ')'"));
7918	      goto done;
7919	    }
7920	  /* Skip ')'.  */
7921	  ++input_line_pointer;
7922#ifdef TE_VMS
7923          if (idx == FUNC_SLOTCOUNT_RELOC)
7924            {
7925              /* @slotcount can accept any expression.  Canonicalize.  */
7926              e->X_add_symbol = make_expr_symbol (e);
7927              e->X_op = O_symbol;
7928              e->X_add_number = 0;
7929            }
7930#endif
7931	  if (e->X_op != O_symbol)
7932	    {
7933	      if (e->X_op != O_pseudo_fixup)
7934		{
7935		  as_bad (_("Not a symbolic expression"));
7936		  goto done;
7937		}
7938	      if (idx != FUNC_LT_RELATIVE)
7939		{
7940		  as_bad (_("Illegal combination of relocation functions"));
7941		  goto done;
7942		}
7943	      switch (S_GET_VALUE (e->X_op_symbol))
7944		{
7945		case FUNC_FPTR_RELATIVE:
7946		  idx = FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE; break;
7947		case FUNC_DTP_MODULE:
7948		  idx = FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE; break;
7949		case FUNC_DTP_RELATIVE:
7950		  idx = FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE; break;
7951		case FUNC_TP_RELATIVE:
7952		  idx = FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE; break;
7953		default:
7954		  as_bad (_("Illegal combination of relocation functions"));
7955		  goto done;
7956		}
7957	    }
7958	  /* Make sure gas doesn't get rid of local symbols that are used
7959	     in relocs.  */
7960	  e->X_op = O_pseudo_fixup;
7961	  e->X_op_symbol = pseudo_func[idx].u.sym;
7962	done:
7963	  *nextcharP = *input_line_pointer;
7964	  break;
7965
7966	case PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST:
7967	  e->X_op = O_constant;
7968	  e->X_add_number = pseudo_func[idx].u.ival;
7969	  break;
7970
7971	case PSEUDO_FUNC_REG:
7972	  e->X_op = O_register;
7973	  e->X_add_number = pseudo_func[idx].u.ival;
7974	  break;
7975
7976	default:
7977	  return 0;
7978	}
7979      return 1;
7980    }
7981
7982  /* first see if NAME is a known register name:  */
7983  sym = hash_find (md.reg_hash, name);
7984  if (sym)
7985    {
7986      e->X_op = O_register;
7987      e->X_add_number = S_GET_VALUE (sym);
7988      return 1;
7989    }
7990
7991  cdesc = hash_find (md.const_hash, name);
7992  if (cdesc)
7993    {
7994      e->X_op = O_constant;
7995      e->X_add_number = cdesc->value;
7996      return 1;
7997    }
7998
7999  /* check for inN, locN, or outN:  */
8000  idx = 0;
8001  switch (name[0])
8002    {
8003    case 'i':
8004      if (name[1] == 'n' && ISDIGIT (name[2]))
8005	{
8006	  dr = &md.in;
8007	  idx = 2;
8008	}
8009      break;
8010
8011    case 'l':
8012      if (name[1] == 'o' && name[2] == 'c' && ISDIGIT (name[3]))
8013	{
8014	  dr = &md.loc;
8015	  idx = 3;
8016	}
8017      break;
8018
8019    case 'o':
8020      if (name[1] == 'u' && name[2] == 't' && ISDIGIT (name[3]))
8021	{
8022	  dr = &md.out;
8023	  idx = 3;
8024	}
8025      break;
8026
8027    default:
8028      break;
8029    }
8030
8031  /* Ignore register numbers with leading zeroes, except zero itself.  */
8032  if (dr && (name[idx] != '0' || name[idx + 1] == '\0'))
8033    {
8034      unsigned long regnum;
8035
8036      /* The name is inN, locN, or outN; parse the register number.  */
8037      regnum = strtoul (name + idx, &end, 10);
8038      if (end > name + idx && *end == '\0' && regnum < 96)
8039	{
8040	  if (regnum >= dr->num_regs)
8041	    {
8042	      if (!dr->num_regs)
8043		as_bad (_("No current frame"));
8044	      else
8045		as_bad (_("Register number out of range 0..%u"),
8046			dr->num_regs - 1);
8047	      regnum = 0;
8048	    }
8049	  e->X_op = O_register;
8050	  e->X_add_number = dr->base + regnum;
8051	  return 1;
8052	}
8053    }
8054
8055  end = xstrdup (name);
8056  name = ia64_canonicalize_symbol_name (end);
8057  if ((dr = hash_find (md.dynreg_hash, name)))
8058    {
8059      /* We've got ourselves the name of a rotating register set.
8060	 Store the base register number in the low 16 bits of
8061	 X_add_number and the size of the register set in the top 16
8062	 bits.  */
8063      e->X_op = O_register;
8064      e->X_add_number = dr->base | (dr->num_regs << 16);
8065      free (end);
8066      return 1;
8067    }
8068  free (end);
8069  return 0;
8070}
8071
8072/* Remove the '#' suffix that indicates a symbol as opposed to a register.  */
8073
8074char *
8075ia64_canonicalize_symbol_name (char *name)
8076{
8077  size_t len = strlen (name), full = len;
8078
8079  while (len > 0 && name[len - 1] == '#')
8080    --len;
8081  if (len <= 0)
8082    {
8083      if (full > 0)
8084	as_bad (_("Standalone `#' is illegal"));
8085    }
8086  else if (len < full - 1)
8087    as_warn (_("Redundant `#' suffix operators"));
8088  name[len] = '\0';
8089  return name;
8090}
8091
8092/* Return true if idesc is a conditional branch instruction.  This excludes
8093   the modulo scheduled branches, and br.ia.  Mod-sched branches are excluded
8094   because they always read/write resources regardless of the value of the
8095   qualifying predicate.  br.ia must always use p0, and hence is always
8096   taken.  Thus this function returns true for branches which can fall
8097   through, and which use no resources if they do fall through.  */
8098
8099static int
8100is_conditional_branch (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
8101{
8102  /* br is a conditional branch.  Everything that starts with br. except
8103     br.ia, br.c{loop,top,exit}, and br.w{top,exit} is a conditional branch.
8104     Everything that starts with brl is a conditional branch.  */
8105  return (idesc->name[0] == 'b' && idesc->name[1] == 'r'
8106	  && (idesc->name[2] == '\0'
8107	      || (idesc->name[2] == '.' && idesc->name[3] != 'i'
8108		  && idesc->name[3] != 'c' && idesc->name[3] != 'w')
8109	      || idesc->name[2] == 'l'
8110	      /* br.cond, br.call, br.clr  */
8111	      || (idesc->name[2] == '.' && idesc->name[3] == 'c'
8112		  && (idesc->name[4] == 'a' || idesc->name[4] == 'o'
8113		      || (idesc->name[4] == 'l' && idesc->name[5] == 'r')))));
8114}
8115
8116/* Return whether the given opcode is a taken branch.  If there's any doubt,
8117   returns zero.  */
8118
8119static int
8120is_taken_branch (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
8121{
8122  return ((is_conditional_branch (idesc) && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno == 0)
8123	  || strncmp (idesc->name, "br.ia", 5) == 0);
8124}
8125
8126/* Return whether the given opcode is an interruption or rfi.  If there's any
8127   doubt, returns zero.  */
8128
8129static int
8130is_interruption_or_rfi (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
8131{
8132  if (strcmp (idesc->name, "rfi") == 0)
8133    return 1;
8134  return 0;
8135}
8136
8137/* Returns the index of the given dependency in the opcode's list of chks, or
8138   -1 if there is no dependency.  */
8139
8140static int
8141depends_on (int depind, struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
8142{
8143  int i;
8144  const struct ia64_opcode_dependency *dep = idesc->dependencies;
8145  for (i = 0; i < dep->nchks; i++)
8146    {
8147      if (depind == DEP (dep->chks[i]))
8148	return i;
8149    }
8150  return -1;
8151}
8152
8153/* Determine a set of specific resources used for a particular resource
8154   class.  Returns the number of specific resources identified  For those
8155   cases which are not determinable statically, the resource returned is
8156   marked nonspecific.
8157
8158   Meanings of value in 'NOTE':
8159   1) only read/write when the register number is explicitly encoded in the
8160   insn.
8161   2) only read CFM when accessing a rotating GR, FR, or PR.  mov pr only
8162   accesses CFM when qualifying predicate is in the rotating region.
8163   3) general register value is used to specify an indirect register; not
8164   determinable statically.
8165   4) only read the given resource when bits 7:0 of the indirect index
8166   register value does not match the register number of the resource; not
8167   determinable statically.
8168   5) all rules are implementation specific.
8169   6) only when both the index specified by the reader and the index specified
8170   by the writer have the same value in bits 63:61; not determinable
8171   statically.
8172   7) only access the specified resource when the corresponding mask bit is
8173   set
8174   8) PSR.dfh is only read when these insns reference FR32-127.  PSR.dfl is
8175   only read when these insns reference FR2-31
8176   9) PSR.mfl is only written when these insns write FR2-31.  PSR.mfh is only
8177   written when these insns write FR32-127
8178   10) The PSR.bn bit is only accessed when one of GR16-31 is specified in the
8179   instruction
8180   11) The target predicates are written independently of PR[qp], but source
8181   registers are only read if PR[qp] is true.  Since the state of PR[qp]
8182   cannot statically be determined, all source registers are marked used.
8183   12) This insn only reads the specified predicate register when that
8184   register is the PR[qp].
8185   13) This reference to ld-c only applies to the GR whose value is loaded
8186   with data returned from memory, not the post-incremented address register.
8187   14) The RSE resource includes the implementation-specific RSE internal
8188   state resources.  At least one (and possibly more) of these resources are
8189   read by each instruction listed in IC:rse-readers.  At least one (and
8190   possibly more) of these resources are written by each insn listed in
8191   IC:rse-writers.
8192   15+16) Represents reserved instructions, which the assembler does not
8193   generate.
8194   17) CR[TPR] has a RAW dependency only between mov-to-CR-TPR and
8195   mov-to-PSR-l or ssm instructions that set PSR.i, PSR.pp or PSR.up.
8196
8197   Memory resources (i.e. locations in memory) are *not* marked or tracked by
8198   this code; there are no dependency violations based on memory access.
8199*/
8200
8201#define MAX_SPECS 256
8202#define DV_CHK 1
8203#define DV_REG 0
8204
8205static int
8206specify_resource (const struct ia64_dependency *dep,
8207		  struct ia64_opcode *idesc,
8208		  /* is this a DV chk or a DV reg? */
8209		  int type,
8210		  /* returned specific resources */
8211		  struct rsrc specs[MAX_SPECS],
8212		  /* resource note for this insn's usage */
8213		  int note,
8214		  /* which execution path to examine */
8215		  int path)
8216{
8217  int count = 0;
8218  int i;
8219  int rsrc_write = 0;
8220  struct rsrc tmpl;
8221
8222  if (dep->mode == IA64_DV_WAW
8223      || (dep->mode == IA64_DV_RAW && type == DV_REG)
8224      || (dep->mode == IA64_DV_WAR && type == DV_CHK))
8225    rsrc_write = 1;
8226
8227  /* template for any resources we identify */
8228  tmpl.dependency = dep;
8229  tmpl.note = note;
8230  tmpl.insn_srlz = tmpl.data_srlz = 0;
8231  tmpl.qp_regno = CURR_SLOT.qp_regno;
8232  tmpl.link_to_qp_branch = 1;
8233  tmpl.mem_offset.hint = 0;
8234  tmpl.mem_offset.offset = 0;
8235  tmpl.mem_offset.base = 0;
8236  tmpl.specific = 1;
8237  tmpl.index = -1;
8238  tmpl.cmp_type = CMP_NONE;
8239  tmpl.depind = 0;
8240  tmpl.file = NULL;
8241  tmpl.line = 0;
8242  tmpl.path = 0;
8243
8244#define UNHANDLED \
8245as_warn (_("Unhandled dependency %s for %s (%s), note %d"), \
8246dep->name, idesc->name, (rsrc_write?"write":"read"), note)
8247#define KNOWN(REG) (gr_values[REG].known && gr_values[REG].path >= path)
8248
8249  /* we don't need to track these */
8250  if (dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_NONE)
8251    return 0;
8252
8253  switch (dep->specifier)
8254    {
8255    case IA64_RS_AR_K:
8256      if (note == 1)
8257	{
8258	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
8259	    {
8260	      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
8261	      if (regno >= 0 && regno <= 7)
8262		{
8263		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8264		  specs[count++].index = regno;
8265		}
8266	    }
8267	}
8268      else if (note == 0)
8269	{
8270	  for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
8271	    {
8272	      specs[count] = tmpl;
8273	      specs[count++].index = i;
8274	    }
8275	}
8276      else
8277	{
8278	  UNHANDLED;
8279	}
8280      break;
8281
8282    case IA64_RS_AR_UNAT:
8283      /* This is a mov =AR or mov AR= instruction.  */
8284      if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
8285	{
8286	  int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
8287	  if (regno == AR_UNAT)
8288	    {
8289	      specs[count++] = tmpl;
8290	    }
8291	}
8292      else
8293	{
8294	  /* This is a spill/fill, or other instruction that modifies the
8295	     unat register.  */
8296
8297	  /* Unless we can determine the specific bits used, mark the whole
8298	     thing; bits 8:3 of the memory address indicate the bit used in
8299	     UNAT.  The .mem.offset hint may be used to eliminate a small
8300	     subset of conflicts.  */
8301	  specs[count] = tmpl;
8302	  if (md.mem_offset.hint)
8303	    {
8304	      if (md.debug_dv)
8305		fprintf (stderr, "  Using hint for spill/fill\n");
8306	      /* The index isn't actually used, just set it to something
8307		 approximating the bit index.  */
8308	      specs[count].index = (md.mem_offset.offset >> 3) & 0x3F;
8309	      specs[count].mem_offset.hint = 1;
8310	      specs[count].mem_offset.offset = md.mem_offset.offset;
8311	      specs[count++].mem_offset.base = md.mem_offset.base;
8312	    }
8313	  else
8314	    {
8315	      specs[count++].specific = 0;
8316	    }
8317	}
8318      break;
8319
8320    case IA64_RS_AR:
8321      if (note == 1)
8322	{
8323	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
8324	    {
8325	      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
8326	      if ((regno >= 8 && regno <= 15)
8327		  || (regno >= 20 && regno <= 23)
8328		  || (regno >= 31 && regno <= 39)
8329		  || (regno >= 41 && regno <= 47)
8330		  || (regno >= 67 && regno <= 111))
8331		{
8332		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8333		  specs[count++].index = regno;
8334		}
8335	    }
8336	}
8337      else
8338	{
8339	  UNHANDLED;
8340	}
8341      break;
8342
8343    case IA64_RS_ARb:
8344      if (note == 1)
8345	{
8346	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
8347	    {
8348	      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
8349	      if ((regno >= 48 && regno <= 63)
8350		  || (regno >= 112 && regno <= 127))
8351		{
8352		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8353		  specs[count++].index = regno;
8354		}
8355	    }
8356	}
8357      else if (note == 0)
8358	{
8359	  for (i = 48; i < 64; i++)
8360	    {
8361	      specs[count] = tmpl;
8362	      specs[count++].index = i;
8363	    }
8364	  for (i = 112; i < 128; i++)
8365	    {
8366	      specs[count] = tmpl;
8367	      specs[count++].index = i;
8368	    }
8369	}
8370      else
8371	{
8372	  UNHANDLED;
8373	}
8374      break;
8375
8376    case IA64_RS_BR:
8377      if (note != 1)
8378	{
8379	  UNHANDLED;
8380	}
8381      else
8382	{
8383	  if (rsrc_write)
8384	    {
8385	      for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
8386		if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_B1
8387		    || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_B2)
8388		  {
8389		    specs[count] = tmpl;
8390		    specs[count++].index =
8391		      CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_BR;
8392		  }
8393	    }
8394	  else
8395	    {
8396	      for (i = idesc->num_outputs; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
8397		if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_B1
8398		    || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_B2)
8399		  {
8400		    specs[count] = tmpl;
8401		    specs[count++].index =
8402		      CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_BR;
8403		  }
8404	    }
8405	}
8406      break;
8407
8408    case IA64_RS_CPUID: /* four or more registers */
8409      if (note == 3)
8410	{
8411	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CPUID_R3)
8412	    {
8413	      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8414	      if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8415		  && KNOWN (regno))
8416		{
8417		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8418		  specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8419		}
8420	      else
8421		{
8422		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8423		  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8424		}
8425	    }
8426	}
8427      else
8428	{
8429	  UNHANDLED;
8430	}
8431      break;
8432
8433    case IA64_RS_DBR: /* four or more registers */
8434      if (note == 3)
8435	{
8436	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_DBR_R3)
8437	    {
8438	      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8439	      if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8440		  && KNOWN (regno))
8441		{
8442		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8443		  specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8444		}
8445	      else
8446		{
8447		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8448		  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8449		}
8450	    }
8451	}
8452      else if (note == 0 && !rsrc_write)
8453	{
8454	  specs[count] = tmpl;
8455	  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8456	}
8457      else
8458	{
8459	  UNHANDLED;
8460	}
8461      break;
8462
8463    case IA64_RS_IBR: /* four or more registers */
8464      if (note == 3)
8465	{
8466	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_IBR_R3)
8467	    {
8468	      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8469	      if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8470		  && KNOWN (regno))
8471		{
8472		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8473		  specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8474		}
8475	      else
8476		{
8477		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8478		  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8479		}
8480	    }
8481	}
8482      else
8483	{
8484	  UNHANDLED;
8485	}
8486      break;
8487
8488    case IA64_RS_MSR:
8489      if (note == 5)
8490	{
8491	  /* These are implementation specific.  Force all references to
8492	     conflict with all other references.  */
8493	  specs[count] = tmpl;
8494	  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8495	}
8496      else
8497	{
8498	  UNHANDLED;
8499	}
8500      break;
8501
8502    case IA64_RS_PKR: /* 16 or more registers */
8503      if (note == 3 || note == 4)
8504	{
8505	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PKR_R3)
8506	    {
8507	      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8508	      if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8509		  && KNOWN (regno))
8510		{
8511		  if (note == 3)
8512		    {
8513		      specs[count] = tmpl;
8514		      specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8515		    }
8516		  else
8517		    for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (gr_values); i++)
8518		      {
8519			/* Uses all registers *except* the one in R3.  */
8520			if ((unsigned)i != (gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF))
8521			  {
8522			    specs[count] = tmpl;
8523			    specs[count++].index = i;
8524			  }
8525		      }
8526		}
8527	      else
8528		{
8529		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8530		  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8531		}
8532	    }
8533	}
8534      else if (note == 0)
8535	{
8536	  /* probe et al.  */
8537	  specs[count] = tmpl;
8538	  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8539	}
8540      break;
8541
8542    case IA64_RS_PMC: /* four or more registers */
8543      if (note == 3)
8544	{
8545	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PMC_R3
8546	      || (!rsrc_write && idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_PMD_R3))
8547
8548	    {
8549	      int reg_index = ((idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_R3 && !rsrc_write)
8550			       ? 1 : !rsrc_write);
8551	      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[reg_index].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8552	      if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8553		  && KNOWN (regno))
8554		{
8555		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8556		  specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8557		}
8558	      else
8559		{
8560		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8561		  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8562		}
8563	    }
8564	}
8565      else
8566	{
8567	  UNHANDLED;
8568	}
8569      break;
8570
8571    case IA64_RS_PMD: /* four or more registers */
8572      if (note == 3)
8573	{
8574	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PMD_R3)
8575	    {
8576	      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8577	      if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8578		  && KNOWN (regno))
8579		{
8580		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8581		  specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8582		}
8583	      else
8584		{
8585		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8586		  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8587		}
8588	    }
8589	}
8590      else
8591	{
8592	  UNHANDLED;
8593	}
8594      break;
8595
8596    case IA64_RS_RR: /* eight registers */
8597      if (note == 6)
8598	{
8599	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_RR_R3)
8600	    {
8601	      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8602	      if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8603		  && KNOWN (regno))
8604		{
8605		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8606		  specs[count++].index = (gr_values[regno].value >> 61) & 0x7;
8607		}
8608	      else
8609		{
8610		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8611		  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8612		}
8613	    }
8614	}
8615      else if (note == 0 && !rsrc_write)
8616	{
8617	  specs[count] = tmpl;
8618	  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8619	}
8620      else
8621	{
8622	  UNHANDLED;
8623	}
8624      break;
8625
8626    case IA64_RS_CR_IRR:
8627      if (note == 0)
8628	{
8629	  /* handle mov-from-CR-IVR; it's a read that writes CR[IRR] */
8630	  int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_CR;
8631	  if (rsrc_write
8632	      && idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_CR3
8633	      && regno == CR_IVR)
8634	    {
8635	      for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
8636		{
8637		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8638		  specs[count++].index = CR_IRR0 + i;
8639		}
8640	    }
8641	}
8642      else if (note == 1)
8643	{
8644	  int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_CR;
8645	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CR3
8646	      && regno >= CR_IRR0
8647	      && regno <= CR_IRR3)
8648	    {
8649	      specs[count] = tmpl;
8650	      specs[count++].index = regno;
8651	    }
8652	}
8653      else
8654	{
8655	  UNHANDLED;
8656	}
8657      break;
8658
8659    case IA64_RS_CR_IIB:
8660      if (note != 0)
8661	{
8662	  UNHANDLED;
8663	}
8664      else
8665	{
8666	  int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_CR;
8667	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CR3
8668	      && (regno == CR_IIB0 || regno == CR_IIB1))
8669	    {
8670	      specs[count] = tmpl;
8671	      specs[count++].index = regno;
8672	    }
8673	}
8674      break;
8675
8676    case IA64_RS_CR_LRR:
8677      if (note != 1)
8678	{
8679	  UNHANDLED;
8680	}
8681      else
8682	{
8683	  int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_CR;
8684	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CR3
8685	      && (regno == CR_LRR0 || regno == CR_LRR1))
8686	    {
8687	      specs[count] = tmpl;
8688	      specs[count++].index = regno;
8689	    }
8690	}
8691      break;
8692
8693    case IA64_RS_CR:
8694      if (note == 1)
8695	{
8696	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CR3)
8697	    {
8698	      specs[count] = tmpl;
8699	      specs[count++].index =
8700		CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_CR;
8701	    }
8702	}
8703      else
8704	{
8705	  UNHANDLED;
8706	}
8707      break;
8708
8709    case IA64_RS_DAHR:
8710      if (note == 0)
8711	{
8712	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_DAHR3)
8713	    {
8714	      specs[count] = tmpl;
8715	      specs[count++].index =
8716		CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_DAHR;
8717	    }
8718	}
8719      else
8720	{
8721	  UNHANDLED;
8722	}
8723      break;
8724
8725    case IA64_RS_FR:
8726    case IA64_RS_FRb:
8727      if (note != 1)
8728	{
8729	  UNHANDLED;
8730	}
8731      else if (rsrc_write)
8732	{
8733	  if (dep->specifier == IA64_RS_FRb
8734	      && idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_F1)
8735	    {
8736	      specs[count] = tmpl;
8737	      specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_FR;
8738	    }
8739	}
8740      else
8741	{
8742	  for (i = idesc->num_outputs; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
8743	    {
8744	      if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F2
8745		  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F3
8746		  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F4)
8747		{
8748		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8749		  specs[count++].index =
8750		    CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_FR;
8751		}
8752	    }
8753	}
8754      break;
8755
8756    case IA64_RS_GR:
8757      if (note == 13)
8758	{
8759	  /* This reference applies only to the GR whose value is loaded with
8760	     data returned from memory.  */
8761	  specs[count] = tmpl;
8762	  specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8763	}
8764      else if (note == 1)
8765	{
8766	  if (rsrc_write)
8767	    {
8768	      for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
8769		if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R1
8770		    || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R2
8771		    || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3)
8772		  {
8773		    specs[count] = tmpl;
8774		    specs[count++].index =
8775		      CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8776		  }
8777	      if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_POSTINC)
8778		for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
8779		  if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_MR3)
8780		    {
8781		      specs[count] = tmpl;
8782		      specs[count++].index =
8783			CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8784		    }
8785	    }
8786	  else
8787	    {
8788	      /* Look for anything that reads a GR.  */
8789	      for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
8790		{
8791		  if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_MR3
8792		      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_CPUID_R3
8793		      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_DBR_R3
8794		      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_IBR_R3
8795		      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_MSR_R3
8796		      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_PKR_R3
8797		      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_PMC_R3
8798		      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_PMD_R3
8799		      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_DAHR_R3
8800		      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_RR_R3
8801		      || ((i >= idesc->num_outputs)
8802			  && (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R1
8803			      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R2
8804			      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3
8805			      /* addl source register.  */
8806			      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3_2)))
8807		    {
8808		      specs[count] = tmpl;
8809		      specs[count++].index =
8810			CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8811		    }
8812		}
8813	    }
8814	}
8815      else
8816	{
8817	  UNHANDLED;
8818	}
8819      break;
8820
8821      /* This is the same as IA64_RS_PRr, except that the register range is
8822	 from 1 - 15, and there are no rotating register reads/writes here.  */
8823    case IA64_RS_PR:
8824      if (note == 0)
8825	{
8826	  for (i = 1; i < 16; i++)
8827	    {
8828	      specs[count] = tmpl;
8829	      specs[count++].index = i;
8830	    }
8831	}
8832      else if (note == 7)
8833	{
8834	  valueT mask = 0;
8835	  /* Mark only those registers indicated by the mask.  */
8836	  if (rsrc_write)
8837	    {
8838	      mask = CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_add_number;
8839	      for (i = 1; i < 16; i++)
8840		if (mask & ((valueT) 1 << i))
8841		  {
8842		    specs[count] = tmpl;
8843		    specs[count++].index = i;
8844		  }
8845	    }
8846	  else
8847	    {
8848	      UNHANDLED;
8849	    }
8850	}
8851      else if (note == 11) /* note 11 implies note 1 as well */
8852	{
8853	  if (rsrc_write)
8854	    {
8855	      for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
8856		{
8857		  if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P1
8858		      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P2)
8859		    {
8860		      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_P;
8861		      if (regno >= 1 && regno < 16)
8862			{
8863			  specs[count] = tmpl;
8864			  specs[count++].index = regno;
8865			}
8866		    }
8867		}
8868	    }
8869	  else
8870	    {
8871	      UNHANDLED;
8872	    }
8873	}
8874      else if (note == 12)
8875	{
8876	  if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno >= 1 && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno < 16)
8877	    {
8878	      specs[count] = tmpl;
8879	      specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.qp_regno;
8880	    }
8881	}
8882      else if (note == 1)
8883	{
8884	  if (rsrc_write)
8885	    {
8886	      int p1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_P;
8887	      int p2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_P;
8888	      int or_andcm = strstr (idesc->name, "or.andcm") != NULL;
8889	      int and_orcm = strstr (idesc->name, "and.orcm") != NULL;
8890
8891	      if ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P1
8892		   || idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P2)
8893		  && p1 >= 1 && p1 < 16)
8894		{
8895		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8896		  specs[count].cmp_type =
8897		    (or_andcm ? CMP_OR : (and_orcm ? CMP_AND : CMP_NONE));
8898		  specs[count++].index = p1;
8899		}
8900	      if ((idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P1
8901		   || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P2)
8902		  && p2 >= 1 && p2 < 16)
8903		{
8904		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8905		  specs[count].cmp_type =
8906		    (or_andcm ? CMP_AND : (and_orcm ? CMP_OR : CMP_NONE));
8907		  specs[count++].index = p2;
8908		}
8909	    }
8910	  else
8911	    {
8912	      if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno >= 1 && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno < 16)
8913		{
8914		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8915		  specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.qp_regno;
8916		}
8917	      if (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_PR)
8918		{
8919		  for (i = 1; i < 16; i++)
8920		    {
8921		      specs[count] = tmpl;
8922		      specs[count++].index = i;
8923		    }
8924		}
8925	    }
8926	}
8927      else
8928	{
8929	  UNHANDLED;
8930	}
8931      break;
8932
8933      /* This is the general case for PRs.  IA64_RS_PR and IA64_RS_PR63 are
8934	 simplified cases of this.  */
8935    case IA64_RS_PRr:
8936      if (note == 0)
8937	{
8938	  for (i = 16; i < 63; i++)
8939	    {
8940	      specs[count] = tmpl;
8941	      specs[count++].index = i;
8942	    }
8943	}
8944      else if (note == 7)
8945	{
8946	  valueT mask = 0;
8947	  /* Mark only those registers indicated by the mask.  */
8948	  if (rsrc_write
8949	      && idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_PR)
8950	    {
8951	      mask = CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_add_number;
8952	      if (mask & ((valueT) 1 << 16))
8953		for (i = 16; i < 63; i++)
8954		  {
8955		    specs[count] = tmpl;
8956		    specs[count++].index = i;
8957		  }
8958	    }
8959	  else if (rsrc_write
8960		   && idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_PR_ROT)
8961	    {
8962	      for (i = 16; i < 63; i++)
8963		{
8964		  specs[count] = tmpl;
8965		  specs[count++].index = i;
8966		}
8967	    }
8968	  else
8969	    {
8970	      UNHANDLED;
8971	    }
8972	}
8973      else if (note == 11) /* note 11 implies note 1 as well */
8974	{
8975	  if (rsrc_write)
8976	    {
8977	      for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
8978		{
8979		  if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P1
8980		      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P2)
8981		    {
8982		      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_P;
8983		      if (regno >= 16 && regno < 63)
8984			{
8985			  specs[count] = tmpl;
8986			  specs[count++].index = regno;
8987			}
8988		    }
8989		}
8990	    }
8991	  else
8992	    {
8993	      UNHANDLED;
8994	    }
8995	}
8996      else if (note == 12)
8997	{
8998	  if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno >= 16 && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno < 63)
8999	    {
9000	      specs[count] = tmpl;
9001	      specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.qp_regno;
9002	    }
9003	}
9004      else if (note == 1)
9005	{
9006	  if (rsrc_write)
9007	    {
9008	      int p1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_P;
9009	      int p2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_P;
9010	      int or_andcm = strstr (idesc->name, "or.andcm") != NULL;
9011	      int and_orcm = strstr (idesc->name, "and.orcm") != NULL;
9012
9013	      if ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P1
9014		   || idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P2)
9015		  && p1 >= 16 && p1 < 63)
9016		{
9017		  specs[count] = tmpl;
9018		  specs[count].cmp_type =
9019		    (or_andcm ? CMP_OR : (and_orcm ? CMP_AND : CMP_NONE));
9020		  specs[count++].index = p1;
9021		}
9022	      if ((idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P1
9023		   || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P2)
9024		  && p2 >= 16 && p2 < 63)
9025		{
9026		  specs[count] = tmpl;
9027		  specs[count].cmp_type =
9028		    (or_andcm ? CMP_AND : (and_orcm ? CMP_OR : CMP_NONE));
9029		  specs[count++].index = p2;
9030		}
9031	    }
9032	  else
9033	    {
9034	      if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno >= 16 && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno < 63)
9035		{
9036		  specs[count] = tmpl;
9037		  specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.qp_regno;
9038		}
9039	      if (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_PR)
9040		{
9041		  for (i = 16; i < 63; i++)
9042		    {
9043		      specs[count] = tmpl;
9044		      specs[count++].index = i;
9045		    }
9046		}
9047	    }
9048	}
9049      else
9050	{
9051	  UNHANDLED;
9052	}
9053      break;
9054
9055    case IA64_RS_PSR:
9056      /* Verify that the instruction is using the PSR bit indicated in
9057	 dep->regindex.  */
9058      if (note == 0)
9059	{
9060	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PSR_UM)
9061	    {
9062	      if (dep->regindex < 6)
9063		{
9064		  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9065		}
9066	    }
9067	  else if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PSR)
9068	    {
9069	      if (dep->regindex < 32
9070		  || dep->regindex == 35
9071		  || dep->regindex == 36
9072		  || (!rsrc_write && dep->regindex == PSR_CPL))
9073		{
9074		  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9075		}
9076	    }
9077	  else if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PSR_L)
9078	    {
9079	      if (dep->regindex < 32
9080		  || dep->regindex == 35
9081		  || dep->regindex == 36
9082		  || (rsrc_write && dep->regindex == PSR_CPL))
9083		{
9084		  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9085		}
9086	    }
9087	  else
9088	    {
9089	      /* Several PSR bits have very specific dependencies.  */
9090	      switch (dep->regindex)
9091		{
9092		default:
9093		  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9094		  break;
9095		case PSR_IC:
9096		  if (rsrc_write)
9097		    {
9098		      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9099		    }
9100		  else
9101		    {
9102		      /* Only certain CR accesses use PSR.ic */
9103		      if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_CR3
9104			  || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_CR3)
9105			{
9106			  int reg_index =
9107			    ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_CR3)
9108			     ? 0 : 1);
9109			  int regno =
9110			    CURR_SLOT.opnd[reg_index].X_add_number - REG_CR;
9111
9112			  switch (regno)
9113			    {
9114			    default:
9115			      break;
9116			    case CR_ITIR:
9117			    case CR_IFS:
9118			    case CR_IIM:
9119			    case CR_IIP:
9120			    case CR_IPSR:
9121			    case CR_ISR:
9122			    case CR_IFA:
9123			    case CR_IHA:
9124			    case CR_IIB0:
9125			    case CR_IIB1:
9126			    case CR_IIPA:
9127			      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9128			      break;
9129			    }
9130			}
9131		    }
9132		  break;
9133		case PSR_CPL:
9134		  if (rsrc_write)
9135		    {
9136		      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9137		    }
9138		  else
9139		    {
9140		      /* Only some AR accesses use cpl */
9141		      if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_AR3
9142			  || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9143			{
9144			  int reg_index =
9145			    ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9146			     ? 0 : 1);
9147			  int regno =
9148			    CURR_SLOT.opnd[reg_index].X_add_number - REG_AR;
9149
9150			  if (regno == AR_ITC
9151			      || regno == AR_RUC
9152			      || (reg_index == 0
9153				  && (regno == AR_RSC
9154				      || (regno >= AR_K0
9155					  && regno <= AR_K7))))
9156			    {
9157			      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9158			    }
9159			}
9160		      else
9161			{
9162			  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9163			}
9164		      break;
9165		    }
9166		}
9167	    }
9168	}
9169      else if (note == 7)
9170	{
9171	  valueT mask = 0;
9172	  if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_IMMU24)
9173	    {
9174	      mask = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number;
9175	    }
9176	  else
9177	    {
9178	      UNHANDLED;
9179	    }
9180	  if (mask & ((valueT) 1 << dep->regindex))
9181	    {
9182	      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9183	    }
9184	}
9185      else if (note == 8)
9186	{
9187	  int min = dep->regindex == PSR_DFL ? 2 : 32;
9188	  int max = dep->regindex == PSR_DFL ? 31 : 127;
9189	  /* dfh is read on FR32-127; dfl is read on FR2-31 */
9190	  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
9191	    {
9192	      if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F1
9193		  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F2
9194		  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F3
9195		  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F4)
9196		{
9197		  int reg = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_FR;
9198		  if (reg >= min && reg <= max)
9199		    {
9200		      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9201		    }
9202		}
9203	    }
9204	}
9205      else if (note == 9)
9206	{
9207	  int min = dep->regindex == PSR_MFL ? 2 : 32;
9208	  int max = dep->regindex == PSR_MFL ? 31 : 127;
9209	  /* mfh is read on writes to FR32-127; mfl is read on writes to
9210	     FR2-31 */
9211	  for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
9212	    {
9213	      if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F1)
9214		{
9215		  int reg = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_FR;
9216		  if (reg >= min && reg <= max)
9217		    {
9218		      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9219		    }
9220		}
9221	    }
9222	}
9223      else if (note == 10)
9224	{
9225	  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
9226	    {
9227	      if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R1
9228		  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R2
9229		  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3)
9230		{
9231		  int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
9232		  if (regno >= 16 && regno <= 31)
9233		    {
9234		      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9235		    }
9236		}
9237	    }
9238	}
9239      else
9240	{
9241	  UNHANDLED;
9242	}
9243      break;
9244
9245    case IA64_RS_AR_FPSR:
9246      if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9247	{
9248	  int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
9249	  if (regno == AR_FPSR)
9250	    {
9251	      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9252	    }
9253	}
9254      else
9255	{
9256	  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9257	}
9258      break;
9259
9260    case IA64_RS_ARX:
9261      /* Handle all AR[REG] resources */
9262      if (note == 0 || note == 1)
9263	{
9264	  int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
9265	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3
9266	      && regno == dep->regindex)
9267	    {
9268	      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9269	    }
9270	  /* other AR[REG] resources may be affected by AR accesses */
9271	  else if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9272	    {
9273	      /* AR[] writes */
9274	      regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_AR;
9275	      switch (dep->regindex)
9276		{
9277		default:
9278		  break;
9279		case AR_BSP:
9280		case AR_RNAT:
9281		  if (regno == AR_BSPSTORE)
9282		    {
9283		      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9284		    }
9285		  /* Fall through.  */
9286		case AR_RSC:
9287		  if (!rsrc_write &&
9288		      (regno == AR_BSPSTORE
9289		       || regno == AR_RNAT))
9290		    {
9291		      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9292		    }
9293		  break;
9294		}
9295	    }
9296	  else if (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9297	    {
9298	      /* AR[] reads */
9299	      regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_AR;
9300	      switch (dep->regindex)
9301		{
9302		default:
9303		  break;
9304		case AR_RSC:
9305		  if (regno == AR_BSPSTORE || regno == AR_RNAT)
9306		    {
9307		      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9308		    }
9309		  break;
9310		}
9311	    }
9312	  else
9313	    {
9314	      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9315	    }
9316	}
9317      else
9318	{
9319	  UNHANDLED;
9320	}
9321      break;
9322
9323    case IA64_RS_CRX:
9324      /* Handle all CR[REG] resources.
9325	 ??? FIXME: The rule 17 isn't really handled correctly.   */
9326      if (note == 0 || note == 1 || note == 17)
9327	{
9328	  if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CR3)
9329	    {
9330	      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_CR;
9331	      if (regno == dep->regindex)
9332		{
9333		  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9334		}
9335	      else if (!rsrc_write)
9336		{
9337		  /* Reads from CR[IVR] affect other resources.  */
9338		  if (regno == CR_IVR)
9339		    {
9340		      if ((dep->regindex >= CR_IRR0
9341			   && dep->regindex <= CR_IRR3)
9342			  || dep->regindex == CR_TPR)
9343			{
9344			  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9345			}
9346		    }
9347		}
9348	    }
9349	  else
9350	    {
9351	      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9352	    }
9353	}
9354      else
9355	{
9356	  UNHANDLED;
9357	}
9358      break;
9359
9360    case IA64_RS_INSERVICE:
9361      /* look for write of EOI (67) or read of IVR (65) */
9362      if ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_CR3
9363	   && CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_CR == CR_EOI)
9364	  || (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_CR3
9365	      && CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_CR == CR_IVR))
9366	{
9367	  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9368	}
9369      break;
9370
9371    case IA64_RS_GR0:
9372      if (note == 1)
9373	{
9374	  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9375	}
9376      else
9377	{
9378	  UNHANDLED;
9379	}
9380      break;
9381
9382    case IA64_RS_CFM:
9383      if (note != 2)
9384	{
9385	  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9386	}
9387      else
9388	{
9389	  /* Check if any of the registers accessed are in the rotating region.
9390	     mov to/from pr accesses CFM only when qp_regno is in the rotating
9391	     region */
9392	  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
9393	    {
9394	      if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R1
9395		  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R2
9396		  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3)
9397		{
9398		  int num = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
9399		  /* Assumes that md.rot.num_regs is always valid */
9400		  if (md.rot.num_regs > 0
9401		      && num > 31
9402		      && num < 31 + md.rot.num_regs)
9403		    {
9404		      specs[count] = tmpl;
9405		      specs[count++].specific = 0;
9406		    }
9407		}
9408	      else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F1
9409		       || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F2
9410		       || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F3
9411		       || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F4)
9412		{
9413		  int num = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_FR;
9414		  if (num > 31)
9415		    {
9416		      specs[count] = tmpl;
9417		      specs[count++].specific = 0;
9418		    }
9419		}
9420	      else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P1
9421		       || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P2)
9422		{
9423		  int num = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_P;
9424		  if (num > 15)
9425		    {
9426		      specs[count] = tmpl;
9427		      specs[count++].specific = 0;
9428		    }
9429		}
9430	    }
9431	  if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno > 15)
9432	    {
9433	      specs[count] = tmpl;
9434	      specs[count++].specific = 0;
9435	    }
9436	}
9437      break;
9438
9439      /* This is the same as IA64_RS_PRr, except simplified to account for
9440	 the fact that there is only one register.  */
9441    case IA64_RS_PR63:
9442      if (note == 0)
9443	{
9444	  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9445	}
9446      else if (note == 7)
9447	{
9448	  valueT mask = 0;
9449	  if (idesc->operands[2] == IA64_OPND_IMM17)
9450	    mask = CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_add_number;
9451	  if (mask & ((valueT) 1 << 63))
9452	    specs[count++] = tmpl;
9453	}
9454      else if (note == 11)
9455	{
9456	  if ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P1
9457	       && CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_P == 63)
9458	      || (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P2
9459		  && CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_P == 63))
9460	    {
9461	      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9462	    }
9463	}
9464      else if (note == 12)
9465	{
9466	  if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno == 63)
9467	    {
9468	      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9469	    }
9470	}
9471      else if (note == 1)
9472	{
9473	  if (rsrc_write)
9474	    {
9475	      int p1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_P;
9476	      int p2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_P;
9477	      int or_andcm = strstr (idesc->name, "or.andcm") != NULL;
9478	      int and_orcm = strstr (idesc->name, "and.orcm") != NULL;
9479
9480	      if (p1 == 63
9481		  && (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P1
9482		      || idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P2))
9483		{
9484		  specs[count] = tmpl;
9485		  specs[count++].cmp_type =
9486		    (or_andcm ? CMP_OR : (and_orcm ? CMP_AND : CMP_NONE));
9487		}
9488	      if (p2 == 63
9489		  && (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P1
9490		      || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P2))
9491		{
9492		  specs[count] = tmpl;
9493		  specs[count++].cmp_type =
9494		    (or_andcm ? CMP_AND : (and_orcm ? CMP_OR : CMP_NONE));
9495		}
9496	    }
9497	  else
9498	    {
9499	      if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno == 63)
9500		{
9501		  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9502		}
9503	    }
9504	}
9505      else
9506	{
9507	  UNHANDLED;
9508	}
9509      break;
9510
9511    case IA64_RS_RSE:
9512      /* FIXME we can identify some individual RSE written resources, but RSE
9513	 read resources have not yet been completely identified, so for now
9514	 treat RSE as a single resource */
9515      if (strncmp (idesc->name, "mov", 3) == 0)
9516	{
9517	  if (rsrc_write)
9518	    {
9519	      if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_AR3
9520		  && CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_BSPSTORE)
9521		{
9522		  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9523		}
9524	    }
9525	  else
9526	    {
9527	      if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9528		{
9529		  if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_BSPSTORE
9530		      || CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_RNAT)
9531		    {
9532		      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9533		    }
9534		}
9535	      else if (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9536		{
9537		  if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_BSP
9538		      || CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_BSPSTORE
9539		      || CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_RNAT)
9540		    {
9541		      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9542		    }
9543		}
9544	    }
9545	}
9546      else
9547	{
9548	  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9549	}
9550      break;
9551
9552    case IA64_RS_ANY:
9553      /* FIXME -- do any of these need to be non-specific? */
9554      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9555      break;
9556
9557    default:
9558      as_bad (_("Unrecognized dependency specifier %d\n"), dep->specifier);
9559      break;
9560    }
9561
9562  return count;
9563}
9564
9565/* Clear branch flags on marked resources.  This breaks the link between the
9566   QP of the marking instruction and a subsequent branch on the same QP.  */
9567
9568static void
9569clear_qp_branch_flag (valueT mask)
9570{
9571  int i;
9572  for (i = 0; i < regdepslen; i++)
9573    {
9574      valueT bit = ((valueT) 1 << regdeps[i].qp_regno);
9575      if ((bit & mask) != 0)
9576	{
9577	  regdeps[i].link_to_qp_branch = 0;
9578	}
9579    }
9580}
9581
9582/* MASK contains 2 and only 2 PRs which are mutually exclusive.  Remove
9583   any mutexes which contain one of the PRs and create new ones when
9584   needed.  */
9585
9586static int
9587update_qp_mutex (valueT mask)
9588{
9589  int i;
9590  int add = 0;
9591
9592  i = 0;
9593  while (i < qp_mutexeslen)
9594    {
9595      if ((qp_mutexes[i].prmask & mask) != 0)
9596	{
9597	  /* If it destroys and creates the same mutex, do nothing.  */
9598	  if (qp_mutexes[i].prmask == mask
9599	      && qp_mutexes[i].path == md.path)
9600	    {
9601	      i++;
9602	      add = -1;
9603	    }
9604	  else
9605	    {
9606	      int keep = 0;
9607
9608	      if (md.debug_dv)
9609		{
9610		  fprintf (stderr, "  Clearing mutex relation");
9611		  print_prmask (qp_mutexes[i].prmask);
9612		  fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9613		}
9614
9615	      /* Deal with the old mutex with more than 3+ PRs only if
9616		 the new mutex on the same execution path with it.
9617
9618		 FIXME: The 3+ mutex support is incomplete.
9619		 dot_pred_rel () may be a better place to fix it.  */
9620	      if (qp_mutexes[i].path == md.path)
9621		{
9622		  /* If it is a proper subset of the mutex, create a
9623		     new mutex.  */
9624		  if (add == 0
9625		      && (qp_mutexes[i].prmask & mask) == mask)
9626		    add = 1;
9627
9628		  qp_mutexes[i].prmask &= ~mask;
9629		  if (qp_mutexes[i].prmask & (qp_mutexes[i].prmask - 1))
9630		    {
9631		      /* Modify the mutex if there are more than one
9632			 PR left.  */
9633		      keep = 1;
9634		      i++;
9635		    }
9636		}
9637
9638	      if (keep == 0)
9639		/* Remove the mutex.  */
9640		qp_mutexes[i] = qp_mutexes[--qp_mutexeslen];
9641	    }
9642	}
9643      else
9644	++i;
9645    }
9646
9647  if (add == 1)
9648    add_qp_mutex (mask);
9649
9650  return add;
9651}
9652
9653/* Remove any mutexes which contain any of the PRs indicated in the mask.
9654
9655   Any changes to a PR clears the mutex relations which include that PR.  */
9656
9657static void
9658clear_qp_mutex (valueT mask)
9659{
9660  int i;
9661
9662  i = 0;
9663  while (i < qp_mutexeslen)
9664    {
9665      if ((qp_mutexes[i].prmask & mask) != 0)
9666	{
9667	  if (md.debug_dv)
9668	    {
9669	      fprintf (stderr, "  Clearing mutex relation");
9670	      print_prmask (qp_mutexes[i].prmask);
9671	      fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9672	    }
9673	  qp_mutexes[i] = qp_mutexes[--qp_mutexeslen];
9674	}
9675      else
9676	++i;
9677    }
9678}
9679
9680/* Clear implies relations which contain PRs in the given masks.
9681   P1_MASK indicates the source of the implies relation, while P2_MASK
9682   indicates the implied PR.  */
9683
9684static void
9685clear_qp_implies (valueT p1_mask, valueT p2_mask)
9686{
9687  int i;
9688
9689  i = 0;
9690  while (i < qp_implieslen)
9691    {
9692      if ((((valueT) 1 << qp_implies[i].p1) & p1_mask) != 0
9693	  || (((valueT) 1 << qp_implies[i].p2) & p2_mask) != 0)
9694	{
9695	  if (md.debug_dv)
9696	    fprintf (stderr, "Clearing implied relation PR%d->PR%d\n",
9697		     qp_implies[i].p1, qp_implies[i].p2);
9698	  qp_implies[i] = qp_implies[--qp_implieslen];
9699	}
9700      else
9701	++i;
9702    }
9703}
9704
9705/* Add the PRs specified to the list of implied relations.  */
9706
9707static void
9708add_qp_imply (int p1, int p2)
9709{
9710  valueT mask;
9711  valueT bit;
9712  int i;
9713
9714  /* p0 is not meaningful here.  */
9715  if (p1 == 0 || p2 == 0)
9716    abort ();
9717
9718  if (p1 == p2)
9719    return;
9720
9721  /* If it exists already, ignore it.  */
9722  for (i = 0; i < qp_implieslen; i++)
9723    {
9724      if (qp_implies[i].p1 == p1
9725	  && qp_implies[i].p2 == p2
9726	  && qp_implies[i].path == md.path
9727	  && !qp_implies[i].p2_branched)
9728	return;
9729    }
9730
9731  if (qp_implieslen == qp_impliestotlen)
9732    {
9733      qp_impliestotlen += 20;
9734      qp_implies = XRESIZEVEC (struct qp_imply, qp_implies, qp_impliestotlen);
9735    }
9736  if (md.debug_dv)
9737    fprintf (stderr, "  Registering PR%d implies PR%d\n", p1, p2);
9738  qp_implies[qp_implieslen].p1 = p1;
9739  qp_implies[qp_implieslen].p2 = p2;
9740  qp_implies[qp_implieslen].path = md.path;
9741  qp_implies[qp_implieslen++].p2_branched = 0;
9742
9743  /* Add in the implied transitive relations; for everything that p2 implies,
9744     make p1 imply that, too; for everything that implies p1, make it imply p2
9745     as well.  */
9746  for (i = 0; i < qp_implieslen; i++)
9747    {
9748      if (qp_implies[i].p1 == p2)
9749	add_qp_imply (p1, qp_implies[i].p2);
9750      if (qp_implies[i].p2 == p1)
9751	add_qp_imply (qp_implies[i].p1, p2);
9752    }
9753  /* Add in mutex relations implied by this implies relation; for each mutex
9754     relation containing p2, duplicate it and replace p2 with p1.  */
9755  bit = (valueT) 1 << p1;
9756  mask = (valueT) 1 << p2;
9757  for (i = 0; i < qp_mutexeslen; i++)
9758    {
9759      if (qp_mutexes[i].prmask & mask)
9760	add_qp_mutex ((qp_mutexes[i].prmask & ~mask) | bit);
9761    }
9762}
9763
9764/* Add the PRs specified in the mask to the mutex list; this means that only
9765   one of the PRs can be true at any time.  PR0 should never be included in
9766   the mask.  */
9767
9768static void
9769add_qp_mutex (valueT mask)
9770{
9771  if (mask & 0x1)
9772    abort ();
9773
9774  if (qp_mutexeslen == qp_mutexestotlen)
9775    {
9776      qp_mutexestotlen += 20;
9777      qp_mutexes = XRESIZEVEC (struct qpmutex, qp_mutexes, qp_mutexestotlen);
9778    }
9779  if (md.debug_dv)
9780    {
9781      fprintf (stderr, "  Registering mutex on");
9782      print_prmask (mask);
9783      fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9784    }
9785  qp_mutexes[qp_mutexeslen].path = md.path;
9786  qp_mutexes[qp_mutexeslen++].prmask = mask;
9787}
9788
9789static int
9790has_suffix_p (const char *name, const char *suffix)
9791{
9792  size_t namelen = strlen (name);
9793  size_t sufflen = strlen (suffix);
9794
9795  if (namelen <= sufflen)
9796    return 0;
9797  return strcmp (name + namelen - sufflen, suffix) == 0;
9798}
9799
9800static void
9801clear_register_values (void)
9802{
9803  int i;
9804  if (md.debug_dv)
9805    fprintf (stderr, "  Clearing register values\n");
9806  for (i = 1; i < NELEMS (gr_values); i++)
9807    gr_values[i].known = 0;
9808}
9809
9810/* Keep track of register values/changes which affect DV tracking.
9811
9812   optimization note: should add a flag to classes of insns where otherwise we
9813   have to examine a group of strings to identify them.  */
9814
9815static void
9816note_register_values (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
9817{
9818  valueT qp_changemask = 0;
9819  int i;
9820
9821  /* Invalidate values for registers being written to.  */
9822  for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
9823    {
9824      if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R1
9825	  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R2
9826	  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3)
9827	{
9828	  int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
9829	  if (regno > 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values))
9830	    gr_values[regno].known = 0;
9831	}
9832      else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3_2)
9833	{
9834	  int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
9835	  if (regno > 0 && regno < 4)
9836	    gr_values[regno].known = 0;
9837	}
9838      else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P1
9839	       || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P2)
9840	{
9841	  int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_P;
9842	  qp_changemask |= (valueT) 1 << regno;
9843	}
9844      else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_PR)
9845	{
9846	  if (idesc->operands[2] & (valueT) 0x10000)
9847	    qp_changemask = ~(valueT) 0x1FFFF | idesc->operands[2];
9848	  else
9849	    qp_changemask = idesc->operands[2];
9850	  break;
9851	}
9852      else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_PR_ROT)
9853	{
9854	  if (idesc->operands[1] & ((valueT) 1 << 43))
9855	    qp_changemask = -((valueT) 1 << 44) | idesc->operands[1];
9856	  else
9857	    qp_changemask = idesc->operands[1];
9858	  qp_changemask &= ~(valueT) 0xFFFF;
9859	  break;
9860	}
9861    }
9862
9863  /* Always clear qp branch flags on any PR change.  */
9864  /* FIXME there may be exceptions for certain compares.  */
9865  clear_qp_branch_flag (qp_changemask);
9866
9867  /* Invalidate rotating registers on insns which affect RRBs in CFM.  */
9868  if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_MOD_RRBS)
9869    {
9870      qp_changemask |= ~(valueT) 0xFFFF;
9871      if (strcmp (idesc->name, "clrrrb.pr") != 0)
9872	{
9873	  for (i = 32; i < 32 + md.rot.num_regs; i++)
9874	    gr_values[i].known = 0;
9875	}
9876      clear_qp_mutex (qp_changemask);
9877      clear_qp_implies (qp_changemask, qp_changemask);
9878    }
9879  /* After a call, all register values are undefined, except those marked
9880     as "safe".  */
9881  else if (strncmp (idesc->name, "br.call", 6) == 0
9882	   || strncmp (idesc->name, "brl.call", 7) == 0)
9883    {
9884      /* FIXME keep GR values which are marked as "safe_across_calls"  */
9885      clear_register_values ();
9886      clear_qp_mutex (~qp_safe_across_calls);
9887      clear_qp_implies (~qp_safe_across_calls, ~qp_safe_across_calls);
9888      clear_qp_branch_flag (~qp_safe_across_calls);
9889    }
9890  else if (is_interruption_or_rfi (idesc)
9891	   || is_taken_branch (idesc))
9892    {
9893      clear_register_values ();
9894      clear_qp_mutex (~(valueT) 0);
9895      clear_qp_implies (~(valueT) 0, ~(valueT) 0);
9896    }
9897  /* Look for mutex and implies relations.  */
9898  else if ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P1
9899	    || idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P2)
9900	   && (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P1
9901	       || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P2))
9902    {
9903      int p1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_P;
9904      int p2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_P;
9905      valueT p1mask = (p1 != 0) ? (valueT) 1 << p1 : 0;
9906      valueT p2mask = (p2 != 0) ? (valueT) 1 << p2 : 0;
9907
9908      /* If both PRs are PR0, we can't really do anything.  */
9909      if (p1 == 0 && p2 == 0)
9910	{
9911	  if (md.debug_dv)
9912	    fprintf (stderr, "  Ignoring PRs due to inclusion of p0\n");
9913	}
9914      /* In general, clear mutexes and implies which include P1 or P2,
9915	 with the following exceptions.  */
9916      else if (has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".or.andcm")
9917	       || has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".and.orcm"))
9918	{
9919	  clear_qp_implies (p2mask, p1mask);
9920	}
9921      else if (has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".andcm")
9922	       || has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".and"))
9923	{
9924	  clear_qp_implies (0, p1mask | p2mask);
9925	}
9926      else if (has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".orcm")
9927	       || has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".or"))
9928	{
9929	  clear_qp_mutex (p1mask | p2mask);
9930	  clear_qp_implies (p1mask | p2mask, 0);
9931	}
9932      else
9933	{
9934	  int added = 0;
9935
9936	  clear_qp_implies (p1mask | p2mask, p1mask | p2mask);
9937
9938	  /* If one of the PRs is PR0, we call clear_qp_mutex.  */
9939	  if (p1 == 0 || p2 == 0)
9940	    clear_qp_mutex (p1mask | p2mask);
9941	  else
9942	    added = update_qp_mutex (p1mask | p2mask);
9943
9944	  if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno == 0
9945	      || has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".unc"))
9946	    {
9947	      if (added == 0 && p1 && p2)
9948		add_qp_mutex (p1mask | p2mask);
9949	      if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno != 0)
9950		{
9951		  if (p1)
9952		    add_qp_imply (p1, CURR_SLOT.qp_regno);
9953		  if (p2)
9954		    add_qp_imply (p2, CURR_SLOT.qp_regno);
9955		}
9956	    }
9957	}
9958    }
9959  /* Look for mov imm insns into GRs.  */
9960  else if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_R1
9961	   && (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_IMM22
9962	       || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_IMMU64)
9963	   && CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_op == O_constant
9964	   && (strcmp (idesc->name, "mov") == 0
9965	       || strcmp (idesc->name, "movl") == 0))
9966    {
9967      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_GR;
9968      if (regno > 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values))
9969	{
9970	  gr_values[regno].known = 1;
9971	  gr_values[regno].value = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number;
9972	  gr_values[regno].path = md.path;
9973	  if (md.debug_dv)
9974	    {
9975	      fprintf (stderr, "  Know gr%d = ", regno);
9976	      fprintf_vma (stderr, gr_values[regno].value);
9977	      fputs ("\n", stderr);
9978	    }
9979	}
9980    }
9981  /* Look for dep.z imm insns.  */
9982  else if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_R1
9983	   && idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_IMM8
9984	   && strcmp (idesc->name, "dep.z") == 0)
9985    {
9986      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_GR;
9987      if (regno > 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values))
9988	{
9989	  valueT value = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number;
9990
9991	  if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[3].X_add_number < 64)
9992	    value &= ((valueT)1 << CURR_SLOT.opnd[3].X_add_number) - 1;
9993	  value <<= CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_add_number;
9994	  gr_values[regno].known = 1;
9995	  gr_values[regno].value = value;
9996	  gr_values[regno].path = md.path;
9997	  if (md.debug_dv)
9998	    {
9999	      fprintf (stderr, "  Know gr%d = ", regno);
10000	      fprintf_vma (stderr, gr_values[regno].value);
10001	      fputs ("\n", stderr);
10002	    }
10003	}
10004    }
10005  else
10006    {
10007      clear_qp_mutex (qp_changemask);
10008      clear_qp_implies (qp_changemask, qp_changemask);
10009    }
10010}
10011
10012/* Return whether the given predicate registers are currently mutex.  */
10013
10014static int
10015qp_mutex (int p1, int p2, int path)
10016{
10017  int i;
10018  valueT mask;
10019
10020  if (p1 != p2)
10021    {
10022      mask = ((valueT) 1 << p1) | (valueT) 1 << p2;
10023      for (i = 0; i < qp_mutexeslen; i++)
10024	{
10025	  if (qp_mutexes[i].path >= path
10026	      && (qp_mutexes[i].prmask & mask) == mask)
10027	    return 1;
10028	}
10029    }
10030  return 0;
10031}
10032
10033/* Return whether the given resource is in the given insn's list of chks
10034   Return 1 if the conflict is absolutely determined, 2 if it's a potential
10035   conflict.  */
10036
10037static int
10038resources_match (struct rsrc *rs,
10039		 struct ia64_opcode *idesc,
10040		 int note,
10041		 int qp_regno,
10042		 int path)
10043{
10044  struct rsrc specs[MAX_SPECS];
10045  int count;
10046
10047  /* If the marked resource's qp_regno and the given qp_regno are mutex,
10048     we don't need to check.  One exception is note 11, which indicates that
10049     target predicates are written regardless of PR[qp].  */
10050  if (qp_mutex (rs->qp_regno, qp_regno, path)
10051      && note != 11)
10052    return 0;
10053
10054  count = specify_resource (rs->dependency, idesc, DV_CHK, specs, note, path);
10055  while (count-- > 0)
10056    {
10057      /* UNAT checking is a bit more specific than other resources */
10058      if (rs->dependency->specifier == IA64_RS_AR_UNAT
10059	  && specs[count].mem_offset.hint
10060	  && rs->mem_offset.hint)
10061	{
10062	  if (rs->mem_offset.base == specs[count].mem_offset.base)
10063	    {
10064	      if (((rs->mem_offset.offset >> 3) & 0x3F) ==
10065		  ((specs[count].mem_offset.offset >> 3) & 0x3F))
10066		return 1;
10067	      else
10068		continue;
10069	    }
10070	}
10071
10072      /* Skip apparent PR write conflicts where both writes are an AND or both
10073	 writes are an OR.  */
10074      if (rs->dependency->specifier == IA64_RS_PR
10075	  || rs->dependency->specifier == IA64_RS_PRr
10076	  || rs->dependency->specifier == IA64_RS_PR63)
10077	{
10078	  if (specs[count].cmp_type != CMP_NONE
10079	      && specs[count].cmp_type == rs->cmp_type)
10080	    {
10081	      if (md.debug_dv)
10082		fprintf (stderr, "  %s on parallel compare allowed (PR%d)\n",
10083			 dv_mode[rs->dependency->mode],
10084			 rs->dependency->specifier != IA64_RS_PR63 ?
10085			 specs[count].index : 63);
10086	      continue;
10087	    }
10088	  if (md.debug_dv)
10089	    fprintf (stderr,
10090		     "  %s on parallel compare conflict %s vs %s on PR%d\n",
10091		     dv_mode[rs->dependency->mode],
10092		     dv_cmp_type[rs->cmp_type],
10093		     dv_cmp_type[specs[count].cmp_type],
10094		     rs->dependency->specifier != IA64_RS_PR63 ?
10095		     specs[count].index : 63);
10096
10097	}
10098
10099      /* If either resource is not specific, conservatively assume a conflict
10100       */
10101      if (!specs[count].specific || !rs->specific)
10102	return 2;
10103      else if (specs[count].index == rs->index)
10104	return 1;
10105    }
10106
10107  return 0;
10108}
10109
10110/* Indicate an instruction group break; if INSERT_STOP is non-zero, then
10111   insert a stop to create the break.  Update all resource dependencies
10112   appropriately.  If QP_REGNO is non-zero, only apply the break to resources
10113   which use the same QP_REGNO and have the link_to_qp_branch flag set.
10114   If SAVE_CURRENT is non-zero, don't affect resources marked by the current
10115   instruction.  */
10116
10117static void
10118insn_group_break (int insert_stop, int qp_regno, int save_current)
10119{
10120  int i;
10121
10122  if (insert_stop && md.num_slots_in_use > 0)
10123    PREV_SLOT.end_of_insn_group = 1;
10124
10125  if (md.debug_dv)
10126    {
10127      fprintf (stderr, "  Insn group break%s",
10128	       (insert_stop ? " (w/stop)" : ""));
10129      if (qp_regno != 0)
10130	fprintf (stderr, " effective for QP=%d", qp_regno);
10131      fprintf (stderr, "\n");
10132    }
10133
10134  i = 0;
10135  while (i < regdepslen)
10136    {
10137      const struct ia64_dependency *dep = regdeps[i].dependency;
10138
10139      if (qp_regno != 0
10140	  && regdeps[i].qp_regno != qp_regno)
10141	{
10142	  ++i;
10143	  continue;
10144	}
10145
10146      if (save_current
10147	  && CURR_SLOT.src_file == regdeps[i].file
10148	  && CURR_SLOT.src_line == regdeps[i].line)
10149	{
10150	  ++i;
10151	  continue;
10152	}
10153
10154      /* clear dependencies which are automatically cleared by a stop, or
10155	 those that have reached the appropriate state of insn serialization */
10156      if (dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_IMPLIED
10157	  || dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_IMPLIEDF
10158	  || regdeps[i].insn_srlz == STATE_SRLZ)
10159	{
10160	  print_dependency ("Removing", i);
10161	  regdeps[i] = regdeps[--regdepslen];
10162	}
10163      else
10164	{
10165	  if (dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_DATA
10166	      || dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_INSTR
10167	      || dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_SPECIFIC)
10168	    {
10169	      if (regdeps[i].insn_srlz == STATE_NONE)
10170		regdeps[i].insn_srlz = STATE_STOP;
10171	      if (regdeps[i].data_srlz == STATE_NONE)
10172		regdeps[i].data_srlz = STATE_STOP;
10173	    }
10174	  ++i;
10175	}
10176    }
10177}
10178
10179/* Add the given resource usage spec to the list of active dependencies.  */
10180
10181static void
10182mark_resource (struct ia64_opcode *idesc ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10183	       const struct ia64_dependency *dep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10184	       struct rsrc *spec,
10185	       int depind,
10186	       int path)
10187{
10188  if (regdepslen == regdepstotlen)
10189    {
10190      regdepstotlen += 20;
10191      regdeps = XRESIZEVEC (struct rsrc, regdeps, regdepstotlen);
10192    }
10193
10194  regdeps[regdepslen] = *spec;
10195  regdeps[regdepslen].depind = depind;
10196  regdeps[regdepslen].path = path;
10197  regdeps[regdepslen].file = CURR_SLOT.src_file;
10198  regdeps[regdepslen].line = CURR_SLOT.src_line;
10199
10200  print_dependency ("Adding", regdepslen);
10201
10202  ++regdepslen;
10203}
10204
10205static void
10206print_dependency (const char *action, int depind)
10207{
10208  if (md.debug_dv)
10209    {
10210      fprintf (stderr, "  %s %s '%s'",
10211	       action, dv_mode[(regdeps[depind].dependency)->mode],
10212	       (regdeps[depind].dependency)->name);
10213      if (regdeps[depind].specific && regdeps[depind].index >= 0)
10214	fprintf (stderr, " (%d)", regdeps[depind].index);
10215      if (regdeps[depind].mem_offset.hint)
10216	{
10217	  fputs (" ", stderr);
10218	  fprintf_vma (stderr, regdeps[depind].mem_offset.base);
10219	  fputs ("+", stderr);
10220	  fprintf_vma (stderr, regdeps[depind].mem_offset.offset);
10221	}
10222      fprintf (stderr, "\n");
10223    }
10224}
10225
10226static void
10227instruction_serialization (void)
10228{
10229  int i;
10230  if (md.debug_dv)
10231    fprintf (stderr, "  Instruction serialization\n");
10232  for (i = 0; i < regdepslen; i++)
10233    if (regdeps[i].insn_srlz == STATE_STOP)
10234      regdeps[i].insn_srlz = STATE_SRLZ;
10235}
10236
10237static void
10238data_serialization (void)
10239{
10240  int i = 0;
10241  if (md.debug_dv)
10242    fprintf (stderr, "  Data serialization\n");
10243  while (i < regdepslen)
10244    {
10245      if (regdeps[i].data_srlz == STATE_STOP
10246	  /* Note: as of 991210, all "other" dependencies are cleared by a
10247	     data serialization.  This might change with new tables */
10248	  || (regdeps[i].dependency)->semantics == IA64_DVS_OTHER)
10249	{
10250	  print_dependency ("Removing", i);
10251	  regdeps[i] = regdeps[--regdepslen];
10252	}
10253      else
10254	++i;
10255    }
10256}
10257
10258/* Insert stops and serializations as needed to avoid DVs.  */
10259
10260static void
10261remove_marked_resource (struct rsrc *rs)
10262{
10263  switch (rs->dependency->semantics)
10264    {
10265    case IA64_DVS_SPECIFIC:
10266      if (md.debug_dv)
10267	fprintf (stderr, "Implementation-specific, assume worst case...\n");
10268      /* Fall through.  */
10269    case IA64_DVS_INSTR:
10270      if (md.debug_dv)
10271	fprintf (stderr, "Inserting instr serialization\n");
10272      if (rs->insn_srlz < STATE_STOP)
10273	insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10274      if (rs->insn_srlz < STATE_SRLZ)
10275	{
10276	  struct slot oldslot = CURR_SLOT;
10277	  /* Manually jam a srlz.i insn into the stream */
10278	  memset (&CURR_SLOT, 0, sizeof (CURR_SLOT));
10279	  CURR_SLOT.user_template = -1;
10280	  CURR_SLOT.idesc = ia64_find_opcode ("srlz.i");
10281	  instruction_serialization ();
10282	  md.curr_slot = (md.curr_slot + 1) % NUM_SLOTS;
10283	  if (++md.num_slots_in_use >= NUM_SLOTS)
10284	    emit_one_bundle ();
10285	  CURR_SLOT = oldslot;
10286	}
10287      insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10288      break;
10289    case IA64_DVS_OTHER: /* as of rev2 (991220) of the DV tables, all
10290			    "other" types of DV are eliminated
10291			    by a data serialization */
10292    case IA64_DVS_DATA:
10293      if (md.debug_dv)
10294	fprintf (stderr, "Inserting data serialization\n");
10295      if (rs->data_srlz < STATE_STOP)
10296	insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10297      {
10298	struct slot oldslot = CURR_SLOT;
10299	/* Manually jam a srlz.d insn into the stream */
10300	memset (&CURR_SLOT, 0, sizeof (CURR_SLOT));
10301	CURR_SLOT.user_template = -1;
10302	CURR_SLOT.idesc = ia64_find_opcode ("srlz.d");
10303	data_serialization ();
10304	md.curr_slot = (md.curr_slot + 1) % NUM_SLOTS;
10305	if (++md.num_slots_in_use >= NUM_SLOTS)
10306	  emit_one_bundle ();
10307	CURR_SLOT = oldslot;
10308      }
10309      break;
10310    case IA64_DVS_IMPLIED:
10311    case IA64_DVS_IMPLIEDF:
10312      if (md.debug_dv)
10313	fprintf (stderr, "Inserting stop\n");
10314      insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10315      break;
10316    default:
10317      break;
10318    }
10319}
10320
10321/* Check the resources used by the given opcode against the current dependency
10322   list.
10323
10324   The check is run once for each execution path encountered.  In this case,
10325   a unique execution path is the sequence of instructions following a code
10326   entry point, e.g. the following has three execution paths, one starting
10327   at L0, one at L1, and one at L2.
10328
10329   L0:     nop
10330   L1:     add
10331   L2:     add
10332   br.ret
10333*/
10334
10335static void
10336check_dependencies (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
10337{
10338  const struct ia64_opcode_dependency *opdeps = idesc->dependencies;
10339  int path;
10340  int i;
10341
10342  /* Note that the number of marked resources may change within the
10343     loop if in auto mode.  */
10344  i = 0;
10345  while (i < regdepslen)
10346    {
10347      struct rsrc *rs = &regdeps[i];
10348      const struct ia64_dependency *dep = rs->dependency;
10349      int chkind;
10350      int note;
10351      int start_over = 0;
10352
10353      if (dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_NONE
10354	  || (chkind = depends_on (rs->depind, idesc)) == -1)
10355	{
10356	  ++i;
10357	  continue;
10358	}
10359
10360      note = NOTE (opdeps->chks[chkind]);
10361
10362      /* Check this resource against each execution path seen thus far.  */
10363      for (path = 0; path <= md.path; path++)
10364	{
10365	  int matchtype;
10366
10367	  /* If the dependency wasn't on the path being checked, ignore it.  */
10368	  if (rs->path < path)
10369	    continue;
10370
10371	  /* If the QP for this insn implies a QP which has branched, don't
10372	     bother checking.  Ed. NOTE: I don't think this check is terribly
10373	     useful; what's the point of generating code which will only be
10374	     reached if its QP is zero?
10375	     This code was specifically inserted to handle the following code,
10376	     based on notes from Intel's DV checking code, where p1 implies p2.
10377
10378		  mov r4 = 2
10379	     (p2) br.cond L
10380	     (p1) mov r4 = 7
10381	  */
10382	  if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno != 0)
10383	    {
10384	      int skip = 0;
10385	      int implies;
10386	      for (implies = 0; implies < qp_implieslen; implies++)
10387		{
10388		  if (qp_implies[implies].path >= path
10389		      && qp_implies[implies].p1 == CURR_SLOT.qp_regno
10390		      && qp_implies[implies].p2_branched)
10391		    {
10392		      skip = 1;
10393		      break;
10394		    }
10395		}
10396	      if (skip)
10397		continue;
10398	    }
10399
10400	  if ((matchtype = resources_match (rs, idesc, note,
10401					    CURR_SLOT.qp_regno, path)) != 0)
10402	    {
10403	      char msg[1024];
10404	      char pathmsg[256] = "";
10405	      char indexmsg[256] = "";
10406	      int certain = (matchtype == 1 && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno == 0);
10407
10408	      if (path != 0)
10409		snprintf (pathmsg, sizeof (pathmsg),
10410			  " when entry is at label '%s'",
10411			 md.entry_labels[path - 1]);
10412	      if (matchtype == 1 && rs->index >= 0)
10413		snprintf (indexmsg, sizeof (indexmsg),
10414			  ", specific resource number is %d",
10415			 rs->index);
10416	      snprintf (msg, sizeof (msg),
10417			"Use of '%s' %s %s dependency '%s' (%s)%s%s",
10418		       idesc->name,
10419		       (certain ? "violates" : "may violate"),
10420		       dv_mode[dep->mode], dep->name,
10421		       dv_sem[dep->semantics],
10422		       pathmsg, indexmsg);
10423
10424	      if (md.explicit_mode)
10425		{
10426		  as_warn ("%s", msg);
10427		  if (path < md.path)
10428		    as_warn (_("Only the first path encountering the conflict is reported"));
10429		  as_warn_where (rs->file, rs->line,
10430				 _("This is the location of the conflicting usage"));
10431		  /* Don't bother checking other paths, to avoid duplicating
10432		     the same warning */
10433		  break;
10434		}
10435	      else
10436		{
10437		  if (md.debug_dv)
10438		    fprintf (stderr, "%s @ %s:%d\n", msg, rs->file, rs->line);
10439
10440		  remove_marked_resource (rs);
10441
10442		  /* since the set of dependencies has changed, start over */
10443		  /* FIXME -- since we're removing dvs as we go, we
10444		     probably don't really need to start over...  */
10445		  start_over = 1;
10446		  break;
10447		}
10448	    }
10449	}
10450      if (start_over)
10451	i = 0;
10452      else
10453	++i;
10454    }
10455}
10456
10457/* Register new dependencies based on the given opcode.  */
10458
10459static void
10460mark_resources (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
10461{
10462  int i;
10463  const struct ia64_opcode_dependency *opdeps = idesc->dependencies;
10464  int add_only_qp_reads = 0;
10465
10466  /* A conditional branch only uses its resources if it is taken; if it is
10467     taken, we stop following that path.  The other branch types effectively
10468     *always* write their resources.  If it's not taken, register only QP
10469     reads.  */
10470  if (is_conditional_branch (idesc) || is_interruption_or_rfi (idesc))
10471    {
10472      add_only_qp_reads = 1;
10473    }
10474
10475  if (md.debug_dv)
10476    fprintf (stderr, "Registering '%s' resource usage\n", idesc->name);
10477
10478  for (i = 0; i < opdeps->nregs; i++)
10479    {
10480      const struct ia64_dependency *dep;
10481      struct rsrc specs[MAX_SPECS];
10482      int note;
10483      int path;
10484      int count;
10485
10486      dep = ia64_find_dependency (opdeps->regs[i]);
10487      note = NOTE (opdeps->regs[i]);
10488
10489      if (add_only_qp_reads
10490	  && !(dep->mode == IA64_DV_WAR
10491	       && (dep->specifier == IA64_RS_PR
10492		   || dep->specifier == IA64_RS_PRr
10493		   || dep->specifier == IA64_RS_PR63)))
10494	continue;
10495
10496      count = specify_resource (dep, idesc, DV_REG, specs, note, md.path);
10497
10498      while (count-- > 0)
10499	{
10500	  mark_resource (idesc, dep, &specs[count],
10501			 DEP (opdeps->regs[i]), md.path);
10502	}
10503
10504      /* The execution path may affect register values, which may in turn
10505	 affect which indirect-access resources are accessed.  */
10506      switch (dep->specifier)
10507	{
10508	default:
10509	  break;
10510	case IA64_RS_CPUID:
10511	case IA64_RS_DBR:
10512	case IA64_RS_IBR:
10513	case IA64_RS_MSR:
10514	case IA64_RS_PKR:
10515	case IA64_RS_PMC:
10516	case IA64_RS_PMD:
10517	case IA64_RS_RR:
10518	  for (path = 0; path < md.path; path++)
10519	    {
10520	      count = specify_resource (dep, idesc, DV_REG, specs, note, path);
10521	      while (count-- > 0)
10522		mark_resource (idesc, dep, &specs[count],
10523			       DEP (opdeps->regs[i]), path);
10524	    }
10525	  break;
10526	}
10527    }
10528}
10529
10530/* Remove dependencies when they no longer apply.  */
10531
10532static void
10533update_dependencies (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
10534{
10535  int i;
10536
10537  if (strcmp (idesc->name, "srlz.i") == 0)
10538    {
10539      instruction_serialization ();
10540    }
10541  else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "srlz.d") == 0)
10542    {
10543      data_serialization ();
10544    }
10545  else if (is_interruption_or_rfi (idesc)
10546	   || is_taken_branch (idesc))
10547    {
10548      /* Although technically the taken branch doesn't clear dependencies
10549	 which require a srlz.[id], we don't follow the branch; the next
10550	 instruction is assumed to start with a clean slate.  */
10551      regdepslen = 0;
10552      md.path = 0;
10553    }
10554  else if (is_conditional_branch (idesc)
10555	   && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno != 0)
10556    {
10557      int is_call = strstr (idesc->name, ".call") != NULL;
10558
10559      for (i = 0; i < qp_implieslen; i++)
10560	{
10561	  /* If the conditional branch's predicate is implied by the predicate
10562	     in an existing dependency, remove that dependency.  */
10563	  if (qp_implies[i].p2 == CURR_SLOT.qp_regno)
10564	    {
10565	      int depind = 0;
10566	      /* Note that this implied predicate takes a branch so that if
10567		 a later insn generates a DV but its predicate implies this
10568		 one, we can avoid the false DV warning.  */
10569	      qp_implies[i].p2_branched = 1;
10570	      while (depind < regdepslen)
10571		{
10572		  if (regdeps[depind].qp_regno == qp_implies[i].p1)
10573		    {
10574		      print_dependency ("Removing", depind);
10575		      regdeps[depind] = regdeps[--regdepslen];
10576		    }
10577		  else
10578		    ++depind;
10579		}
10580	    }
10581	}
10582      /* Any marked resources which have this same predicate should be
10583	 cleared, provided that the QP hasn't been modified between the
10584	 marking instruction and the branch.  */
10585      if (is_call)
10586	{
10587	  insn_group_break (0, CURR_SLOT.qp_regno, 1);
10588	}
10589      else
10590	{
10591	  i = 0;
10592	  while (i < regdepslen)
10593	    {
10594	      if (regdeps[i].qp_regno == CURR_SLOT.qp_regno
10595		  && regdeps[i].link_to_qp_branch
10596		  && (regdeps[i].file != CURR_SLOT.src_file
10597		      || regdeps[i].line != CURR_SLOT.src_line))
10598		{
10599		  /* Treat like a taken branch */
10600		  print_dependency ("Removing", i);
10601		  regdeps[i] = regdeps[--regdepslen];
10602		}
10603	      else
10604		++i;
10605	    }
10606	}
10607    }
10608}
10609
10610/* Examine the current instruction for dependency violations.  */
10611
10612static int
10613check_dv (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
10614{
10615  if (md.debug_dv)
10616    {
10617      fprintf (stderr, "Checking %s for violations (line %d, %d/%d)\n",
10618	       idesc->name, CURR_SLOT.src_line,
10619	       idesc->dependencies->nchks,
10620	       idesc->dependencies->nregs);
10621    }
10622
10623  /* Look through the list of currently marked resources; if the current
10624     instruction has the dependency in its chks list which uses that resource,
10625     check against the specific resources used.  */
10626  check_dependencies (idesc);
10627
10628  /* Look up the instruction's regdeps (RAW writes, WAW writes, and WAR reads),
10629     then add them to the list of marked resources.  */
10630  mark_resources (idesc);
10631
10632  /* There are several types of dependency semantics, and each has its own
10633     requirements for being cleared
10634
10635     Instruction serialization (insns separated by interruption, rfi, or
10636     writer + srlz.i + reader, all in separate groups) clears DVS_INSTR.
10637
10638     Data serialization (instruction serialization, or writer + srlz.d +
10639     reader, where writer and srlz.d are in separate groups) clears
10640     DVS_DATA. (This also clears DVS_OTHER, but that is not guaranteed to
10641     always be the case).
10642
10643     Instruction group break (groups separated by stop, taken branch,
10644     interruption or rfi) clears DVS_IMPLIED and DVS_IMPLIEDF.
10645   */
10646  update_dependencies (idesc);
10647
10648  /* Sometimes, knowing a register value allows us to avoid giving a false DV
10649     warning.  Keep track of as many as possible that are useful.  */
10650  note_register_values (idesc);
10651
10652  /* We don't need or want this anymore.  */
10653  md.mem_offset.hint = 0;
10654
10655  return 0;
10656}
10657
10658/* Translate one line of assembly.  Pseudo ops and labels do not show
10659   here.  */
10660void
10661md_assemble (char *str)
10662{
10663  char *saved_input_line_pointer, *temp;
10664  const char *mnemonic;
10665  const struct pseudo_opcode *pdesc;
10666  struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
10667  unsigned char qp_regno;
10668  unsigned int flags;
10669  int ch;
10670
10671  saved_input_line_pointer = input_line_pointer;
10672  input_line_pointer = str;
10673
10674  /* extract the opcode (mnemonic):  */
10675
10676  ch = get_symbol_name (&temp);
10677  mnemonic = temp;
10678  pdesc = (struct pseudo_opcode *) hash_find (md.pseudo_hash, mnemonic);
10679  if (pdesc)
10680    {
10681      (void) restore_line_pointer (ch);
10682      (*pdesc->handler) (pdesc->arg);
10683      goto done;
10684    }
10685
10686  /* Find the instruction descriptor matching the arguments.  */
10687
10688  idesc = ia64_find_opcode (mnemonic);
10689  (void) restore_line_pointer (ch);
10690  if (!idesc)
10691    {
10692      as_bad (_("Unknown opcode `%s'"), mnemonic);
10693      goto done;
10694    }
10695
10696  idesc = parse_operands (idesc);
10697  if (!idesc)
10698    goto done;
10699
10700  /* Handle the dynamic ops we can handle now:  */
10701  if (idesc->type == IA64_TYPE_DYN)
10702    {
10703      if (strcmp (idesc->name, "add") == 0)
10704	{
10705	  if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_op == O_register
10706	      && CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_add_number < 4)
10707	    mnemonic = "addl";
10708	  else
10709	    mnemonic = "adds";
10710	  ia64_free_opcode (idesc);
10711	  idesc = ia64_find_opcode (mnemonic);
10712	}
10713      else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "mov") == 0)
10714	{
10715	  enum ia64_opnd opnd1, opnd2;
10716	  int rop;
10717
10718	  opnd1 = idesc->operands[0];
10719	  opnd2 = idesc->operands[1];
10720	  if (opnd1 == IA64_OPND_AR3)
10721	    rop = 0;
10722	  else if (opnd2 == IA64_OPND_AR3)
10723	    rop = 1;
10724	  else
10725	    abort ();
10726	  if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_op == O_register)
10727	    {
10728	      if (ar_is_only_in_integer_unit (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_add_number))
10729		mnemonic = "mov.i";
10730	      else if (ar_is_only_in_memory_unit (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_add_number))
10731		mnemonic = "mov.m";
10732	      else
10733		rop = -1;
10734	    }
10735	  else
10736	    abort ();
10737	  if (rop >= 0)
10738	    {
10739	      ia64_free_opcode (idesc);
10740	      idesc = ia64_find_opcode (mnemonic);
10741	      while (idesc != NULL
10742		     && (idesc->operands[0] != opnd1
10743			 || idesc->operands[1] != opnd2))
10744		idesc = get_next_opcode (idesc);
10745	    }
10746	}
10747    }
10748  else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "mov.i") == 0
10749	   || strcmp (idesc->name, "mov.m") == 0)
10750    {
10751      enum ia64_opnd opnd1, opnd2;
10752      int rop;
10753
10754      opnd1 = idesc->operands[0];
10755      opnd2 = idesc->operands[1];
10756      if (opnd1 == IA64_OPND_AR3)
10757	rop = 0;
10758      else if (opnd2 == IA64_OPND_AR3)
10759	rop = 1;
10760      else
10761	abort ();
10762      if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_op == O_register)
10763	{
10764	  char unit = 'a';
10765	  if (ar_is_only_in_integer_unit (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_add_number))
10766	    unit = 'i';
10767	  else if (ar_is_only_in_memory_unit (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_add_number))
10768	    unit = 'm';
10769	  if (unit != 'a' && unit != idesc->name [4])
10770	    as_bad (_("AR %d can only be accessed by %c-unit"),
10771		    (int) (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_add_number - REG_AR),
10772		    TOUPPER (unit));
10773	}
10774    }
10775  else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "hint.b") == 0)
10776    {
10777      switch (md.hint_b)
10778	{
10779	case hint_b_ok:
10780	  break;
10781	case hint_b_warning:
10782	  as_warn (_("hint.b may be treated as nop"));
10783	  break;
10784	case hint_b_error:
10785	  as_bad (_("hint.b shouldn't be used"));
10786	  break;
10787	}
10788    }
10789
10790  qp_regno = 0;
10791  if (md.qp.X_op == O_register)
10792    {
10793      qp_regno = md.qp.X_add_number - REG_P;
10794      md.qp.X_op = O_absent;
10795    }
10796
10797  flags = idesc->flags;
10798
10799  if ((flags & IA64_OPCODE_FIRST) != 0)
10800    {
10801      /* The alignment frag has to end with a stop bit only if the
10802	 next instruction after the alignment directive has to be
10803	 the first instruction in an instruction group.  */
10804      if (align_frag)
10805	{
10806	  while (align_frag->fr_type != rs_align_code)
10807	    {
10808	      align_frag = align_frag->fr_next;
10809	      if (!align_frag)
10810		break;
10811	    }
10812	  /* align_frag can be NULL if there are directives in
10813	     between.  */
10814	  if (align_frag && align_frag->fr_next == frag_now)
10815	    align_frag->tc_frag_data = 1;
10816	}
10817
10818      insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10819    }
10820  align_frag = NULL;
10821
10822  if ((flags & IA64_OPCODE_NO_PRED) != 0 && qp_regno != 0)
10823    {
10824      as_bad (_("`%s' cannot be predicated"), idesc->name);
10825      goto done;
10826    }
10827
10828  /* Build the instruction.  */
10829  CURR_SLOT.qp_regno = qp_regno;
10830  CURR_SLOT.idesc = idesc;
10831  CURR_SLOT.src_file = as_where (&CURR_SLOT.src_line);
10832  dwarf2_where (&CURR_SLOT.debug_line);
10833  dwarf2_consume_line_info ();
10834
10835  /* Add unwind entries, if there are any.  */
10836  if (unwind.current_entry)
10837    {
10838      CURR_SLOT.unwind_record = unwind.current_entry;
10839      unwind.current_entry = NULL;
10840    }
10841  if (unwind.pending_saves)
10842    {
10843      if (unwind.pending_saves->next)
10844	{
10845	  /* Attach the next pending save to the next slot so that its
10846	     slot number will get set correctly.  */
10847	  add_unwind_entry (unwind.pending_saves->next, NOT_A_CHAR);
10848	  unwind.pending_saves = &unwind.pending_saves->next->r.record.p;
10849	}
10850      else
10851	unwind.pending_saves = NULL;
10852    }
10853  if (unwind.proc_pending.sym && S_IS_DEFINED (unwind.proc_pending.sym))
10854    unwind.insn = 1;
10855
10856  /* Check for dependency violations.  */
10857  if (md.detect_dv)
10858    check_dv (idesc);
10859
10860  md.curr_slot = (md.curr_slot + 1) % NUM_SLOTS;
10861  if (++md.num_slots_in_use >= NUM_SLOTS)
10862    emit_one_bundle ();
10863
10864  if ((flags & IA64_OPCODE_LAST) != 0)
10865    insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10866
10867  md.last_text_seg = now_seg;
10868
10869 done:
10870  input_line_pointer = saved_input_line_pointer;
10871}
10872
10873/* Called when symbol NAME cannot be found in the symbol table.
10874   Should be used for dynamic valued symbols only.  */
10875
10876symbolS *
10877md_undefined_symbol (char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10878{
10879  return 0;
10880}
10881
10882/* Called for any expression that can not be recognized.  When the
10883   function is called, `input_line_pointer' will point to the start of
10884   the expression.  */
10885
10886void
10887md_operand (expressionS *e)
10888{
10889  switch (*input_line_pointer)
10890    {
10891    case '[':
10892      ++input_line_pointer;
10893      expression_and_evaluate (e);
10894      if (*input_line_pointer != ']')
10895	{
10896	  as_bad (_("Closing bracket missing"));
10897	  goto err;
10898	}
10899      else
10900	{
10901	  if (e->X_op != O_register
10902	      || e->X_add_number < REG_GR
10903	      || e->X_add_number > REG_GR + 127)
10904	    {
10905	      as_bad (_("Index must be a general register"));
10906	      e->X_add_number = REG_GR;
10907	    }
10908
10909	  ++input_line_pointer;
10910	  e->X_op = O_index;
10911	}
10912      break;
10913
10914    default:
10915      break;
10916    }
10917  return;
10918
10919 err:
10920  ignore_rest_of_line ();
10921}
10922
10923/* Return 1 if it's OK to adjust a reloc by replacing the symbol with
10924   a section symbol plus some offset.  For relocs involving @fptr(),
10925   directives we don't want such adjustments since we need to have the
10926   original symbol's name in the reloc.  */
10927int
10928ia64_fix_adjustable (fixS *fix)
10929{
10930  /* Prevent all adjustments to global symbols */
10931  if (S_IS_EXTERNAL (fix->fx_addsy) || S_IS_WEAK (fix->fx_addsy))
10932    return 0;
10933
10934  switch (fix->fx_r_type)
10935    {
10936    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64I:
10937    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32MSB:
10938    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32LSB:
10939    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64MSB:
10940    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64LSB:
10941    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR22:
10942    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64I:
10943      return 0;
10944    default:
10945      break;
10946    }
10947
10948  return 1;
10949}
10950
10951int
10952ia64_force_relocation (fixS *fix)
10953{
10954  switch (fix->fx_r_type)
10955    {
10956    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64I:
10957    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32MSB:
10958    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32LSB:
10959    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64MSB:
10960    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64LSB:
10961
10962    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF22:
10963    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF64I:
10964    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR22:
10965    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64I:
10966    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF22:
10967    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64I:
10968    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64MSB:
10969    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64LSB:
10970
10971    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF22X:
10972    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LDXMOV:
10973      return 1;
10974
10975    default:
10976      break;
10977    }
10978
10979  return generic_force_reloc (fix);
10980}
10981
10982/* Decide from what point a pc-relative relocation is relative to,
10983   relative to the pc-relative fixup.  Er, relatively speaking.  */
10984long
10985ia64_pcrel_from_section (fixS *fix, segT sec)
10986{
10987  unsigned long off = fix->fx_frag->fr_address + fix->fx_where;
10988
10989  if (bfd_section_flags (sec) & SEC_CODE)
10990    off &= ~0xfUL;
10991
10992  return off;
10993}
10994
10995
10996/* Used to emit section-relative relocs for the dwarf2 debug data.  */
10997void
10998ia64_dwarf2_emit_offset (symbolS *symbol, unsigned int size)
10999{
11000  expressionS exp;
11001
11002  exp.X_op = O_pseudo_fixup;
11003  exp.X_op_symbol = pseudo_func[FUNC_SEC_RELATIVE].u.sym;
11004  exp.X_add_number = 0;
11005  exp.X_add_symbol = symbol;
11006  emit_expr (&exp, size);
11007}
11008
11009/* This is called whenever some data item (not an instruction) needs a
11010   fixup.  We pick the right reloc code depending on the byteorder
11011   currently in effect.  */
11012void
11013ia64_cons_fix_new (fragS *f, int where, int nbytes, expressionS *exp,
11014		   bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
11015{
11016  fixS *fix;
11017
11018  switch (nbytes)
11019    {
11020      /* There are no reloc for 8 and 16 bit quantities, but we allow
11021	 them here since they will work fine as long as the expression
11022	 is fully defined at the end of the pass over the source file.  */
11023    case 1: code = BFD_RELOC_8; break;
11024    case 2: code = BFD_RELOC_16; break;
11025    case 4:
11026      if (target_big_endian)
11027	code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB;
11028      else
11029	code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB;
11030      break;
11031
11032    case 8:
11033      /* In 32-bit mode, data8 could mean function descriptors too.  */
11034      if (exp->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup
11035	  && exp->X_op_symbol
11036	  && S_GET_VALUE (exp->X_op_symbol) == FUNC_IPLT_RELOC
11037	  && !(md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64))
11038	{
11039	  if (target_big_endian)
11040	    code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTMSB;
11041	  else
11042	    code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTLSB;
11043	  exp->X_op = O_symbol;
11044	  break;
11045	}
11046      else
11047	{
11048	  if (target_big_endian)
11049	    code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB;
11050	  else
11051	    code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB;
11052	  break;
11053	}
11054
11055    case 16:
11056      if (exp->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup
11057	  && exp->X_op_symbol
11058	  && S_GET_VALUE (exp->X_op_symbol) == FUNC_IPLT_RELOC)
11059	{
11060	  if (target_big_endian)
11061	    code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTMSB;
11062	  else
11063	    code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTLSB;
11064	  exp->X_op = O_symbol;
11065	  break;
11066	}
11067      /* FALLTHRU */
11068
11069    default:
11070      as_bad (_("Unsupported fixup size %d"), nbytes);
11071      ignore_rest_of_line ();
11072      return;
11073    }
11074
11075  if (exp->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup)
11076    {
11077      exp->X_op = O_symbol;
11078      code = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (exp->X_op_symbol, code);
11079      /* ??? If code unchanged, unsupported.  */
11080    }
11081
11082  fix = fix_new_exp (f, where, nbytes, exp, 0, code);
11083  /* We need to store the byte order in effect in case we're going
11084     to fix an 8 or 16 bit relocation (for which there no real
11085     relocs available).  See md_apply_fix().  */
11086  fix->tc_fix_data.bigendian = target_big_endian;
11087}
11088
11089/* Return the actual relocation we wish to associate with the pseudo
11090   reloc described by SYM and R_TYPE.  SYM should be one of the
11091   symbols in the pseudo_func array, or NULL.  */
11092
11093static bfd_reloc_code_real_type
11094ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (struct symbol *sym, bfd_reloc_code_real_type r_type)
11095{
11096  bfd_reloc_code_real_type newr = 0;
11097  const char *type = NULL, *suffix = "";
11098
11099  if (sym == NULL)
11100    {
11101      return r_type;
11102    }
11103
11104  switch (S_GET_VALUE (sym))
11105    {
11106    case FUNC_FPTR_RELATIVE:
11107      switch (r_type)
11108	{
11109	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64I; break;
11110	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32MSB; break;
11111	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32LSB; break;
11112	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64MSB; break;
11113	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64LSB; break;
11114	default:			type = "FPTR"; break;
11115	}
11116      break;
11117
11118    case FUNC_GP_RELATIVE:
11119      switch (r_type)
11120	{
11121	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL22; break;
11122	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL64I; break;
11123	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL32MSB; break;
11124	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL32LSB; break;
11125	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL64MSB; break;
11126	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL64LSB; break;
11127	default:			type = "GPREL"; break;
11128	}
11129      break;
11130
11131    case FUNC_LT_RELATIVE:
11132      switch (r_type)
11133	{
11134	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF22; break;
11135	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF64I; break;
11136	default:			type = "LTOFF"; break;
11137	}
11138      break;
11139
11140    case FUNC_LT_RELATIVE_X:
11141      switch (r_type)
11142	{
11143	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF22X; break;
11144	default:			type = "LTOFF"; suffix = "X"; break;
11145	}
11146      break;
11147
11148    case FUNC_PC_RELATIVE:
11149      switch (r_type)
11150	{
11151	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL22; break;
11152	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64I; break;
11153	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL32MSB; break;
11154	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL32LSB; break;
11155	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64MSB; break;
11156	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64LSB; break;
11157	default:			type = "PCREL"; break;
11158	}
11159      break;
11160
11161    case FUNC_PLT_RELATIVE:
11162      switch (r_type)
11163	{
11164	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF22; break;
11165	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64I; break;
11166	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64MSB;break;
11167	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64LSB;break;
11168	default:			type = "PLTOFF"; break;
11169	}
11170      break;
11171
11172    case FUNC_SEC_RELATIVE:
11173      switch (r_type)
11174	{
11175	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SECREL32MSB;break;
11176	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SECREL32LSB;break;
11177	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SECREL64MSB;break;
11178	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SECREL64LSB;break;
11179	default:			type = "SECREL"; break;
11180	}
11181      break;
11182
11183    case FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE:
11184      switch (r_type)
11185	{
11186	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SEGREL32MSB;break;
11187	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SEGREL32LSB;break;
11188	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SEGREL64MSB;break;
11189	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SEGREL64LSB;break;
11190	default:			type = "SEGREL"; break;
11191	}
11192      break;
11193
11194    case FUNC_LTV_RELATIVE:
11195      switch (r_type)
11196	{
11197	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTV32MSB; break;
11198	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTV32LSB; break;
11199	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTV64MSB; break;
11200	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:	newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTV64LSB; break;
11201	default:			type = "LTV"; break;
11202	}
11203      break;
11204
11205    case FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE:
11206      switch (r_type)
11207	{
11208	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:
11209	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR22; break;
11210	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:
11211	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64I; break;
11212	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:
11213	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR32MSB; break;
11214	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:
11215	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR32LSB; break;
11216	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:
11217	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64MSB; break;
11218	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:
11219	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64LSB; break;
11220	default:
11221	  type = "LTOFF_FPTR"; break;
11222	}
11223      break;
11224
11225    case FUNC_TP_RELATIVE:
11226      switch (r_type)
11227	{
11228	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM14:      newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL14; break;
11229	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:      newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL22; break;
11230	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:      newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL64I; break;
11231	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL64MSB; break;
11232	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL64LSB; break;
11233	default:                        type = "TPREL"; break;
11234	}
11235      break;
11236
11237    case FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE:
11238      switch (r_type)
11239	{
11240	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:
11241	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_TPREL22; break;
11242	default:
11243	  type = "LTOFF_TPREL"; break;
11244	}
11245      break;
11246
11247    case FUNC_DTP_MODULE:
11248      switch (r_type)
11249	{
11250	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:
11251	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPMOD64MSB; break;
11252	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:
11253	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPMOD64LSB; break;
11254	default:
11255	  type = "DTPMOD"; break;
11256	}
11257      break;
11258
11259    case FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE:
11260      switch (r_type)
11261	{
11262	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:
11263	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_DTPMOD22; break;
11264	default:
11265	  type = "LTOFF_DTPMOD"; break;
11266	}
11267      break;
11268
11269    case FUNC_DTP_RELATIVE:
11270      switch (r_type)
11271	{
11272	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:
11273	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL32MSB; break;
11274	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:
11275	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL32LSB; break;
11276	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:
11277	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL64MSB; break;
11278	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:
11279	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL64LSB; break;
11280	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM14:
11281	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL14; break;
11282	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:
11283	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL22; break;
11284	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:
11285	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL64I; break;
11286	default:
11287	  type = "DTPREL"; break;
11288	}
11289      break;
11290
11291    case FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE:
11292      switch (r_type)
11293	{
11294	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:
11295	  newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_DTPREL22; break;
11296	default:
11297	  type = "LTOFF_DTPREL"; break;
11298	}
11299      break;
11300
11301    case FUNC_IPLT_RELOC:
11302      switch (r_type)
11303	{
11304	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTMSB:    return r_type;
11305	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTLSB:    return r_type;
11306	default:                        type = "IPLT"; break;
11307	}
11308      break;
11309
11310#ifdef TE_VMS
11311    case FUNC_SLOTCOUNT_RELOC:
11312      return DUMMY_RELOC_IA64_SLOTCOUNT;
11313#endif
11314
11315    default:
11316      abort ();
11317    }
11318
11319  if (newr)
11320    return newr;
11321  else
11322    {
11323      int width;
11324
11325      if (!type)
11326	abort ();
11327      switch (r_type)
11328	{
11329	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB: width = 32; suffix = "MSB"; break;
11330	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB: width = 32; suffix = "LSB"; break;
11331	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB: width = 64; suffix = "MSB"; break;
11332	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB: width = 64; suffix = "LSB"; break;
11333	case BFD_RELOC_UNUSED:        width = 13; break;
11334	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM14:    width = 14; break;
11335	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:    width = 22; break;
11336	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:    width = 64; suffix = "I"; break;
11337	default:                      abort ();
11338	}
11339
11340      /* This should be an error, but since previously there wasn't any
11341	 diagnostic here, don't make it fail because of this for now.  */
11342      as_warn (_("Cannot express %s%d%s relocation"), type, width, suffix);
11343      return r_type;
11344    }
11345}
11346
11347/* Here is where generate the appropriate reloc for pseudo relocation
11348   functions.  */
11349void
11350ia64_validate_fix (fixS *fix)
11351{
11352  switch (fix->fx_r_type)
11353    {
11354    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64I:
11355    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32MSB:
11356    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64LSB:
11357    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR22:
11358    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64I:
11359      if (fix->fx_offset != 0)
11360	as_bad_where (fix->fx_file, fix->fx_line,
11361		      _("No addend allowed in @fptr() relocation"));
11362      break;
11363    default:
11364      break;
11365    }
11366}
11367
11368static void
11369fix_insn (fixS *fix, const struct ia64_operand *odesc, valueT value)
11370{
11371  bfd_vma insn[3], t0, t1, control_bits;
11372  const char *err;
11373  char *fixpos;
11374  long slot;
11375
11376  slot = fix->fx_where & 0x3;
11377  fixpos = fix->fx_frag->fr_literal + (fix->fx_where - slot);
11378
11379  /* Bundles are always in little-endian byte order */
11380  t0 = bfd_getl64 (fixpos);
11381  t1 = bfd_getl64 (fixpos + 8);
11382  control_bits = t0 & 0x1f;
11383  insn[0] = (t0 >>  5) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
11384  insn[1] = ((t0 >> 46) & 0x3ffff) | ((t1 & 0x7fffff) << 18);
11385  insn[2] = (t1 >> 23) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
11386
11387  err = NULL;
11388  if (odesc - elf64_ia64_operands == IA64_OPND_IMMU64)
11389    {
11390      insn[1] = (value >> 22) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
11391      insn[2] |= (((value & 0x7f) << 13)
11392		  | (((value >> 7) & 0x1ff) << 27)
11393		  | (((value >> 16) & 0x1f) << 22)
11394		  | (((value >> 21) & 0x1) << 21)
11395		  | (((value >> 63) & 0x1) << 36));
11396    }
11397  else if (odesc - elf64_ia64_operands == IA64_OPND_IMMU62)
11398    {
11399      if (value & ~0x3fffffffffffffffULL)
11400	err = _("integer operand out of range");
11401      insn[1] = (value >> 21) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
11402      insn[2] |= (((value & 0xfffff) << 6) | (((value >> 20) & 0x1) << 36));
11403    }
11404  else if (odesc - elf64_ia64_operands == IA64_OPND_TGT64)
11405    {
11406      value >>= 4;
11407      insn[1] = ((value >> 20) & 0x7fffffffffLL) << 2;
11408      insn[2] |= ((((value >> 59) & 0x1) << 36)
11409		  | (((value >> 0) & 0xfffff) << 13));
11410    }
11411  else
11412    err = (*odesc->insert) (odesc, value, insn + slot);
11413
11414  if (err)
11415    as_bad_where (fix->fx_file, fix->fx_line, "%s", err);
11416
11417  t0 = control_bits | (insn[0] << 5) | (insn[1] << 46);
11418  t1 = ((insn[1] >> 18) & 0x7fffff) | (insn[2] << 23);
11419  number_to_chars_littleendian (fixpos + 0, t0, 8);
11420  number_to_chars_littleendian (fixpos + 8, t1, 8);
11421}
11422
11423/* Attempt to simplify or even eliminate a fixup.  The return value is
11424   ignored; perhaps it was once meaningful, but now it is historical.
11425   To indicate that a fixup has been eliminated, set FIXP->FX_DONE.
11426
11427   If fixp->fx_addsy is non-NULL, we'll have to generate a reloc entry
11428   (if possible).  */
11429
11430void
11431md_apply_fix (fixS *fix, valueT *valP, segT seg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11432{
11433  char *fixpos;
11434  valueT value = *valP;
11435
11436  fixpos = fix->fx_frag->fr_literal + fix->fx_where;
11437
11438  if (fix->fx_pcrel)
11439    {
11440    switch (fix->fx_r_type)
11441      {
11442      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21B: break;
11443      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21BI: break;
11444      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21F: break;
11445      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21M: break;
11446      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL60B: break;
11447      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL22: break;
11448      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64I: break;
11449      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL32MSB: break;
11450      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL32LSB: break;
11451      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64MSB: break;
11452      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64LSB: break;
11453      default:
11454	fix->fx_r_type = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (pseudo_func[FUNC_PC_RELATIVE].u.sym,
11455					       fix->fx_r_type);
11456	break;
11457      }
11458    }
11459  if (fix->fx_addsy)
11460    {
11461      switch ((unsigned) fix->fx_r_type)
11462	{
11463	case BFD_RELOC_UNUSED:
11464	  /* This must be a TAG13 or TAG13b operand.  There are no external
11465	     relocs defined for them, so we must give an error.  */
11466	  as_bad_where (fix->fx_file, fix->fx_line,
11467			_("%s must have a constant value"),
11468			elf64_ia64_operands[fix->tc_fix_data.opnd].desc);
11469	  fix->fx_done = 1;
11470	  return;
11471
11472	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL14:
11473	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL22:
11474	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL64I:
11475	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_TPREL22:
11476	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_DTPMOD22:
11477	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL14:
11478	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL22:
11479	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL64I:
11480	case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_DTPREL22:
11481	  S_SET_THREAD_LOCAL (fix->fx_addsy);
11482	  break;
11483
11484#ifdef TE_VMS
11485        case DUMMY_RELOC_IA64_SLOTCOUNT:
11486	  as_bad_where (fix->fx_file, fix->fx_line,
11487			_("cannot resolve @slotcount parameter"));
11488	  fix->fx_done = 1;
11489	  return;
11490#endif
11491
11492	default:
11493	  break;
11494	}
11495    }
11496  else if (fix->tc_fix_data.opnd == IA64_OPND_NIL)
11497    {
11498#ifdef TE_VMS
11499      if (fix->fx_r_type == DUMMY_RELOC_IA64_SLOTCOUNT)
11500        {
11501          /* For @slotcount, convert an addresses difference to a slots
11502             difference.  */
11503          valueT v;
11504
11505          v = (value >> 4) * 3;
11506          switch (value & 0x0f)
11507            {
11508            case 0:
11509            case 1:
11510            case 2:
11511              v += value & 0x0f;
11512              break;
11513            case 0x0f:
11514              v += 2;
11515              break;
11516            case 0x0e:
11517              v += 1;
11518              break;
11519            default:
11520              as_bad (_("invalid @slotcount value"));
11521            }
11522          value = v;
11523        }
11524#endif
11525
11526      if (fix->tc_fix_data.bigendian)
11527	number_to_chars_bigendian (fixpos, value, fix->fx_size);
11528      else
11529	number_to_chars_littleendian (fixpos, value, fix->fx_size);
11530      fix->fx_done = 1;
11531    }
11532  else
11533    {
11534      fix_insn (fix, elf64_ia64_operands + fix->tc_fix_data.opnd, value);
11535      fix->fx_done = 1;
11536    }
11537}
11538
11539/* Generate the BFD reloc to be stuck in the object file from the
11540   fixup used internally in the assembler.  */
11541
11542arelent *
11543tc_gen_reloc (asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, fixS *fixp)
11544{
11545  arelent *reloc;
11546
11547  reloc = XNEW (arelent);
11548  reloc->sym_ptr_ptr = XNEW (asymbol *);
11549  *reloc->sym_ptr_ptr = symbol_get_bfdsym (fixp->fx_addsy);
11550  reloc->address = fixp->fx_frag->fr_address + fixp->fx_where;
11551  reloc->addend = fixp->fx_offset;
11552  reloc->howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (stdoutput, fixp->fx_r_type);
11553
11554  if (!reloc->howto)
11555    {
11556      as_bad_where (fixp->fx_file, fixp->fx_line,
11557		    _("Cannot represent %s relocation in object file"),
11558		    bfd_get_reloc_code_name (fixp->fx_r_type));
11559      free (reloc);
11560      return NULL;
11561    }
11562  return reloc;
11563}
11564
11565/* Turn a string in input_line_pointer into a floating point constant
11566   of type TYPE, and store the appropriate bytes in *LIT.  The number
11567   of LITTLENUMS emitted is stored in *SIZE.  An error message is
11568   returned, or NULL on OK.  */
11569
11570const char *
11571md_atof (int type, char *lit, int *size)
11572{
11573  LITTLENUM_TYPE words[MAX_LITTLENUMS];
11574  char *t;
11575  int prec;
11576
11577  switch (type)
11578    {
11579      /* IEEE floats */
11580    case 'f':
11581    case 'F':
11582    case 's':
11583    case 'S':
11584      prec = 2;
11585      break;
11586
11587    case 'd':
11588    case 'D':
11589    case 'r':
11590    case 'R':
11591      prec = 4;
11592      break;
11593
11594    case 'x':
11595    case 'X':
11596    case 'p':
11597    case 'P':
11598      prec = 5;
11599      break;
11600
11601    default:
11602      *size = 0;
11603      return _("Unrecognized or unsupported floating point constant");
11604    }
11605  t = atof_ieee (input_line_pointer, type, words);
11606  if (t)
11607    input_line_pointer = t;
11608
11609  (*ia64_float_to_chars) (lit, words, prec);
11610
11611  if (type == 'X')
11612    {
11613      /* It is 10 byte floating point with 6 byte padding.  */
11614      memset (&lit [10], 0, 6);
11615      *size = 8 * sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE);
11616    }
11617  else
11618    *size = prec * sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE);
11619
11620  return NULL;
11621}
11622
11623/* Handle ia64 specific semantics of the align directive.  */
11624
11625void
11626ia64_md_do_align (int n ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11627		  const char *fill ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11628		  int len ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11629		  int max ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11630{
11631  if (subseg_text_p (now_seg))
11632    ia64_flush_insns ();
11633}
11634
11635/* This is called from HANDLE_ALIGN in write.c.  Fill in the contents
11636   of an rs_align_code fragment.  */
11637
11638void
11639ia64_handle_align (fragS *fragp)
11640{
11641  int bytes;
11642  char *p;
11643  const unsigned char *nop_type;
11644
11645  if (fragp->fr_type != rs_align_code)
11646    return;
11647
11648  /* Check if this frag has to end with a stop bit.  */
11649  nop_type = fragp->tc_frag_data ? le_nop_stop : le_nop;
11650
11651  bytes = fragp->fr_next->fr_address - fragp->fr_address - fragp->fr_fix;
11652  p = fragp->fr_literal + fragp->fr_fix;
11653
11654  /* If no paddings are needed, we check if we need a stop bit.  */
11655  if (!bytes && fragp->tc_frag_data)
11656    {
11657      if (fragp->fr_fix < 16)
11658#if 1
11659	/* FIXME: It won't work with
11660	   .align 16
11661	   alloc r32=ar.pfs,1,2,4,0
11662	 */
11663	;
11664#else
11665	as_bad_where (fragp->fr_file, fragp->fr_line,
11666		      _("Can't add stop bit to mark end of instruction group"));
11667#endif
11668      else
11669	/* Bundles are always in little-endian byte order. Make sure
11670	   the previous bundle has the stop bit.  */
11671	*(p - 16) |= 1;
11672    }
11673
11674  /* Make sure we are on a 16-byte boundary, in case someone has been
11675     putting data into a text section.  */
11676  if (bytes & 15)
11677    {
11678      int fix = bytes & 15;
11679      memset (p, 0, fix);
11680      p += fix;
11681      bytes -= fix;
11682      fragp->fr_fix += fix;
11683    }
11684
11685  /* Instruction bundles are always little-endian.  */
11686  memcpy (p, nop_type, 16);
11687  fragp->fr_var = 16;
11688}
11689
11690static void
11691ia64_float_to_chars_bigendian (char *lit, LITTLENUM_TYPE *words,
11692			       int prec)
11693{
11694  while (prec--)
11695    {
11696      number_to_chars_bigendian (lit, (long) (*words++),
11697				 sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE));
11698      lit += sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE);
11699    }
11700}
11701
11702static void
11703ia64_float_to_chars_littleendian (char *lit, LITTLENUM_TYPE *words,
11704				  int prec)
11705{
11706  while (prec--)
11707    {
11708      number_to_chars_littleendian (lit, (long) (words[prec]),
11709				    sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE));
11710      lit += sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE);
11711    }
11712}
11713
11714void
11715ia64_elf_section_change_hook (void)
11716{
11717  if (elf_section_type (now_seg) == SHT_IA_64_UNWIND
11718      && elf_linked_to_section (now_seg) == NULL)
11719    elf_linked_to_section (now_seg) = text_section;
11720  dot_byteorder (-1);
11721}
11722
11723/* Check if a label should be made global.  */
11724void
11725ia64_check_label (symbolS *label)
11726{
11727  if (*input_line_pointer == ':')
11728    {
11729      S_SET_EXTERNAL (label);
11730      input_line_pointer++;
11731    }
11732}
11733
11734/* Used to remember where .alias and .secalias directives are seen. We
11735   will rename symbol and section names when we are about to output
11736   the relocatable file.  */
11737struct alias
11738{
11739  const char *file;		/* The file where the directive is seen.  */
11740  unsigned int line;	/* The line number the directive is at.  */
11741  const char *name;	/* The original name of the symbol.  */
11742};
11743
11744/* Called for .alias and .secalias directives. If SECTION is 1, it is
11745   .secalias. Otherwise, it is .alias.  */
11746static void
11747dot_alias (int section)
11748{
11749  char *name, *alias;
11750  char delim;
11751  char *end_name;
11752  int len;
11753  const char *error_string;
11754  struct alias *h;
11755  const char *a;
11756  struct hash_control *ahash, *nhash;
11757  const char *kind;
11758
11759  delim = get_symbol_name (&name);
11760  end_name = input_line_pointer;
11761  *end_name = delim;
11762
11763  if (name == end_name)
11764    {
11765      as_bad (_("expected symbol name"));
11766      ignore_rest_of_line ();
11767      return;
11768    }
11769
11770  SKIP_WHITESPACE_AFTER_NAME ();
11771
11772  if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
11773    {
11774      *end_name = 0;
11775      as_bad (_("expected comma after \"%s\""), name);
11776      *end_name = delim;
11777      ignore_rest_of_line ();
11778      return;
11779    }
11780
11781  input_line_pointer++;
11782  *end_name = 0;
11783  ia64_canonicalize_symbol_name (name);
11784
11785  /* We call demand_copy_C_string to check if alias string is valid.
11786     There should be a closing `"' and no `\0' in the string.  */
11787  alias = demand_copy_C_string (&len);
11788  if (alias == NULL)
11789    {
11790      ignore_rest_of_line ();
11791      return;
11792    }
11793
11794  /* Make a copy of name string.  */
11795  len = strlen (name) + 1;
11796  obstack_grow (&notes, name, len);
11797  name = obstack_finish (&notes);
11798
11799  if (section)
11800    {
11801      kind = "section";
11802      ahash = secalias_hash;
11803      nhash = secalias_name_hash;
11804    }
11805  else
11806    {
11807      kind = "symbol";
11808      ahash = alias_hash;
11809      nhash = alias_name_hash;
11810    }
11811
11812  /* Check if alias has been used before.  */
11813  h = (struct alias *) hash_find (ahash, alias);
11814  if (h)
11815    {
11816      if (strcmp (h->name, name))
11817	as_bad (_("`%s' is already the alias of %s `%s'"),
11818		alias, kind, h->name);
11819      goto out;
11820    }
11821
11822  /* Check if name already has an alias.  */
11823  a = (const char *) hash_find (nhash, name);
11824  if (a)
11825    {
11826      if (strcmp (a, alias))
11827	as_bad (_("%s `%s' already has an alias `%s'"), kind, name, a);
11828      goto out;
11829    }
11830
11831  h = XNEW (struct alias);
11832  h->file = as_where (&h->line);
11833  h->name = name;
11834
11835  error_string = hash_jam (ahash, alias, (void *) h);
11836  if (error_string)
11837    {
11838      as_fatal (_("inserting \"%s\" into %s alias hash table failed: %s"),
11839		alias, kind, error_string);
11840      goto out;
11841    }
11842
11843  error_string = hash_jam (nhash, name, (void *) alias);
11844  if (error_string)
11845    {
11846      as_fatal (_("inserting \"%s\" into %s name hash table failed: %s"),
11847		alias, kind, error_string);
11848out:
11849      obstack_free (&notes, name);
11850      obstack_free (&notes, alias);
11851    }
11852
11853  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
11854}
11855
11856/* It renames the original symbol name to its alias.  */
11857static void
11858do_alias (const char *alias, void *value)
11859{
11860  struct alias *h = (struct alias *) value;
11861  symbolS *sym = symbol_find (h->name);
11862
11863  if (sym == NULL)
11864    {
11865#ifdef TE_VMS
11866      /* Uses .alias extensively to alias CRTL functions to same with
11867	 decc$ prefix. Sometimes function gets optimized away and a
11868	 warning results, which should be suppressed.  */
11869      if (strncmp (alias, "decc$", 5) != 0)
11870#endif
11871	as_warn_where (h->file, h->line,
11872		       _("symbol `%s' aliased to `%s' is not used"),
11873		       h->name, alias);
11874    }
11875    else
11876      S_SET_NAME (sym, (char *) alias);
11877}
11878
11879/* Called from write_object_file.  */
11880void
11881ia64_adjust_symtab (void)
11882{
11883  hash_traverse (alias_hash, do_alias);
11884}
11885
11886/* It renames the original section name to its alias.  */
11887static void
11888do_secalias (const char *alias, void *value)
11889{
11890  struct alias *h = (struct alias *) value;
11891  segT sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (stdoutput, h->name);
11892
11893  if (sec == NULL)
11894    as_warn_where (h->file, h->line,
11895		   _("section `%s' aliased to `%s' is not used"),
11896		   h->name, alias);
11897  else
11898    sec->name = alias;
11899}
11900
11901/* Called from write_object_file.  */
11902void
11903ia64_frob_file (void)
11904{
11905  hash_traverse (secalias_hash, do_secalias);
11906}
11907
11908#ifdef TE_VMS
11909#define NT_VMS_MHD 1
11910#define NT_VMS_LNM 2
11911
11912/* Integrity VMS 8.x identifies it's ELF modules with a standard ELF
11913   .note section.  */
11914
11915/* Manufacture a VMS-like time string.  */
11916static void
11917get_vms_time (char *Now)
11918{
11919  char *pnt;
11920  time_t timeb;
11921
11922  time (&timeb);
11923  pnt = ctime (&timeb);
11924  pnt[3] = 0;
11925  pnt[7] = 0;
11926  pnt[10] = 0;
11927  pnt[16] = 0;
11928  pnt[24] = 0;
11929  sprintf (Now, "%2s-%3s-%s %s", pnt + 8, pnt + 4, pnt + 20, pnt + 11);
11930}
11931
11932void
11933ia64_vms_note (void)
11934{
11935  char *p;
11936  asection *seg = now_seg;
11937  subsegT subseg = now_subseg;
11938  asection *secp = NULL;
11939  char *bname;
11940  char buf [256];
11941  symbolS *sym;
11942
11943  /* Create the .note section.  */
11944
11945  secp = subseg_new (".note", 0);
11946  bfd_set_section_flags (secp, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_READONLY);
11947
11948  /* Module header note (MHD).  */
11949  bname = xstrdup (lbasename (out_file_name));
11950  if ((p = strrchr (bname, '.')))
11951    *p = '\0';
11952
11953  /* VMS note header is 24 bytes long.  */
11954  p = frag_more (8 + 8 + 8);
11955  number_to_chars_littleendian (p + 0, 8, 8);
11956  number_to_chars_littleendian (p + 8, 40 + strlen (bname), 8);
11957  number_to_chars_littleendian (p + 16, NT_VMS_MHD, 8);
11958
11959  p = frag_more (8);
11960  strcpy (p, "IPF/VMS");
11961
11962  p = frag_more (17 + 17 + strlen (bname) + 1 + 5);
11963  get_vms_time (p);
11964  strcpy (p + 17, "24-FEB-2005 15:00");
11965  p += 17 + 17;
11966  strcpy (p, bname);
11967  p += strlen (bname) + 1;
11968  free (bname);
11969  strcpy (p, "V1.0");
11970
11971  frag_align (3, 0, 0);
11972
11973  /* Language processor name note.  */
11974  sprintf (buf, "GNU assembler version %s (%s) using BFD version %s",
11975	   VERSION, TARGET_ALIAS, BFD_VERSION_STRING);
11976
11977  p = frag_more (8 + 8 + 8);
11978  number_to_chars_littleendian (p + 0, 8, 8);
11979  number_to_chars_littleendian (p + 8, strlen (buf) + 1, 8);
11980  number_to_chars_littleendian (p + 16, NT_VMS_LNM, 8);
11981
11982  p = frag_more (8);
11983  strcpy (p, "IPF/VMS");
11984
11985  p = frag_more (strlen (buf) + 1);
11986  strcpy (p, buf);
11987
11988  frag_align (3, 0, 0);
11989
11990  secp = subseg_new (".vms_display_name_info", 0);
11991  bfd_set_section_flags (secp, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_READONLY);
11992
11993  /* This symbol should be passed on the command line and be variable
11994     according to language.  */
11995  sym = symbol_new ("__gnat_vms_display_name@gnat_demangler_rtl",
11996		    absolute_section, 0, &zero_address_frag);
11997  symbol_table_insert (sym);
11998  symbol_get_bfdsym (sym)->flags |= BSF_DEBUGGING | BSF_DYNAMIC;
11999
12000  p = frag_more (4);
12001  /* Format 3 of VMS demangler Spec.  */
12002  number_to_chars_littleendian (p, 3, 4);
12003
12004  p = frag_more (4);
12005  /* Place holder for symbol table index of above symbol.  */
12006  number_to_chars_littleendian (p, -1, 4);
12007
12008  frag_align (3, 0, 0);
12009
12010  /* We probably can't restore the current segment, for there likely
12011     isn't one yet...  */
12012  if (seg && subseg)
12013    subseg_set (seg, subseg);
12014}
12015
12016#endif /* TE_VMS */
12017